MI UEjjFC ^^R*k^J!!C[y^fr Class TFSS-Q Copyright^ COPYRIGHT DEPOSIT; a* JBH? Operation of Trains and Station Work and Telegraphy COMPILED AND EDITED BY FREDERICK J: PRIOR ILLUSTRATED CHICAGO FREDERICK J. DRAKE & CO., Publishers TF550 Copyright, 1914 FREDERICK J. DRAKE & CO. Chicago Copyright, 1907 By FREDERICK J. DRAKE & CO. Chicago /V* )CI.A371640 PREFACE The proper administration and operation of the train department of railways is one of first importance in modern American railway practice. It is the department which comes in closest contact with the' general public. Passenger trains must be safely run and on time. Freight trains are of nearly equal importance and freight must be handled without causing friction with shippers. In- telligent, skillful, well directed effort and harmony of action is necessary to ensure this. The operating forces, particularly in the train depart- ment have shown an improvement equally as marked as the improvement and progress in railways, and this for- ward movement continues. Railway men are on the alert for information, they now seek reasons before coming to conclusions. The result being that railway men of the future will have a far wider range of knowledge than raihvay men of the past ever dreamed of possessing. Those in whom this spirit of inquiry has been awakened will not rest content with knowledge gained through personal experience alone, instead, while continuing to profit by experience they will supplement it with obser- vation, inquiry and study. The editors have endeavored to meet in this particular volume the needs of just such men. Compiled from many sources it contains the essence of numerous stand- ard works by noted writers of authority, to whom grate- ful acknowledgment is made. Being largely a compila- tion no claim to originality is made. Doubtless some omissions have been made, and possibly some redundant matter may be found, but, even so, it is believed it will prove a work of much value and interest to those for whom primarily it is designed. 3 TABLE OF CONTENTS PART I. The train brakeman 5 The passenger conductor ' 9 Dispatchers: Trainmaster: Division Superintendent.... 15 Color blindness — How to detect it 27 Heating passenger cars 41 Heating car? with electricity ;.J15 Catechism of steam heating 122 Lighting passenger cars 133 Acetylene car lighting • 150 Electric car lighting system 1 G6 Car generator 177 Standard code train rules 203 Rules for single track 206 Rules for movement by train orders 220 Forms of train orders 22S Movement of trains * 241 Rules for movement by train orders 243 Trainmen's examination 250 Rulings of the American Ra'ilway Association 314 Interlocking rules 343 Block signal rules 350 Enginemen and trainmen 359 Train order signals 375 Block signal examination 427 Signalling catechism 432 Signals of interlocking plants 443 Pointers for conductors 453 Pointers for brakemen 457 Rules for operation of trains and handling of freight and passengers 458 Trainmen handling brakes 474 Appendices 493 TABLE OF CONTENTS— Continued. PART II. TELEGRAPHY. Instructions for beginners 3 Adjustment of instruments 30 Wire signals used in taking circuit from others 41 General rules and instructions for telegraph employes... 52 General instructions in train order wire work 60 General instructions in railway message wire work 69 General instructions in commercial wire work 78 Indexes, Part I and Part II. THE TRAIN BRAKEMAN. As a rule, young men who decide to engage in the railroad service as brakemen do so because there is a certain fascination connected with the business, due to the fact that they are privileged to ride through various sections of the country, with advantages similar to those for which others have to pay, affording them an oppor- tunity to visit different villages and cities, which serve to satisfy the natural longing for travel and .desire for change of scene felt by young men, especially between the ages of seventeen and twenty-five. It is the exception instead of the rule for a man who changes from one road to another to be successful ; for this reason a young ^nan who decides to enter the rail- road world as brakeman, before making application for a position, should carefully consider his future chances in connection with the position and the field for advance- ment ; whether or not the climate in the section of coun- try through which he would run will agree with his health : also, if the community in which the majority of the trainmen have their ''lay over" is all that he would desire as a location to be made his home. To make a good brakeman, a young man should be possessed of the average amount of good common sense, should have a good memory and a quick ear, should in- cline toward being shrewd and business-like, should be active, possessed of a sound body and a steady nerve. He should be firm in his decisions, following closelv his 5 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS instructions and looking to the best interests of the com- pany, and should always be civil and polite. If he conducts himself in a respectable manner, and keeps himself neat and clean when surrounding circum- stances permit, he will command respect wherever he goes ; and if possessed of ordinary good sense and ability, is bound to be successful. He should, so far as lies in his power, see that the proper temperature is maintained in the cars, and that they are properly ventilated ; also, when running at night, he should see that the lamps are burning properly, and in a general way look after the comfort of the passengers. FREIGHT BRAKEMAN. The voung" man who starts in the train-service as freight brakeman, should at once begin to study a copy of the rules and instructions furnished by his employer, with the object in view of familiarizing himself with them to such an extent that he will make a showing as good as, if not better than usually made by young men on their first trip, as upon this and the following two or three trips depend his chances, while serving in that capacity, especially if there are several extra brakemen. During the first few months of his railroad experience, especially, he should use the utmost care in everything he does, in fact doing nothing that he does not know to be right. When throwing switches he should see that the rails "line" properly or points close up tightly. He should never stand beside a "switch" when a train is approaching or passing, in order to guard against the un- accountable impulse of "throwing" a switch that is prop- erly set. When setting brakes he should be careful to STATION AND TRAIN WORK 4 avoid the sliding, and consequent destroying of wheels. When "dropping cars in" at stations he should always consider it down grade until he is assured that it is not ; in so doing he will leave no chance for them to get be- yond his control ; and when leaving them, if equipped with air-brakes, and the hand brakes are in proper work- ing order, the latter should be used to secure them. The air-brakes should not be depended upon, as in time they may release, leaving an opening for an accident. When giving signals with a lantern he should use judgment. When he wishes an engineer to move slowly or a short distance, signal should be given accordingly ; emphasizing it when emphasis is needed. In fact, cool and deliberate judgment should be exercised in every move ; it is essential to the proper performance of duty in any department of a railroad. He should never absent himself from duty # at the dif- ferent terminals without permission, when there is a possible chance for his "crew" to be used; and such per- mission should not be requested unless there are good reasons for so doing. Instead of a young man, after entering the railroad service, ''falling in" with the "rougher" class of. men with the object of becoming "one of the boys," thinking that is the only way of securing friends among railroad men, drifting along until his will power is so weakened by dissipation that he has not the moral courage to leave his so-called "friends," and in preference, sacrific- ing his position, losing all ambition in life and becoming what is termed a ''traveling railroad man/' he should keep none but good company, and never miss an opportu- nity to gather information concerning the running of a freight train, so that when called upon to make his first 8 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS trip as a freight conductor he will be able to make a good showing. Once started, it is seldom one forsakes the hope that some day he will reach the goal of his ambition and be classed as a master of intricate and numerous train rules, acquired not by the study alone of books, but by the hard grind of an everyday practical contact with ever changing conditions that crop up almost every hour, and must frequently be dealt with in a way possible only to those whose sole dependence is the judgment necessary to improvise for emergencies. . When his bills or slips are handed him for the first time, none feels more elated than he, for his highest am- bition for years has been secured, and he begins to reflect on how to advance further. After learning the rudimentary principles of freight, and perhaps in addition yard service, he feels that he possesses qualifications fitting him for advancement, and because of this confidence, inspired by years of successful work, is finally promoted to passenger service. PASSENGER CONDUCTOR. The first duty of a conductor is to be absolutely certain that his train is perfectly protected and safe, protected against accidents by being supplied with the proper sig- nals ; and in case a train is delayed, to see that the rear man goes back with danger signals to warn an approach- ing train. This is a very important duty, and no con- ductor can be too careful in properly protecting his train, as many accidents have happened by short flagging. He must know his engineer and men, and keep in touch with them, and notify them of all orders received, and must know and be familiar with all signals and orders re- ceived from train master and other officials. He must be vigilant and watchful — careful as to the safety and comfort of the passengers and property en- trusted to his care, always keeping in mind that he repre- sents the owners and officials of the railway he is em- ployed upon — and, as he is the man who comes directly in contact with the public as the representative of the rail- way company, he must be a good judge of human nature and be thoughtful and intelligent in the transaction of the company's business affairs, careful not to allow any loss to occur on any account, and be courteous, gentle- manly and business-like, always endeavoring to avoid giving offense to any one. He should also see that the cars are clean and properly heated and well ventilated. At each terminal he should make correct reports of all trains and the time, and re- 9 10 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS turn same to the proper officials. Before starting on a trip he should know that his train has been properly in- spected, that he has the authority for the movement of all cars in his train, that the air brakes are in proper work- ing order, that he has the proper train orders or clearance in his possession to move, and that all over-due trains have arrived and departed, and that he has the right of track to proceed before giving the signal that starts the train. While train is running, it is his duty to keep a sharp lookout to see if any of the journals are running hot, brake-shoes sticking, etc. Not only does the responsibility for the safety of the train devolve upon the conductor, calling for an everlast- ing alertness while on the road, but the numerous forms of transportation must be watched, and the bulletins and instructions carried out. It is an easy matter for a con- ductor to involve his company in a suit by improperly handling a "crank" who has been sold a ticket to a point at which the train does not stop, or one whose transporta- tion is questionable. There are a great many things which must be left to the conductor's judgment, as all emergencies cannot be covered by instructions. In the collection of transportation he must be careful not to accept any ticket or pass the limit of which has expired, or one that has been advertised as lost or stolen. Tie must be familiar with all forms of tickets issued by other roads, and be able to answ r er all questions intelli- gently in regard to connections, leaving time of trains at junction points, etc. In fact he is a walking encyclopaedia and timetable, all of which must.be done in a pleasant manne 1 * as the popularity of the road depends in a great measure on the way passengers are treated by the em- ployees. b» STATION AND TRAIN WORK 11 The duties of the conductor vary according to the run, whether it is local or a through run. On a through run a conductor reports in full uniform thirty minutes before leaving time, inspects train and reports any defects to the division superintendent or other proper officer to whom such reports are to be made ; sees that trainmen are on duty in full uniform fl ■u pq 05 o 3 0) u cd od o S) u. I 1 1 i i > i J, tga Q) t« 2 •* a, !* x o to prevent salt or any other solid matter from entering the pipes. The lower end of the coil should be con- nected with the Globe valve e. The water, if salt, should - be sufficient to fill the pipes without drawing down too close to the surplus salt at the bottom and not too near to the strainer. The water level should never be less than four inches above the strainer. One hundred feet of 1 34 -inch piping will hold about seven and a half gal- lons of water ; therefore, if the number of feet of circu- lation piping is known the quantity of water can easily be calculated. As a precaution an excess quantity of about a third should be provided. A barrel of the ordi- nary size will usually hold enough water to fill the heater in a standard car ; and the same quantity suffices for one-half of a double circulation heater, but to guard against taking air into the pipes care should be taken to have more water or brine than is absolutely needed so as to not draw it down too near to the strainer. The angle valve b should be closed and the globe valve e opened ; a steam hose connected to the draw-off cock furthest from the expansion drum and about 25 or 30 pounds of steam blown into the pipes. Directly it issues in full volume freely from each open draw-off cock that cock should be 'closed, and thus in the course of a few moments every foot of the heater pipes will be full of live steam which will force its way 'into the expansion drum and out through the coil B and the globe valve e, carrying the air and the condensed water with it, which will be discharged from the globe valve e. Should any live steam escape with the water, the valve should.be dosed a little, or until nothing but water and air escape. The steam will heat the water in the barrel to the boiHng ooint wdien all the air has been expelled; HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 00 and boiling will expel the air held in suspension in a body of cool water ; then, if the boiling water will float a potato it is salt enough to use in the circulation pipes. The globe valve outside the barrel and also the draw- off cock through which steam enters the 'pipes should be closed and the steam hose disconnected. The angle valve inside the barrel should be opened, whereupon the steam from the pipes will continue to enter the brine until the pressure is reduced. The steam which remains in the pipes will condense and form a vacuum into which the boiling hot brine is forced by atmospheric pressure, com- pletely filling the pipes in a few moments. It may be known the pipes are completely filled by the water level in the barrel remaining stationary. The half-inch piping should be disconnected after the circulation piping is filled, whereupon it will be discov- ered the drum is full to the top. This excess may be drawn off through the combination cock to the level of the cock and then the safety valve should be replaced. When, after a few hours, the water has cooled, it will have contracted to some extent, so a small quantity may be added by hand through the combination cock. The heating system will then be ready for service. In the case of double-coil circulation systems they should be treated as though each were a separate car. The fire should be started slowly when first it is lighted, it is best to begin with a wood fire. It should burn gradually until the circulation of the hot water is complete, which is indicated by the entire piping system being hot. Then the fire should be allowed to die down and the water to cool. Probably two or three firings and coolings may be necessary before all the air is ex- hausted from the pipes and the water becomes "solid.'' 56 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS Usually after the first firing the heater needs more water. For the first few days the renewing of water should be carefully attended to, a small deficit may have to be made good every day for the first week or two. When, however, the water becomes solid throughout the heater and circulation pipes no further renewal will be neces- sary; but nevertheless frequent tests should be made to ensure that everything is working right. To test for the amount of water in the drum and piping the fire should be low and no pressure in the heater. The height of the water in the drum should be noted by means of the combination cock C, Figure 5. If the water is at the right height it will run out of the drip pipe when the cock C is opened. To renew water when necessary to do so, it should be put in through the filling funnel f, which is attached to the cock C. When through the cock should be closed and the funnel turned down. To empty water from the heating system, if occasion requires, it should be drawn off through the cock e in the crossover pipe, "Figure 3. At the same time cock C in the drum should be opened to serve as an air vent, thus admitting atmospheric pressure to assist in discharg- ing the water more freely. Should there be any extra drain cocks where water could be pocketed in the piping they should be opened also to drain out the water. The circulation system should never be emptied unless abso- lutely necessary. If the water should ever be allowed to get low T enough so that the drum is emptied, circulation will stop, the pressure will increase rapidly, and the safety vent prob- ably blow r out. Should it get so low as to leave none in the coil the latter would burn out; but if the water is HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 57 always kept solid the circulation throughout the entire system will be satisfactory, without any pressure in the heater. Should a safety vent blow out, the fire should be immediately drawn, the water renewed to the level of the combination cock C, another vent v screwed into the drum and the fire again started. i On the old style Baker heater the safety vent con- sisted of a rubber ball held between tw T o brass plates. The screws which hold these plates must not be interfered with nor should the plates be screwed any closer together than was originally intended. Every time the valve blows out it spoils the ball, therefore a new one should be put in, but the cast-iron vent is far more reliable. The pressure gauge indicates the pressure within the heater. The Xew Style of Baker Heater Steam Attachment consists of four 34-inch copper pipes screwed into brass fittings, and placed vertically into a 3-inch wrought iron cylinder, three and one-half feet long. Into this cylinder steam is admitted from the locomotive through a 3/^-inch branch pipe leading up from the train pipe, to top of cylinder. By this arrangement, steam instead of fire in the Baker heater is used, if desired, to circulate the w T ater, or steam can be used at the same time as the fire, to heat up quickly. When used in connection with a heater, it is placed at the back of the heater, as shown in Figure 8, between the return pipe and the pipe connecting top of the coil to the drum. (The heater coil can be cut out if so de- sired.) The steam is controlled by an angle valve, placed at the top of the 3/^-inch supply pipe. The position of the valve is such that all water from the condensed steam will run from it. 58 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS FIG. 8. BAKER STEAM ATTACHMENT SHOWN FITTED TO HEATER. CUT TO THE RIGHT SHOWS THE ATTACHMENT DETACHED FROM HEATER. HEATING AN1> LIGHTING CARS 59 FIG. 9. DETAILS OF IMPROVED BAKER STEAM ATTACHMENT. (See Fig. 8 for Same Shown Attached to Heater.) 60 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS Xo "trap" is used for the release of the water of the condensed steam, but instead a simple blow-through valve on a ^-inch drip pipe, operated inside the car. The seat of this valve has a small groove, which allows the escape of condensed' water, even if closed. . | I > < j > 3 a* . p* ^ -o Ph d tf st! 5 £ Pm g I I £ « S the pipe which leads to the bottom of the coil, the others on the pipes which lead to and from the radiating pipes on the side of the car opposite the heater side, known as "cross-overs/' or, in the case of a double circulation 62 .RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS car they are connected into the circulation near the mid- dle of the car. The steam thus drawn from the loco- motive is conducted from car to car by means of i ukable flexible couplings and pipes beneath the floor ; these pipes are called train-pipes, and they are so arranged as to admit of gravity drainage from a selected high point to each end of the car. A fitting is placed at this high point which permits the necessary quantity of steam to be withdrawn from the train-pipe for use in heating the car. Two train-pipe valves, Figure 10, one at each end of the car, control the passage of steam through the pipe, both being kept open, except the one at the rear end of the rear car, which should be closed to prevent the FIG. 11. EXTENSION HANDLE. steam from escaping. A small groove in the seat of the valve provides for the continual draining of the con- densed steam (or water) and prevents freezing. The train-pipe valves just described are controlled by exten- sion handle, Figure n, which is readily reached from the car step. From the fitting in the train-pipe steam passes first through a controlling valve, near the heater, along the truss plank to the low end of the jacket nearest the heater and from this jacket by connecting pipes to the other jackets in series. These jackets have each an in- clination upward in the direction of the circulation of HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 63 the water, steam entering and leaving the low end of each jacket. The steam pipes should maintain a gradual fall from the controlling valve to the low end of the last jacket and then to the automatic trap. In all jackets the water contained within the outer pipes is heated by the passing steam, thus aiding in the circulation, and also reducing to from one-third to one- sixth the time required, to cause complete circulation of hot water in all parts of the system. While the steam at the pressures used is far below the temperature of fire, its application in this way, at various points of circula- tion instead of at one point (the heater coil), results in a more uniform heating, and higher average temperature of the pipes throughout the car. The principle is the same in a double circulation car, the only difference being in the location of the jackets, which are connected into the circulation as shown. It will be noted that the entire water circulating sys- tem is a "closed" one, and that when once filled with water to the proper level, requires no further attention. The heat required for the car is regulated by a con- trolling valve which admits steam to the jackets, and by which means a uniform temperature is easily main- tained. To discharge the condensed steam (or water) from the steam pipes, and yet prevent steam from escaping, an automatic steam trap is used, Figure 12. This trap is adjusted by loosening the locknut F, on the end, the trap is then opened by screwing out the seat (which is controlled by the smaller square stem D) until steam escapes freely, then it should be closed until a point is reached w 7 here just a little steam escapes with the water. When the seat is adjusted properly the locknut should RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 65 Wv^/V^/vr^ be tightly screwed up, care being taken not to let the seat move while doing so. The minimum pitch which should be given to the trap to ensure that the water of condensation drains through the outlet is shown in Figure 13, which also shows a 66 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS blow-off valve connected to the one-inch pipe thread in the end of the trap. This valve serves to remove any dirt or scale from the trap, and it also permits the quick discharge of condensed steam. It is usually so arranged that it may be controlled by an extension handle through the floor of the car. Should steam be entirely cut off at any time, the trap will immediately discharge all condensation which re- mains in the pipes. Or, it may be quickly discharged by means of the blow-off valve above the trap, which is generally controlled by a handle through the floor. The trap is fully capable of being used without recourse to this auxiliary, it is merely there for use in the event of most extraordinarv and very severe conditions. DIRECT STEAM HEATING SYSTEM. This system, illustrated by Plates I, II and III, is a simple and easily applied heater for cars. It is illustrated on Plate III. Steam is supplied to the cars by means of an ordinary train-pipe, with flexible couplings between the cars. This train-pipe drains from the center to each end of the car, and at the middle point is a cross, 638. Two train-pipe valves, one .at each end of the car, con- trol the passage of steam through the pipe, both being kept open, except the rear one of the rear car, which is closed to prevent the escape of steam*. A small groove in the seat of the valve provides for the continual draining of. the condensation in the train-pipe and avoids freezing. These train-pipe valves are controlled by extension han- dles, which may be readily reached from the steps of the car. TRAP 833 Plate 1. Design, showing Standard Heating System as used with Single Circulation Baker Heaters. Plate 2. Design showing Standard Heating System as used with Double Circulation Baker Heaters, Plate 3. Diagram illustrating design for Direct Steam Heating System. HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 67 C — Body. D — Bonnet. B — Cap Nut. ELEVATION SECTION AB FIG 14. STEAM INLET VALVE. LIST OF PARTS. F Gland I — Disc. O — Valve Nut. G Hand Wheel. K — Stem Nut. P — Cotter Pin. jj Valve L — Stem. R — Disc Case. 68 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS Steam is supplied from the train-pipe through the cross, 638, and it passes to each side of the car. Rising through the floor beneath a seat, it is controlled by a D — Cap Nut. E — Gland. F — Bonnet. G — Stem. H — Body. I — Stem Nut. J — Valve. Section Elevation FIG. 15. ANGLE VALVE. (Used on Locomotive.) K — Union Nut. L — Union Nipple. X — Hand Wheel. Z — Gasket. No. 142a — Retaining Screw. No. 150 — Bonnet Screw. steam inlet valve, Figure 14,, which is capable of very fine adjustment. By means of this valve the requisite amount of steam necessary to heat the car is admitted. Plate 4. Locomotive Steam Heating Equipment for Furnishing Steam to the Coaches. HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 69 Along the truss plank is a radiator of two (2) inch pipes, and the steam from the inlet valve enters the upper one first through a back outlet return bend, 783, and expansion bend. This 2-inch pipe has an inclination from the center toward each end of the car, and the steam fol- lows these inclinations, entering the lower pipe from the ends and returning: toward the center. At the center is a -=PLAN=- BRA93 l'N PIPETK.READ. 4 -= SECTION CD. =*- -= ELEVATION.3- -Plug. -Body. FIG. 16. REDUCING VALVE. (Used on Locomotive.) G — Wiasher. H — Nut. tee, 708b, from which a 2-inch pipe is taken to a vertical automatic trap, which regulates the discharge of the condensation. The radiation of the heat from the two pipes along the truss plank heats the car, the area of radiating surface being proportioned to the size of the car. Plate IV illustrates in a general war the method of equipping a locomotive for use with ste^m heated cars. Steam is usuallv taken from the "steam box." 70 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS Angle Valve, Figure 15, Reducing Valve, Figure 16, and Gauge. Figure 17, are placed in the relationship shown on the drawing. The first is for admitting the steam supply, and the Reducing Valve is for controlling the pressure on the Train-Pipe and should never be used as a shut-off valve. SIPHON FIG. 17. i~PlPETHREA0/ GAUGE FOR STEAM HEATING. (On Locomotive.) Experience has shown that it is best to carry a pressure of 40 lbs. on the train-pipe for a train of eight cars or less, and that for a greater number of cars, the pressure should be increased five pounds for each car above eight. It is better to have a pressure higher than is needed than one that is too low, and it is not a, serious drain on the locomotive. The amount of extra work put on a locomo- tive, by the steam heating of its train, is measured by HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 72 the amount of water condensed by each car, and is roughly about 40 to 60 lbs. per hour per car. Care should be taken to keep the steam gauge, Figure 17, in good order, and it should be tested and corrected, if necessary, at least once each season. Many cases of reported failures of trains to heat properly are found to be due to errors of gauges, the pressure actually supplied being far below that indicated by the gauge. STEAM COUPLER TROUBLES. Owing to modern passenger traffic conditions, with the constantly increasing demands made on locomotives, im- provements to prevent leaks and effect economy of steam have been made and upon many railroads have been adopted. We give, therefore, a concise description of new style steam couplers made by the Consolidated Car Heating Company. Serious steam losses result from imperfect connections of steam hose couplers. Constant efforts have been made to construct a satisfactory coupler. Coupler heads are hammered together, and locking devices are applied in an attempt to force a tight joint — and still the drain on the locomotive has increased and the delays to trains on account of leaky couplers have been as frequent and annoying as ever. The Consolidated Car-Heating Company claim to have overcome this condition by the development of the type of coupler we describe (see Figure 18). The essential points in the construction of this type of coupler are : ( 1 ) an automatic locking device, (2) all the points of en- gagement are carefully machined, (3) the opening through the head can be adjusted from i*4' to ij/£ f , (4) RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS en P < ffl fa O o g £> o o 2 HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 73 the liability to hose kinking is prevented by the increased angle of the coupler nipple, (5) should the train part the coupler automatically separates, (6) 'on sharp curves or under strain of the draft rigging the coupler will not open and leak steam, (7) the wear and gasket losses are reduced to a minimum through the novel and efficient method of holding gaskets. The gasket is applied to the coupler by sliding it into the machined groove, and is firmly locked in place by slightly bending the steel lug formed on it. Springs are not used to hold it in place, neither are they necessary, because there is no obstruction in the steam passage. It is moulded into one piece and has wide faces at the front and back, making a positive seat and steam tight joint. When a coupling of the heads is being made, the locks are turned to one side so that the lug and clutch can , engage each other. The locks are then snapped into position (see Figure 19). The small degree of lift of the heads with the attend- ing slight bend of the hose in the coupling will be noted. This feature is the result of the increased angle of the coupler head nipple. It produces the important advan- tage of ease in making the coupler connection, of effecting a more positive automatic coupling, and of greatly les- sening the amount of bending at the hose when coupling and uncoupling. It is the bending of the hose which proves so destructive to its life — especially in regard to the larger sizes. The increased angle of the nipple per- mits of a natural set form to the hose when coupled. The bending strain is distributed over the entire length of the hose instead of being confined to the point just back of the nipple and causing kinking, as is the case when the angle of the elevation of the nipple is less. The service 74 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS application of the coupler locks is shown in Figure 19 and is as follows : Points A and A 1 acting as fulcrums, through the compression of the specially oil tempered spiral steel springs, B and B\ cause the locks to exert a downward pressure of 35 to 40 pounds at the extreme tip of e^ch of the coupler wings, C and C . Point D acting as a hinge, the two gaskets are brought into definite and fixed contact, and a steam-tight connection is effected. n The automatic locking device is, perhaps, the most important feature in the effective operation of this coup- ler ; it is claimed for it that, a steam tight joint is insured under all conditions, that the gaskets are brought to- gether and locked as one piece, that when coupled with heads of other types the locking effect is interchangeable, that heads are prevented from lifting and leaking on sharp curves or under strain of draft rigging, that the necessity of hammering heads in an attempt to get tight " joints is entirely done away with, and that in event of the train parting for any cause there is no tearing out of hose or pulling out of train line. In case of accidental break-in-two of the train the coupler wings are forced up by the straightening of the hose, D acting as a hinge, and the pressure of the lock springs B and B 1 being overcome until the line of draft reaches a higher plane than the line of contact, when the coupler heads part without damage to hose or train line. THE ECONOMY CAR HEATING SYSTEM. This system is designed to heat passenger trains with the exhaust steam from Air Pumps instead of live steam from the locomotive boiler. HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 75 76 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS Many attempts have been made in the past to utilize the exhaust steam from Air Pumps for heating purposes, but without success, as no means were provided for tak- ing care of the condensed water discharged from the pump with the steam. The manufacturers state that the action of the Air Pump on the road being intermittent, constantly stopping and restarting, and so causing con- siderable condensation to take place in both the steam cylinder of the Air Pump and its steam supply pipe, which, being discharged by the Air Pump upon each restarting, can, if carried into the heating system of the cars, fill the radiators and pipes and so prevent the cars from being properly heated. Serious damage would also be likely to result from the freezing of tl>is water in the car radiators and pipes. With the Economy Car Heating System the exhaust steam and water from the Air Pump is discharged into a Reservoir, and the water is prevented from passing into the train pipes and radiators. In the Reservoir also all the ivater is re-evaporated into steam, and both the heat in the steam and the latent heat in the water ex- hausted from the Air Pump (which has heretofore been zvasted) are used for heating the cars. It has been fully demonstrated, the makers claim, on a large number of railroads, on which this system is in use, that the average passenger train can be properly heated with the exhaust steam from the Air Pump zvith- ont the use of live steam. In case the exhaust from the Air Pump should not be sufficient to heat the train, live steam to supply the de- ficiency is automatically drawn from the locomotive boiler. This condition might arise with limited express trains making but few stops, or with very heavy trains HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 77 in extremely cold weather. In this event, all the heat from the Air Pump exhaust would be utilized, and the boiler would furnish only the excess quantity of live steam necessary to heat the train. This system is claimed to be perfectly automatic and requires no attention on the part of the engine crew on the road. The "Relief Valve" is set at the maximum and the "Pressure Regulator" at the minimum pressures before the train is started, and the steam pressure in the train heating system is absolutely confined between these two pressures. Fuel and water are also saved by the removal of the Air Pump exhaust from the stack, it being a well-known fact that the discharge of the exhaust steam from the Air Pump into the stack, which is the practice on many railroads, causes a constant draft on the fire and a con- siderable waste of coal. Steam and water are also wasted by the frequent opening of the pop valves and the opera- tion of the injectors to maintain the proper water level. The noise from the Air Pump exhaust is avoided, which is an advantage of no little importance, especially with locomotives standing under covered stations. A very perceptible improvement in the steaming of locomotives has resulted, it is stated, from their equip- ment with this heating system, especially in the case of locomotives that had previously steamed poorly in cold weather. This has been due to the fact that practically all of the steam generated in the boiler has been available for use in the locomotive cylinders, and the constant drain of live steam for heating trains has been eliminated. Locomotives have, therefore, been able to make their time, and the delays caused by "low steam" have been avoided. 78 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS No cjiange whatever is required in the car heating equipment, the apparatus being applied to the locomotive in a manner for use in conjunction with the car heating system already in service, which can also be used inde- pendently of the Economy Car Heating System, with live steam direct from the boiler, if desired. The effect upon the Air Pump from its operation under back pressure is the same only as would result from an increase of the main reservoir pressure. PIPE CONNECTIONS. One set of the Economy Car Heating Apparatus con- sists of a Reservoir, Three-way Cock, and "E. C. H." Relief Valve. Various types of locomotives require different locations of the apparatus. The material for the pipe connections depends upon the respective locations of the Air Pump and Reservoir. Pipe of the i 1/4 inch size should be used. The Reservoirs are made in four sizes, 44 inches in length, and 14, 16, iS, and 20 inches outside diameter respectively, of steel, carefully tested under 250 pounds pressure. They are first covered with asbestos cloth, then lagged with wood one inch thick, and fitted on the outside with an iron jacket. The largest size of Reservoir that will clear the cab line should be used, especially for locomotives hauling long or heavy trains. For trains consisting of not more than four cars a Reservoir of the 14-inch size is amply large. The Reservoir should be attached to the running board directly under the cab and on the same side of the loco- HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 79 motive as the Air Pump, so that the pipe connecting the Air Pump and the Reservoir will be the shortest possible. The location of the Reservoir on the same side of the locomotive as the Air Pump is not absolutely necessary, and, in case the driver brake auxiliary reservoir, triple valve, signal valve, etc., are on the same side of the locomotive as the Air Pump, the Reservoir may be at- tached to the running board directly under the cab on the opposite side, and the exhaust pipe from the Three-way Cock carried back into the cab. across the boiler butt, and down through the running board into the Reservoir. If the space on both sides is already occupied and it is impossible to locate the Reservoir below the running board dire.Sly^®cier-,th^ckb, and 'on locomotives having the Wooten type of firebox, the Reservoir should be attached below the running board forward of the Air Pump. The Reservoirs have two openings in one end and one opening in the other end. The Reservoir with the end having the two openings should be placed at the forward end, and the single'' opening on the rear end should be at the lozvest point. A pipe should be connected from the single opening on the rear end of the Reservoir direct to the train heating pipe under the locomotive tender. The Three-way Cock should be located in the exhaust pipe of the Air Pump and close to it, fitted with a rod leading back into the cab and a handle convenient for operation by the engineer (see Figure 20). A pipe should be connected from the Three-way Cock to one of the openings in the forward end of the Reservoir. Quar- ter-turns and tees should not be used with the pipe lead- ing from the Three-way Cock to the Reservoir, but the pipe should be bent if necessary. A pipe should be con- 80 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS nected from the other, or third opening in the Three-way Cock to the stack or saddle as heretofore, A pipe should be connected from the direct steam pres- sure regulator to one of the openings in the forward end of the reservoir, and from this same pipe a pipe should FIG. 20. SHOWS THE THREE-WAY COCK LOCATED IN THE EX- HAUST PIPE CLOSE TO THE AIR PUMP, WITH THE OP- ERATING ROD LEADING BACK INTO THE CAB. be connected to the "E. C. H." Relief Valve. A pipe should also be connected from the "E. C. H." Relief V^lve to vent the surplus steam either through the roof of the cab or forward into the saddle or stack, as may be preferred. HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 81 OPERATION. Before the train is started adjust the Pressure Regu- lator for the minimum pressure and the "E. C. H." Relief Valve for the maximum pressure required to heat the train. The steam pressure on the train heating sys- tem will therefore be confined between these two pressures. Pull back the handle of the Three-way Cock, to dis- charge the exhaust steam from the Air Pump into the Reservoir, and open the boiler valve in the direct heating system. To shut off the steam from the train, close the boiler valve and* push the handle of the Three-way Cock for- ward to discharge the exhaust from the Air Pump into the stack or saddle. The Three-way Cock must be kept in either the ex- treme forward or back position, as any intermediate posi- tion would close the exhaust pipe from the Air Pump. To increase the pressure on the train heating system, slacken the Cross Bar Check Nut of the U E. C. H." Relief Valve and turn the hand wheel from left to right ; to decrease the maximum pressure, turn the hand wheel from right to left and tighten the Cross Bar Check Nut. It will be found that average trains can be properly heated -with the exhaust steam from the Air Pump with- out opening the boiler valve in the direct steam heating system. In case, however, the Air Pump exhaust is not sufficient to maintain the required pressure, open the boiler valve and the Pressure Regulator will furnish live steam to supply the deficiency. The locomotive shown in Figures 21 and 22 has the air pump and Economy Car Heating Apparatus on the 82 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 83 84 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS left hand side. The three-way cock is located near the reservoir directly under the cab. The outlet of the "E. C. H." Relief Valve is piped to discharge the surplus steam through the roof of the cab. The locomotive shown in Figure 23 has air pump and Economy Car Heating Apparatus on the left hand side, with the three-way cock forward of and close to the air pump, and the exhaust pipe leading to the reservoir fitted with asbestos covering. When the Economy Car Heating System was first in- troduced, an ordinary open pop valve located outside, on top of the locomotive cab, was used as a relief valve to vent the surplus pressure from the train heating sys- tem. Experience demonstrated that an adjustable relief valve, conveniently located for operation by the; engineer inside the cab, was both desirable and necessary to en- able him to vary the steam pressure to suit trains of different lengths. A steam pressure of 20 pounds would be ample to heat a train of two or three cars, but a steam pressure of 40 pounds or more might be necessary to in- sure a circulation of steam at the rear end of very long and heavy trains, especially in extremely cold weather. The "E. C. H/' Relief Valve, illustrated Figure 24, is an improved form of valve with duplex spring, especial- ly adapted for the Economy Car Heating System, for Avhich United States Letters Patent have been applied. The "E. C. H." Relief Valve is located inside the cab, with its pipe connections so arranged that the surplus steam from the train heating system will be discharged either through the roof of the cab or into the saddle or front end of the locomotive, if it is desired to avoid the noise and annoyance of the escaping steam. Its peculiar merits over all single spring relief valves are the increased range of steam pressures at which it will HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 85 6* [Hi • «£'* cLmJ Wm ■ IPt ' BfEf ' H ! '■■ '^ : -".~ •„ 8 pn - :■ : r W < a o j o o a E 86 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS work satisfactorily without change of spring and the ease with which it can be adjusted for any desired change of working steam pressure. FIG. 24. "E. C. II. RELIEF VALVE. It will give an automatic and ///// relief at any steam pressure between 15 and 60 pounds per square inch. This is accomplished by the duplex spring, the outer spring be- ing under tension at all pressures, while the inner spring HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS £7 (of smaller diameter) is tinder tension only at the higher pressures. The springs are adjusted for the valve to relieve at the desired pressure, by means of a hand wheel on the top, outside of the valve body. To obtain a higher working pressure, slacken the Cross Bar Check Nut and turn the hand wheel from left to right; for a lower working pres- sure turn the hand wheel from right to left and tighten the Cross Bar Check Nut. Another important feature of the "E. C. H." Relief Valve is that it can be taken apart and cleaned if necessary without disconnecting the pipe connections at either the inlet or outlet. The "E. C. H." Relief Valve is made entirely of high grade composition metal with springs of Jessop's steel. gold's steam heating apparatus. As in other systems of heating the cars with steam from the locomotive, the equipment on the engine and tender is not complicated, but is, on the contrary, quite simple. All pipes should pitch to avoid w r ater pockets and any exposed pipes should be covered well. Fig. 25 shows the method of taking steam at the fountain, by means' of a locomotive starting valve, with a Tobin bronze spindle. This valve also has a hard metal seat and a malleable iron handle. The inlet is screwed into a 2-inch port in the fountain, and from this inlet runs a 1 ]/ 2 -inch extra heavy pipe to the inlet of the regulator. The pressure regulator is provided with brass unions at both sides, the inlet being j J / 2 inches and the outlet 2 inches. A 2-inch nipple runs from the pressure regulator outlet to 2 tee which is tapped for *4-inch pipe connection 88 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS J > Eh o c j u T3 c e h! o' * lO . c *• » tf H CM ► „ X it X i v?»N c K * *? B 5 v 5 fl «aj CM CNI CM ~ U 2 « O M 03 h P 5 P rH 03 >d" p. q P a) Qj "S U 3 P. X rt p p p s ft 2 3 P 5 . CD t- O O l> 00 CO CO CD io m io in in io GOLD'S IMPROVED TEMPERATURE REGULATOR & STOP VALVE. POSITION li" R.&L. COUPLING. 2"x/' TEE V TO POUT LE 60" STEAM GAUGE STRAINER CROSS C A P. TEMPERATURE REGULATOR STRAINER NIPPLE. Z"*S''lj-'ni" CROSS w/1 BOTTOM OUTLET ('STRAINER STOP V dfth 5 O O _ * O O £ o p u Pi H <: & e-< o c do P K f> O P O o 102 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OE TRAINS HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 103 combination automatic lock and hose support (gold's). This device is designed to accomplish two purposes — the automatic locking of. steam hose couplers and the proper support of the hose and coupler. The advent of larger hose and heavier couplers neces- sary to heat the long passenger trains now in common use made the problem of tight joints and hose protection one of greater importance than ever before, and, taken in connection with the higher steam pressures carried in the train line to satisfactorily effect the heating of these long trains, the jarring on fast runs causes con- siderable leakage of steam, especially in passing around curves. In the new arrangement the hose is relieved of the weight of the couplers both when coupled and when separated, the couplers being supported by means of a chain attached to the platform and sill, and a con- nection between the chain and coupler is made by means of a lever or lock hinged onto the coupler attached to the same car and bearing on the mating coupler of the adjacent car in 'such a manner as to force the gaskets into close contact. This removes all the weight from the hose, and presses the gaskets together with a force much greater than that due to their weight and the action of the cam and wedge, which are still retained as integral parts of the coupler. Figure 35 shows the device and Figure 36 shows it attached to a car. 104 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 105 FIG. 36. COMBINATION AUTOMATIC LOCK AND HOSE SUPPORT ATTACHED TO A CAR. VAPOR SYSTEM OF CAR HEATING. This is a system of car heating which is manufactured by the Chicago Car Heating Co. It is an exceedingly simple apparatus, and the principle upon which the sys- tem operates is equally simple. 106 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS The temperature of the escaping condensation from the heating pipes is used to operate and control in an auto- matic manner the inflow of the steam from the train pipe to the heating* pipes which are inside the car, in- stead of its being used to control the outlet or discharge. Thus the entire heating pipes are left open to the atmos- phere all the time and the condensation flows out by gravity immediately it reaches the lowest points of the heating pipes, and in consequence of the entire absence of w T ater in the pipes through ''backing up" the possi- bility of freezing is completely done away with. The pipes are automatically filled with steam at atmospheric pressure (which is equal to 212 degrees, or the same temperature as boiling water), thus a very agreeable heat is radiated. The heat of the escaping condensation has, in other systems, been used to automatically operate some form of a trap or discharge valve located in the outlet or the lowest part of the heating pipes, which has resulted in carrying about the same pressure in the radiating pipes inside the cars as was carried in the train pipe located underneath the cars. In the vapor system train pipe pressure only reaches the inlet of the radiating system, as shown in the com- parison of systems in Plate VI, but in the case of the steam pressure system train pipe pressure goes through the entire radiating system to the outlet. This method of carrying train pipe pressure in the heating pipes in- side the car has frequently resulted in the cars being over-heated, because of the high train pipe pressure neces- sary. The trap or valve which has been placed at the outlet has, it is claimed, caused more or less backing HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 107 .**■?* % FIG. 37. VAPOR HEATING — SECTIONAL VIEW, 108 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS u 2 U .2 O the operating rod an up of water in the pipes, and this has often resulted in the apparatus being frozen. Figure 37 shows a sectional view of the piping arrangement. The ex- pansive diaphragm (see Figure 38) is combined with and adapted to other parts of the apparatus to con- trol the admission of steam. It is placed at the very outlet of the ap- paratus underneath the car, where it is subject to the combined influ- ence of the cold outside air and the hot condensation pressing over and around it before it reaches the "at- mosphere. The steam entering the pipes passes through the hand operated admission valves in the usual way and into the Vapor Regulator, where it passes up through the automatic valve and out of the regulator again, then through the feed pipe to the radiating pipes along the truss plank, finally reaching the bottom of the regulator and passing down through the discharge pipe and around the expansive diaphragm and out to the atmosphere. Instantly the hot con- densation and steam reach the dia- phragm at the very bottom of the apparatus, it expands it about a quar- ter of an inch, causing it to push up d close down the automatic valve, thus HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 109 closing the supply of steam to the radiating pipes at the inlet of the Vapor Regulator. The instant the supply of steam to the radiating pipes is thus shut off, the dia- phragm in the outlet of the apparatus starts to cool, and contracts just enough to permit sufficient steam to pass the automatic inlet valve to make up for whatever is lost in condensation in the radiating pipes and still main- tain a temperature of 200 degrees at the outlet point un- derneath the car at which the diaphragm is located. Less than 200 degrees temperature around the diaphragm at the bottom causes it to contract and open the admis- sion valve until sufficient steam is passing into the ap- paratus to give 200 degrees at the very outlet. A tem- perature of much over 200 degrees at the outlet expands the diaphragm and cuts down the admission of steam until the temperature at the outlet reaches 200 degrees. Therefore the temperature of the outlet of the apparatus (which contains the diaphragm. Figure 38) is automati- cally maintained at a temperature of about 200 degrees, and necessarily all the pipes between this outlet and the inlet are maintained at a temperature of between 200 degrees at the outlet point, and about 212 degrees at the inlet point. DETAILS OF OPERATION. The Vapor Regulator is divided by partitions into, three parts (see Figure 39), a high pressure chamber di- rectly under the automatic valve "A," a low pressure or supply chamber directly above the automatic valve, and an outlet chamber where the return or drain pipe from the heating pipes inside of the car is connected to the regulator. 110 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS TO RADIATING PI PC lATirtofT S ^l , c ,\-y- Throttle Admis- sion Valve Con> pletc -Valve with B— Disc C— Disc Nut D— Bonnet E— Stuffing Box F— Valve Stem G— Wheel H— Body WZ— Automatic Regulator U)2 -A— Regulai ~2 B— Cast iron Regulator Body 2-C— Top Cover —Operating Rod —Expansive Diaphra —Set Screw 2-G — Bearing for Lever 2-H— Cam Lock 402-1— Ventilating Wings 402-J— Lower cast iron Casting 402- K— Hinged Cover with Set Screw and Cam Lock 402-L— Hooks to Prevent Dia- phram from Shifting /CRC55 5EXTI0IN ' / OF CAR AT CCriTE.*%! M— Plates to hold Dia- phram in Horizontar Position N— Tube Cut to Template O— Regulating Valve P— Operating Rod Lever Q-Stuffing Box R— Guides for Oper Rod S— Bolts for top Plate T-Brass Valve Seat U— Lock Nut for Set Screw V— Top Guide for Auto- matic Valve VV— Gasket for Top Cover FIG. 39. DETAILS OF VAPOR REGULATOR. HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 111 Steam leaves the train pipe at the strainer cross (No. in), and passes through the admission valve into the high pressure chamber. After passing through the auto- matically operated valve "A" into the low pressure cham- ber it passes out of the Vapor Regulator again, and through the feed pipes into the radiating pipes at the FIG. 39A. side of the truss pipe where it branches and flows to each end of the car, returning again to the center where it joins again in one pipe and flows through this pipe into the outlet chamber of the vapor regulator and down through the tube and around the expansive diaphragm and out to the atmosphere. 112 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS As already explained, the heating of the diaphragm to about 200 degrees at the outlet causes the closing of the automatic valve "A" sufficiently to pass just enough steam into the radiating pipes to circulate entirely through them and maintain a temperature of 200 degrees at the outlet point, and it should be remembered that if the temperature around this outlet drops below 200 de- grees the diaphragm will contract instantly just enough to open the automatic valve "A" to permit sufficient steam to pass into the apparatus to raise the temperature at the outlet to 200 degrees. Until the steam passes the automatic valve "A" it is, of course, under train pipe pressure, but after it passes the valve "A" it is under atmospheric pressure, and in just sufficient quantity to pass entirely through the pipes and give the required 200 degrees at the outlet. It is found that this automatically maintained tempera- ture of 200 degrees at the outlet point underneath the car gives an actual temperature of about 208 degrees in the bottom or coolest pipes inside the car and 212 de- grees in the top of the pipes where the steam first enters, and a temperature of 213 degrees immediately after the steam leaves the automatic valve, and these tem- peratures are found to remain the same regardless of what pressure or temperature the steam may be when it enters the Vapor Regulator from the train pipe. This condition of affairs continues indefinitely as long as steam is on the apparatus. As the radiating pipes are open to the atmosphere it will be readily understood that their temperature can never exceed 212 degrees at the hottest point. Inasmuch as at no time is there any pressure backed up in the radiating pipes, and as the outlet point is auto- HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 113 viatically maintained at a normal temperature of 200 degrees, necessarily the discharge at the outlet must be nothing but actual condensation which will do no injury to varnish or sheathing. Tliis overcomes a serious de- fect in steam traps which always discharge condensation wider a pressure — resulting in scorching the side of car. The passage for the discharge of condensation from the pipes to the atmosphere contains no trap valve or stoppage of any kind, and condensation is free to escape by gravity from the pipes to the atmosphere, as will be seen from the cut. Motion from the diaphragm at the outlet, to the auto- matic valve "A" at the inlet, is transmitted through the dividing partition by means of the lever "P" passing through the stuffing box "Q." As the pressure is inappreciable on either side of this stuffing box, and as the motion of the axis of the operating lever amounts to almost nothing, it will be evident that the wear of this packing is practically nothing and need not be considered as a feature needing attention after the device is in service. When valve 4 is a quarter of an inch, the weight of the rod D will keep the valve A open when the diaphragm is cold. To remove the auto- matic valve unscrew the brass guide cap V, open the hinge cover K at the bottom, allowing the rod D to drop down, then the automatic valve A can be easily lifted out. To get at the entire inside of the top part of vapor regulator, remove the brass stud bolts S, allowing the top plate to be removed. The Expansive Diaphragm. — Figure 38, already re- ferred to, is round, being about four inches in diameter and three-quarters of an inch thick, is made of phosphor bronze, and is filled about half full of a mixture of 114 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS which alcohol forms the greater part, and it is hermeti- cally sealed. This mixture boils at a temperature of about 180 de- grees, and when confined in the diaphragm and sub- jected to a surrounding temperature of between 200 and 212 degrees, a sufficient internal pressure is created to cause the diaphragm to expand about three-eighths of an inch and when the diaphragm is placed in the device and adjusted with the set screw so that the maximum movement cannot exceed a quarter of an inch, it will exert sufficient force to close a three-quarter inch valve seat against a pressure of as high as a hundred and twenty pounds to the square inch. As the temperature surrounding the diaphragm falls, it begins to contract until at 180 degrees it is again at its original or normal thickness of three-fourths of an inch. Plate VII shows the Vapor System applied to a stand- ard passenger coach. The details of the Vapor Regu- lator are shown in the sectional view, Figure 39. HEATING CARS WITH ELECTRICITY. FIRST PRINCIPLES. The conversion of electrical energy to heat takes place in accordance with well known laws, and in known pro- portions. One British Thermal Unit of heat is equiva- lent to 1047.3 watts, and cannot be produced without the expenditure of that amount of energy. A resistance coil which will pass a certain amount of current may be made of a short length of wire of high resistance, or of a long wire of low resistance. If the resistances of the coils are equal, the same amount of current will flow through each, and each coil will give off the same amount of heat. Consequently a short coil of high-resistance wire having a small surface must necessarily operate at an excessively high temperature, in order to dissipate the same amount of heat as the longer coil of low-re- sistance w^ire having a much larger surface. In this prin- ciple lies the success of the Consolidated Electric Heaters, which have a large heating surface and operate at a moderate temperature. It is claimed by the manufacturers that experience has demonstrated that galvanized iron wire, which has been specially galvanized for the purpose, makes the best resistance coils, and that by reason of the large radiating surface made possible by the McElroy spiral coil construction, the wire is heated only to a moderate degree, thus the excessive temperature to which a high resistance wire is necessarily subjected, usually resulting 115 116 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS in crystallization of the wire if accompanied by vi- bration, is overcome. In each heater there are two resistance coils placed, one above the other. The upper coil is of greater re- sistance and consumes less current than the lower. The coverings of lead wires to the two coils are different colors, and thus may be easily distinguished. The top coils of all the heaters in the car are in series, and the bottom coils of all the heaters are in series. Thus, wherever current is used, heat is given out the full length of the casing of every heater in the car. At the same time this method of wiring is said to be the simplest and most econom- ical in time of equipping and material used. All this type of heaters are said to secure convenience, sim- plicity and durability. A coil for heater, show- ing resistance coil, porcelain bushings, end plates and lead fires is shown in Figure 40. HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 117 FIG. 41.A. ELECTRIC HEATER IN POSITION. FIG. 41B. HEATER ENCLOSED IN INSULATED IRON CASING ; WIRING SHOWN IN MOULDING. A heater for a cross-seat car or parlor car is shown in Figure 41. It is designed to attach to the truss plank, and is designed to occupy about the same space as the steam pipes do when the steam heating system is em- ployed. The coils are, it will be noticed, covered by an iron case of attractive design, which is insulated. 118 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS The arrangement for wiring when electricity is em- ployed for heating cars is shown by the diagrams in Figure 42. . The coupler shown in Figure 43 is used for the pur- pose of connecting the heat and light circuits in trains. jVWWMWj /WV.VAVV^ ^jVWW^jVV/.V.VVM^ 12-Heater Equipment WWNW WvV.VAw/kv/.v /' .v ;,' n— sar- Yf.f\ SWITCH 19-4 JWWWVW^ /WvV.V.vv.v.^ j .: ;; ■:•: ■ -.y -.v.- .-.■.•/ ■,< r -w;jw,v::q ; WWWWV j WWWWfl ft 16-Heater Equipment //j SWITCH 16*. ^— ' ^ -^ 18-Heater Equipment FIG. 42. DIAGRAMS OF WIRING ELECTRIC HEATING SYSTEM. With this coupler there are no exposed contacts. The contact finger is mounted on the inside of a protecting casing which is attached at the end of the car, either HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 119 120 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS under the platform sill or under the hood, and the open- ing to this casing is covered with a spring door On the end of the flexible cable is securely attached a hollow cylindrical contact piece which slides over the contact finger mounted in the protecting casing on the opposite car. This cylindrical contact piece is mounted securely in an insulating handle which covers it not only on the sides, but projects beyond the end of the contact piece leaving no portion of the contact piece unprotected. No danger of short circuit occurs either in handling it or in allowing the connector to drop to the rail, since the FIG. 44. A QUICK-BREAK KNIFE SWITCH. cylindrical contactor is not exposed at the ends. When the contacts are once made the action of the door is to hold the contactor securely in place. In case the cars should pull apart the connector pulls out of the socket automatically. A quick-break knife switch is illustrated in Figure 44. It has double contacts, and is intended for service on 600-volt circuits. Slate bases free from metallic veins are used to mount the switches upon, and as the HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 121 slates are drilled to a templet and counter-sunk all cur- rent carrying parts are brought below the surface on the back of the slate. It is considered by the manufac- turers advisable that all switches used for heating or lighting purposes should be placed on the bulkhead above the windows, either in the vestibule or the car body. CATECHISM OF STEAM HEATING. ON TRAINS EQUIPPED WITH THE STEAM HEATING SYSTEM OF THE SAFETY CAR HEATING AND LIGHTING COMPANY. DIRECTIONS FOR THE MANAGEMENT OF STEAM HEATING ON TRAINS. MAKING UP TRAINS. When a train is made up all steam hose should be coupled and all cocks or valves in the steam train pipe, the whole length of the train, should be opened. When signal is given steam should be turned on at the cab ' and allowed to blow through the entire length of the steam train pipe. After steam issues from the rear end of the train pipe, the rear train pipe valve of the last car should be closed. This valve is slotted and will allow a little steam to escape through the rear coupling. REGULATION OF TEMPERATURE. To heat cars, open steam inlet valve in each car and. regulate the temperature with this valve. Do not ask the engineer to vary the steam pressure for the purpose of regulating the temperature of cars. Steam inlet valves must riot be shut tight in freezing weather. 122 GENERAL ARRANGEMENT OF APPARATUS ON A CAR Fig. 45. A — Storage Tank. I — Branches from Main B — Filling Valve. K— Gas Cock. C — Tank Valve L— Lamp Burner. D — Extra Heavy Pipe. M — Vestibule Lamp. F — Outlet Pipe. O — Bracket Lamp. G — Main Cock. P— Gauge. H — Main Pipe. E — Regulator. HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 123 Traps should be set at terminal points so that a little steam will escape with the water. Readjustment is sel- dom necessary. CHANGING ENGINES. Five minutes before arriving at terminals or stations where engines are to be changed, the rear train pipe valve must be opened wide, and just before coming to a stop at such stations the engineer should shut off steam at locomotive valve. Do not use reducing valve for this purpose. This valve is to be set at 40 pounds when the engine is placed in service and not changed there- after, except in zero weather, when 5 pounds should be added for each additional car over eight. Trainmen should see that steam is shut off at engine before uncoupling hose. When cars are to be laid up all valves must be left open. CATECHISM OF STEAM HEATING APPARATUS OX TRAINS. I. DESCRIPTION OF THE APPARATUS. Question. What is the advantage of using steam heat on trains? i. Answer. Safety to trains as well as passengers by replacing the heat of the fire with the heat of steam, and for economy of operation. Ques. Haw are cars heated by steam? 2. Ans. Either by direct steam, that is the admission of steam to radiating pipes in car, or on cars w T ith Baker heaters, by means of steam jackets applied to the water circulation pipes. Ques. How should the jackets be applied? 3. Ans. They should be located at nearly equal dis- tances apart in the water circulating pipes, and to secure rapidity of circulation should have an upward slant of two or more inches in the direction the water flows. Ques. How do the jackets operate? 4. Ans. As the circulating water passes through the jackets, it is heated by the steam. The water does not come in direct contact with the steam. Ques. How is steam conducted to the jackets? 5. Ans. By a branch pipe from train pipe, leading through inlet valve to ends of jackets in series. Ques. How T many heating jackets are used on a car? 6. Ans. Ordinarily two or three with single coil heaters and twice the number with double coil heaters. 124 HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 125 Ques. In what direction does the water flow when using steam? 7. Ans. In the same direction as when using a fire in the heater. Where are the following" parts located (a), and what are their functions (b) ? Ques. Locomotive valve? 8. Ans. (a) At the steam box in cab 'or other source of dry steam supply. 9. Ans. (b) To control the supply of steam to train pipe. Ques. Reducing Valve? 10. Ans. (a) In cab. 11. Ans. (b) To control the pressure of steam in the train pipe. Ques. Train pipe? 12. Ans. (a) Underneath tender and cars. 13. Ans. (b) To conduct steam to the cars. Ques. How should the train pipe be applied? 14. Ans. So as to drain to each end of car, thereby avoiding pockets for the collection of condensation water, the prescribed measurements being closely followed in locating the ends of train pipes, in order to prevent the couplers from opening on curves. Ques. Steam couplers? 15. Ans. (a) At ends of train pipe. 16. Ans. (b) To connect train pipes between cars. Ques. Steam coupler safety chain? 17. Ans. (a) Under platform bufler timber; in ac- cordance with standard measurements. 18. Ans. (b) To prevent the steam coupler from being injured. 126 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS Ques. Train pipe valve? 19. Afis. (a) At ends of train pipes, in accordance with standard measurements. 20. Ans. (b) To close rear end of train pipe, and to control same without disturbing passengers, also for protection in handling steam couplers. Ques. Inlet regulating valve? 21. Ans. (a) Inside of cars — usually at heater room with cars having a Baker heater, and at inlet of radi- ators of cars having direct steam. 22. Ans. (b) To supply steam to heating jackets or direct steam pipes and to regulate the temperature in car. Ques. Steam traps? 23. Ans. (a) Horizontal Trap No. 833 is under- neath car at the lowest point in the steam transfer pipe, and should have a drain of two inches: 24. Ans. (ai) Vertical Trap No. 933 (used with direct steam only), at the lowest point in the steam radiators, extending through the car flooring. 25. Ans. (b) To automatically discharge the con- densation water from the heating jackets or direct steam heating pipes. Ques. Trap blow-off valve? 26. Ans. (a) At the inlet end of trap. 27. Ans. (b) To discharge the accumulation of dirt and scale from the trap. Ques. Trap adjustment? 28. Ans. (a) At the low end of trap. 29. Ans. (b) For setting so as to allow a little steam or vapor to escape w r ith the condensation water. Ques. When should the trap be set.? HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 127 30. Ans. When cars are tested with steam previous to being placed in service. Oues. Why? 31. Ans. So that it will not be necessary to adjust the trap on the road. Oues. How should the trap be set? 32. Ans. First open the adjustment wide; then after all pipes have become hot close it down until a little vapor escapes with the water of condensation. Oues. What causes the trap to operate automatically? 33. Ans. The difference in expansion between the brass tube and the iron shell enclosing it. II. OPERATION OF THE APPARATUS. Oues. When should the reducing valve in cab be set? 34. Ans. When the engine is placed in service. Ones. - At what pressure should the reducing valve be set? 35. Ans. Forty pounds. Oues. Under what conditions should the pressure on reducing valve be increased? 36. Ans. When there are more than eight cars, add- ing 5 pounds for each additional car in zero weather. Oues. Should the reducing valve on engine be closed? 37. Ans. It should never be used as a shut-off valve. Ques. What valve should control the supply of steam to train pipe? 38. Ans. The locomotive valve. Oues. When should the locomotive valve be closed? 39. Ans. Five minutes before arriving at points where engines are to be changed, or terminals where 128 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS train is to lay up and always before hose are uncoupled. Ones. Should the locomotive valve be closed under any other condition? 40. Ans. Never while heat is required in tne cars, except in cases of emergency. Oues. Why ? 41. Ans. To prevent condensation water in train pipe from freezing. Oues. When should steam be admitted to train pipe ? 42. Ans. After all steam hose are coupled and all inlet and train pipe valves are open, signal the engineer to open locomotive valve. Ques. What is the next move? 43. Ans. Close end train pipe valve on rear car after train pipe is thoroughly blown out. Oues. How is the end train valve operated? 44. Ans. By the extension handle operated at step side, or through an opening in step riser, thereby pre- venting the passengers from tampering with same from inside of vestibule. Oues. When should the condensation water be blown out of the train pipe? 45. Ans. When the train is made up, also on ap- proaching and before leaving points where engines are changed or the train laid up, and occasionally on the road, the rear valve only being used for this purpose. Oues. When should traps be adjusted? 46. Ans. Traps should be inspected often to see if a little steam or vapor is being discharged with the water of condensation and reported at terminals if not working properly. Only adjust traps on the road when absolutely necessary. HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 129 Ques. Why should a little steam issue from the rear train pipe valve on the road? 47. Ans. To prevent the accumulation of condensa- tion water and to have live steam throughout the entire length of the train pipe in order to avoid freezing. Ques. What temperature should be maintained in cars? 48. Ans. About 70 degrees Fahrenheit, with proper ventilation. Ques. How should this temperature be regulated? 49. Ans. By adjusting the inlet valve. Ques. When the steam supply is cut off from cars having Baker heaters, what should be done? 50. Ans. Start a fire in the heater. III. CARE OF THE APPARATUS. What test or inspection should be given the parts fol- lowing? Ques. Reducing valve? 51. Ans. It should be taken apart and thoroughly cleaned, oiled and tested before the steam heat season opens. Ques. Gauge ? 52. Ans. Should be tested with test gauge before season opens and occasionally in service. Ques. Valves ? 53. Ans. Before season opens, all valves and seats should be repaired, or renewed if necessary, and all valve stems repacked. Ques. Traps (horizontal No.* 833, vertical No. 933) ? 54. Ans. Remove adjustment from low end and 130 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS valve from high end of trap, allowing steam to blow through until thoroughly cleaned, and renew 7 Jenkins' discs if necessary. Ques. Steam couplers ? 55. Ans. These should be removed from cars at the end of the season and stored at the shop after being- repaired and tested and made ready for the next season. Cap or plug the opening in the end train pipe valve. Ques. What is the proper method of filling heater pipes with water ? 56. Ans. At the beginning of the steam heat season, open all draw-off cocks on water circulating pipe. After water is drained, blow steam through water circulating- pipes, making attachment at draw-off cocks nearest heater. When pipes are clean, shut off steam, close draw- off cocks, remove safety valve in circulating drum and run a half-inch pipe thence to a coil in a barrel of water. Then turn on steam again and boil water in barrel. After this, disconnect steam and close draw-off cocks and the- water in barrel will syphon into and fill circu- lating pipes. After standing some time, the water, hav- ing cooled, will contract to some extent and a small amount of water may then be poured in through the combination cock. Then turn on steam at inlet valve and if water circulates quickly the pipes are properly filled. If water does not circulate properly, let water out of pipes and repeat operation. Ques. How often should inspections be made to ascer- tain that water is at the proper height in circulating drums ? 57. Ans. During the heating* season they should be examined when cars reach terminals or yard,s. HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 131 Ones. Should Baker heater pipes be kept filled with water during summer? 58. Ans. Yes, as they will not rust so rapidly as when empty. IV. RESPONSIBILITY OF EMPLOYES. What are the duties for which the following em- ployes are held responsible? Oues. The repair shop employes? 59. Ans. For the proper application of and for the thorough overhauling and testing of the heating ap- paratus when cars are in shop. Ones. The engineer? 60. Ans. For turning steam on or off at the loco- motive valve when the prescribed signals are given, and for supplying the proper amount of steam for healing the train. Oues. The conductor? 61. Ans. For knowing the pressure- of steam sup- plied to the train and seeing that the proper tempera- ture and ventilation is maintained and knowing that the other members of the crew are familiar with the opera- tion of the steam heating apparatus. Ones. The brakeman or flagman ? 62. Ans. For blowing the condensation water out of the train pipe before arriving at terminals or stations where engines are to be changed, also at stations where there are no car inspectors, and for leaving all valves open when cars are to be laid up. Oues. The round house inspector? 63. Ans. For the condition of the steam heating 132 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS equipment on the engine before it leaves the round house, and knowing that an extra steam coupler is carried. Ques. The car inspector? 64. Ans. For the condition of the car heating ap- paratus and for blowing the condensation water out of train pipe before trains leave terminals and stations ; for knowing that an extra steam coupler is carried on train and for having a supply of steam couplers and gaskets on hand. LIGHTING PASSENGER CARS. The Pint sch Gas Lighting System. The general ar- rangement of this system of lighting is shown in Figure 45, which also shows the general relation of the parts. "A" represents the storage tank, in which a sufficient supply of gas is carried to maintain the lights in the car the desired length of time, the number and size of the tanks varying in proportion to the requirements of the service. The gas is supplied to these tanks under pressure at regular filling stations, a hose connection be- ing made between the supply pipe and the filling valve "B," which iii turn are connected with the storage tank by means of the extra heavy pipe "D" connecting into the tank valve "C." The pressure in the tank is at all times indicated on the gauge "P." From a branch in pipe "D" the gas is conducted through the reducing valve or regulator "R," in which the pressure is so reduced and governed as to maintain a constant pressure of one- third of an ounce on the outlet pipe U F," irrespective of the pressure in the tank. The regulator controls the gas pressure on the lamps in a perfectly uniform and automatic manner, whether the pressure in the tank is two pounds or one hundred and fifty pounds. From the regulator the gas passes into the car at any convenient point and terminates in a main pipe "H" extending along and on the roof of the car, from which branches "I" are taken ofif at each lamp, connection being made to one of the arms of the lamp, designated as the gas-way 133 134 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS arm, which contains a tube through which the gas passes down into the burner of the lamp kk L.'' The gas is turned off and on by means of a gas cock "K" on the gas-arm of each lamp, but if desired all of the lamps can be regulated at once by means of the maincock "G" placed in the pipe "F" shown on the wall, or the gas can be shut off entirely at this same point. "O" represents a bracket lamp for use in toilet rooms and passage ways. "M" is a vestibule lamp used for lighting the platform and vestibule of a car. The arrangement of the gas holder (or holders), the regulator, piping for gas under pressure, filling valves, etc., is shown in Figures 46, 47, 48 and 49. The way the connections are made for an equipment as shown in Figure 45 is shown in Figures 46, 47 and 48 as indi- cated by the full or solid lines. The method of con- necting a second holder on that side of the car is like- wise shown as indicated by the broken lines in Figure 46. Two holders, one on each side, are shown in Figure 49 as indicated by the full lines, and a third holder on one side is shown also, as indicated by the broken lines. These holders are usually hung about one inch from the sheathing, as far as possible away from the sides of the car, the inlet connection end being away from the nearest truck, and the flat side of the angle iron upwards. Figures 48 and 49. show forms of the hang- ing irons, and another form is shown in Figure 50. The holder valve (53b), Figure 51, is attached to the holder by a flange (3) which is screwed on the holder inlet bushing, and a flange (3a) which is screwed on (53b) in a similar manner, the whole being secured with screws (150). The regular board is shown in HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 135 136 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 137 detail in Figure 52. The recess, in one face of this board, receives the upper part of the regulator cover. This board with the regulator attached is secured to the car body (see Figures 46, 48 and 49) by means of straps (243) and lags (180) passing through both the board and the straps and lags (179) passing through the straps only. Filling valve brackets (118a) are located FIG. 50. as desired, but they have to be far enough back to insure that the filling valve does not project beyond the edge of the car body. The brackets are usually located between the end of the holder and a needle beam. The gauge should be enclosed in a box with a glass face and screwed to the under side of the car as shown in Figure 47. The pipes are bent for gas under pressure, as shown in Figures 46, 47, 48 and 49. All pipes are usually made to drain to the holder fittings (53b) and the gauge pipe must drain to -the fitting (12). The threads on the bent pipes are tinned, and are fitted in place after the flanges are screwed on. The brass flanges, etc., are thoroughly soldered to the pipes when all the -pipes for gas under 138 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS pressure have been fitted. The pipe leading to No. 65 is put through (118a) before No. 9 is soldered on. Filling bracket (118a) is then securely fastened to the car and all the pipes strapped up securely. OLD FORM. PRESENT FORM. FIG. 51. The filling valve and cover (65) (89) are attached by removing the cover (89) from the valve (65) and bolting valve to the bracket. This is done by opening- port covers P and T, unscrewing and removing packing nut R (but set screw B should not be unscrewed nor should valve stem nut M be loosened), screws (148) are HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 139 taken out and Xo. 89 is held to the back flange of the Xo. 65 valve and the threaded end of the valve is rapped on a block of wood. The number and character of fixtures required for the proper equipment of any car depends upon the class or kind of the car, the divisions of its space (as into state- rooms, toilets, smoking-rooms, passageways, etc.), the spacings of the ceilings or headlinings, and the amount of light required in the particular service for which the car is destined. 140 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS The consumption for each kind of lamp is about as follows : 4 flame lamps, 2y 2 cubic feet per hour. 2 flame lamps, \]A cubic feet per hour. Vestibule lamps, i cubic foot per hour. I flame bracket, J4 of a cubic foot per hour.' Argand bracket, 2^ cubic feet per hour. The necessary number and sizes of holders or tanks is figured from, the above calculated results, combined with the following: A holder 9' 6" long, 20J/2" diam. contains when filled to 10 atm.* 21 1.8 cubic feet. A holder 8' 6" long, 20]/ 2 " diam. contains when filled to 10 atm. ife cubic feet. A holder 7' 10" long, 20J/2" diam. contains when filled to 10 atm. 175 cubic feet. *Ten atmospheres is the standard pressure to which cars are rilled, and is therefore taken as the basis of calculation. The term "Atmosphere" (atm.) is used to indicate the pres- sure of the gas in the holders. Each atmosphere as indicated by the Pintsch gauges is 14 7/10 pounds per square inch above the outside air. The gauge, connected with a holder into which its own cubical contents of gas has been forced, will indicate one atmosphere increase in pressure. If twice its cubical con- tents has been forced in, then the gauge will show two atmos- pheres increase in pressure. If ten times, then ten atmospheres. Each atmosphere of pressure indicated, multiplied by the cubical volume of the holder or holders, gives the available gas supply. Example — A car with two holders, each of 13.8 cubic feet of volume, and tilled to S atmospheres, has on hand as available gas 2x18.8x8 = 300.8 cubic feet. When filled to 10 atmos- pheres these holders would contain 37G cubic feet, and would supply five four-flame lamps, two vestibule lamps and two bracket lamps, consuming altogether 16 cubic feet an hour, for about 24 hours' full burning. HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 141 A holder 7' 2*4" long, 2oy 2 " diam. contains when filled to 10 atm. 157 cubic feet. A holder 6' 1" long, 20^" diam. contains when filled to 10 atm. 135 cubic feet. FIG. 53. SHOWING A TWO-FLAME ORDINARY PIXTSCH GAS LAMP, IN BAGGAGE CAR. A holder & 1" long, i8)4" diam. contains when filled to 10 atm. no cubic feet. A holder & 1" long, 163/2" diam. contains when filled to 10 atm. 88.5 cubic feet. 142 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS One of the ordinary style two-flame burners is shown in Figure 53, illustrating its application to a baggage car. % Special inverted mantle burners for use with Pintsch gas are now used. By their use it is claimed a steady white light is produced and the candle increased more than three fold. The regulator has to be arranged so as to give an outlet pressure of one pound per square inch. 2667 2667 iEx.StrongPi'pc FIG. 54. THE REGULATOR USED WITH TFIE MANTLES FOR INVERTED BURNERS. See Figure 54. This illustration shows the gas pipe connections for two mantle lamps, as shown in Figure 55, which gives the details of the lamp, arrangement of parts and shows the flow T of gas. The delivery of gas is the same as for ordinary lamps, until it reaches fitting SECTIONAL, VIEW OF LAMP- 3 PARTS SHOWN. 2603a — Opal Bowl. 2615 — Gas Tip. 2725 — 6% in. Ventilator^ 26 — % in. Nipple, 6 in. long. 2621 — Mantle and Globe ] 2747 — Lamp Body. 2748 — Gas Strainer. 79—% in. Extra Strong Pipe. 2640— Mantle. 2749 — Extension Pillar. 2667—% in. x % in. 2750 — Spring Lock. Flange. 2752— Outer Globe Ring.. 2VO0— Incnnrlestenl Cos Bulb, 2753 — Inner Globe Ring. Nos 2603a. 2621, 2640 2823— Shield. and 2753. 2911 — Ventilating BelK 1862— Woodscrew for Ventilating 2918 — Lower Thimble. HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 143 2615, which has at its end nearest the burner a very fine drilling through which the gas issues, mixing itself with the air which burns with a jet downwardly into the globe 2603 A. The mantle is designated by 2640. FIG. 56. SHOWING PROPER FLAME. The proper flame from the burner is shown in Figure 56. This flame has seven short light blue cones sur- rounded by a very light gaseous flame. To light the lamps : If the main cock is closed it should be opened full, then the lamp cock should be opened, and the flame of a match or taper held just' 144 RILES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS FIG. 57. INVERTED BURNER LAMPS IN PASSENGER COACH. HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 145 at the bottom opening of each small globe, the flame only being allowed to extend into the globe. To extinguish lights: Simply turn off the gas at each o-as cock. - } r * j \.-;K /mm: .: ... J0W* pi- ; '.-...",. i S^/f. ■■■^M fflb '■■..;. ;,-. = . : p ** m "' itiiTTn ~'^ t- r; ■>;■ !■•"■■ -■ ;■ III _ — ; ■'„„■•, i - _— • ■ , - FIG. 58. INVERTED BURNER LAMPS IN DINING CAR. Care of mantles : When a burner becomes defective it is indicated by an inferior light. In which case a new bulb should be substituted. To do this the light should be extinguished and when cool enough the glass bulb and its holder should be removed. Care should be taken 146 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS to see that the holder unscrews with the bulb. Then light all flames and if any are found to be defective, there is probably some obstruction in the gas supply. In which case, it should be reported at the terminal, as should all other matters in connection with the lighting apparatus needing attention. When a new bulb is sub- stituted it should be screwed slowly on the lamp with the flame burning. Two styles of lamps in which inverted mantles are used in connection with Pintsch gas are shown in Fig- ures 57 and 58, one illustrating the lighting of a pas- senger coach, and the other a dining car. INSTRUCTIONS TO FOREMEN AND INSPECTORS FOR THE USE OF PINTSCH GAS EQUIPMENT AT TERMINAL POINTS. When a gas car arrives at a terminal, the lamps should be thoroughly cleaned and carefully looked over, and if any parts are found to be defective, repairs must be made promptly. After testing, and replacing all de- fects, close cock at each lamp separately, then close main cock in gent's toilet room, using gas key furnished for that purpose. See. Trainmen's Rule posted in toilet room in regard to turning off lamps first, then shut off main cock. Also that mantle lamps must be turned on full, or turned off entirely. Lampmen and Inspectors must report immediately if a car is found with lamps turned on and main cock turned off in toilet room, and report made to Car Fore- man or Master Car Builder. HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 147 The small pipes under the car connecting the tanks, regulator, and filling valves are made of ]/a in. extra heavy iron pipe with brass flanges soldered on to connect the pipes together. A small lead washer is used between the faces of the flanges to make a tight joint, slot headed bolts used to draw the flanges together. Should a leak be discovered in these flanges, the leak may be stopped by tightening the slot headed bolts in the brass flanges with a screw 7 driver. If jeak does not then stop, remove old and apply new washer. Should it become necessary to disconnect these pipes to re-solder a joint or to replace a washer, ihe gas will have to be shut off at tank valves. This must be done by removing cap from tank valve which will expose stem of tank valve, turn these stems to the right until valves are closed, using same kind of brass key as in toilet room. After these connections are repaired, turn on the gas at tank valves, replace valve caps and see that all joints are tight. Never use 3. light to locate leaks. Depend on the sense of smeii or use soap suds applied with a brush. If a filling valve should be found to be leaking it may be stopped by being turned down tighter by brass key from toilet room. These valves are left hand, to shut them off turn them to the left. Should a filling valve leak so badly that it cannot be repaired the gas must be turned off at the tanks, and the Foreman notified. 1-48 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS INSTRUCTIONS TO TRAINMEN FOR THE CARE OF PINTSCH GAS CAR EQUIPMENT. Read instructions to trainmen in regard to lighting lamps and emergency outfit which is posted in toilet rooms. Before the gas is turned on at the main cock in the toilet room see that all lamps in the main part of the car and the bracket lamps in the passageways and toilet rooms are turned off. After the gas has been turned on at the main cock in the toilet room all lamps may be lighted. Should one of the lamps be leaky or defective, turn it off and report it at the next terminal point to the Car Foreman, or the man in charge of the lamps. Should lights fail when there is gas in the tanks, thaw out the gas regulator under the car with steam or hot water. Should "a leak be discovered in any part of the car the gas must be shut off at once at the main cock in the toilet room. Should a leak occur in the filling valve under the car or in the connections between the gas tanks, the gas must be turned off at both tanks. To do this, take brass key from, toilet room, using large socket to un- screw caps of tank -valves. After these have been re- moved, the stems of the tank valves will be exposed, then use the small socket of the key to shut off valves turning them to the right. Torches or lamps of any kind must not be used while working around the connections and tanks under the car, and any employe looking for a leak with a light will be discharged. HEAIING AND LIGHTING CARS 149 In turning off the light turn off each lamp separately. After that is done turn off the gas at the main cock in the toilet room. Should the odor of gas be detected in any part of the car, report it promptly to the Car Foreman, In- spector, or man in charge of lamps, at the next terminal point. Trainmen must use discretion in regard to using the light during their respective runs. In first class and second class coaches where there are four or five centre lamps in the body of the car it will be sufficient to have two lamps burning after up. m. The balance should be shut off entirely. In sleeping cars lamps should be turned out in the main body of the car, as per general instructions. After 12 o'clock midnight the lamps in sleeping car smoking rooms should also be turned out. GOLD'S IMPROVED SYSTEM OF ACETYLENE CAR LIGHTING. The gas generator may be either inclosed in a locker, toilet room, or any other convenient part of a car or may be put in one corner of a car without being enclosed in any way. Its appearance is neat, the absence of moving parts or complicated valves makes it possible to place it in any desired position in a car. All the charg- ing and cleaning is done from the outside of the car, as the only inside connections are permanent ones. The charging and cleaning is done by car men and is onlv done at terminals. The gas is made by the generators only as needed and the apparatus needs no attention from trainmen, beyond the lighting and putting out of lamps. The amount of carbide a generator will hold is enough for several nights, and recharging may be done at any point to which carbide can be shipped, thus no charging plants are necessary. It is claimed by the makers that a burner will last for years without renewal, thus there is no occasion for continual renewal of burner parts as in the mantle system. Figure 59 shows the interior of a second class coach with gas generator installed. The cylindrical generator passing through the car from floor to roof ; the water tank over the door, the condenser in the corner of the clear deck, gas outlet pipe from the generator to the bottom of the condenser and gas pipe coming out the side of the condenser. A cut-out cock is shown on the 150 HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 151 gas pipe to the condenser for cutting off the generator at terminal when being charged. A charge of 140 pounds of carbide is put into the generator from the roof of the car. The water tank holding sufficient supply of water has an extension up through the roof where 'water is also supplied from FIG. 59. INTERIOR OF COACH. WITH GAS GENERATOR INSTALLED. without. An outlet is provided beneath the floor of the car for cleaning out the residue at the end of long runs, or after four or five nights' heavy service, as cars equipped with these generators are in transcontinental service as well as running on remote branch lines. When the car equipped with this generator leaves the terminal, 152 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS train crews and porters light or turn off the gas the same as one does at his city residence ; the generator supplying the gas according to the consumption. All attendance to the generator is done by the car men while the cars are in the yards being cleaned. FIG. oO. TOP OF GENERATOR PROJECTING THROUGH ROOF OF SLEEPING CAR. HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 153 Figure 60 shows a view of a compartment sleeping car, the top of the generator, it will be noticed, is pro- jecting through the roof. This generator applied to a coach is shown in Figure 61. The simplicity of the gen- erator is plainly indicated with its carbide chamber at the top extended downward about three feet and ter- minating in a grating to form the bottom of this recep- tacle. The bottom being filled with water and connecting with the overhead supply tank which raises the water up to the grate where it comes in contact with the car- bide generating gas as it does so, and at the same time slacking the carbide, allowing the residue to drop down to the bottom of the generator. This forms a slight pressure above the water, causing it to recede until the gas is sufficiently drawn off in using, thus automatically regulating the making of gas according to the consump- tion. Other accompanying apparatus is used, but such as does not in any way complicate the installation as a whole. A condenser, storage reservoir and regulator to insure pure dry gas at a steady pressure, giving the soft white light characteristic of this gas. In the event of accidents there is no escape of highly compressed gas to be contended with. The generator is provided with a safety valve which would not allow building up any high pressure under any emergency, and the system which causes the water to recede when a pressure is built up which exceeds the weight of the column of water due to the height of the water supply perfectly controls the ordinary pressure of gas in the system. Cars equipped with the Pintsch gas system can be 154 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS < 55 O H O Q «! O O O b* Q H 3 Oh O H <^ o 2 HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 155 converted to this system when desired, the same lamps being changed over to suit, or new ones of special de- sign substituted. THE SAFETY STORAGE SYSTEM OF ACETYLENE LIGHTING FOR RAILWAY CARS. This system of lighting is similar to other gas storage systems, in that it consists of a cylindrical tank charged with gas, in connection with which are a pressure regu- lating valve and pressure gauge, all of which are placed under the car. FIG. 62. SAFETY STORAGE TANK BROKEN TO SHOW THE ASBESTOS DISCS. The tanks used in the Commercial Acetylene Com- pany's patented safety storage system contain no free gas. They are packed with asbestos discs, as shown in Figure 62, before the ends are brazed in. This asbestos is then saturated with acetone (a species of wood alco- hol) which, at ten atmospheres, or 150 pounds pressure, absorbs twenty-five times its own volume of the gas at a normal temperature, thereby increasing the storage capacity of the tank ten-fold. The regular railway cyl- inder is a trifle smaller than those used in other gas storage systems, measuring 114" in length by 20" in diameter; at a charging pressure of 150 pounds it will contain 2,000 cubic feet of gas. 156 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS Though the tremendous storage capacity is realized, what it really means is better understood when the high candle power of the gas is appreciated. For instance, one cubic foot yields 50 candle power. Thus a tank of 2,000 cubic feet equals 100,000 candle power ; enough to light a car for several transcontinental trips. • *ss^r ^iftS^ ^_ -\ FIG. 63. CHARGING PLANT OF THE N. Y., N. H. & H. R. R. f PROVIDENCE, R. I., SHOWING 5,000 CU. FT. HOLDER. The generating and compressing plant consists of a two-story building for the generating, with a one-story addition for the compressing room, with room for motor on side, and a shed containing the storage cylinders in back. (See Figures 63, 64, 65, 66 and 67.) HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 157 E — Generators. El — 4" Gate Valves. E2 — 3" Gate Valves. E3 — 4" Flanged Unions. E4 — 3" Flanged Unions. F — Cushion Holder Tank. FT — Bell of Cushion Holder. F2 — 4" Inlet to Cushion Holdei. F3 — 3" Outlet from Cushion Holder. G — Meter. H — Dryer Cylinders. I — Scrubber. II — 3" Main to Compressor. J — Compressor. Jl — %" H. P. Line to Storage Cylinders. J2 — Oil Separators. J3— %" H. P. Globe Valves. J4 — 1/ ( " h. P. Globe Valves. J5 — M " H. P. Globe Valves. ,16 — y, " Pod Valves. K — Filter Cases. L — y 2 " H. P. Line to Acetone Cylinder. II — Acetone Cylinder. L2 — Acetone Filler. M — VI" Special Steel Pipe. N — Storage Cylinders. O — Saddles for Storage Cylinders. P — Yard Line. PI — Yard Line Valves. P2 — Nest of Valves for Charging Cylinders on Flat Cars. Q — %" Pipe to Release Gas in Yard Line Back to Holder. Ql — %." Pipe to Release Gas in Compressor Back to Holder. R — 12" Connection to Sewer. S — %" Pine to Release Acetone Cylinder Back to Holder. T — Water Seal Blow-Off. U — Shafting, Hangers and Pul- leys. V — Belt. W — Motor. 158 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS A — Gas Holder. E — Tank of Gas Holder. C— Cell of Gas Holder. CI— Inlet to Gas Holder. C2 — Outlet from Gas Holder. D — Drip Pots. Dl — 4" Main to Holder. D2 — 4" Return Main. These plans in detail apply to all charging plants built for this system of lighting, the various sizes varying, of course, according to the capacity of the plant HEATIXG -VXD LIGHTING CARS 159 FIG. 66. GENERAL ACETYLENE GENERATOR. SEE PAGE 160 FOR EXPLANATION. 160 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS EXPLANATION OF FIG. GO. A — Hand Hole through which Hopper is filled with Carbide. B — Hand Hole for cleaning Feed Drum. C — Hand Hole giving access to Generating Chamber. D — Carbide Hcpper. E — Rachet Wheel operating Feed Drum. F — Cas Main from Generator. G — Gate Valve. H — Over Flow Pipe. I — Vent Pipe. J — Water Supply Pipe. K — Zlow Oil Pipe. L — Blow Off Seal. M — Blow Off Seal Overflow. N — Drain Pipe. O — Drain Valve. P — Carbide Deflector. ■Q — Flange Joint connecting Hopper with Generating Chamber. FIG. 67. GENERATING AND COMPRESSING PLANT OF THE D , L. & W. R. R. AT HOBOKEN. N. J. South end of first floor, showing : two General Acetylene Generators with Carbide Chamber or Hopper passing up through ceiling to second floor, 4 Driers, 1 Scrubber. HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 161 The hoppers, or carbide chambers, of the generators run up through the ceiling of generating room, and the carbide is fed into same from the second floor, which is. also used for storage of carbide. FIG. 6S. N. Y. C. & H. R. R. DAY COACH EQUIPPED WITH THE SAFETY STORAGE SYSTEM. (Converted Pintsch Lamps.) Where meter is not desired, the cushion bell, F', can be dispensed with, as its use is only to equalize the flow •through meter and protect it from the drag of the compressor's intake. 162 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS This system of lighting is shown in a series of illus- trations showing the interiors of a day coach and a mail car, and also a cafe car. The exterior of a stand- ard coach is shown likewise to indicate the storage tank, etc. See Figures 68, 69, 70 and 71. FIG. 69. ERIE MAIL CAR 699 Built by Standard Steel Car Co., Equipped with the Safety Storage System. Finest Lighted "Car in the World. Sections of cars showing the equipment, and also the names of parts are illustrated in Figure 72. HEATi:\G AXD LIGHTING CARS 163 FIG. 70. D., L. & W. CAFE CAR 781. Equipped with the Safety Storage System. 164 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 165 FIG. SECTIONS OF CARS SHOWING EQUIPMENT. 101 — Stud Valve. 101 — Filling Valve. 105 — Filling Valve Bracket. 107 — Filling Valve Cover. 108— 14" Flange Union- (H.P.) 110 — 14 " Steel Cross. Ill — 14" Steel Tee. 114 — Gauge for Car. 117 — A Regulating Valve. 138 — 14" Extra Strong Pipe. THE ELECTRIC CAR LIGHTING SYSTEM. The electric lighting of cars by the Bliss system con- sists essentially of the following* apparatus : — i. A dynamo electric machine or generator, mounted upon the truck frame and so arranged that its armature is rotated by means of a mechanical connection with the axle. 2. A regulator mounted upon the bottom of the car body, the function of which is to control the generator output, and to maintain constant the lamp voltage, irre- spective of the speed of the car or the number of lamps in use. / 3. An automatic switch, mounted inside the can the function of which is to control the connection of the generator with the rest of the system. In addition to these three elementary devices, an elec- trically lighted car must be equipped with: First, a suitable storage battery, and Second, the usual wiring, fixtures, lamps, circuit switches, etc., as may be neces- sary. The apparatus consists of the three essential elements above mentioned, namely, generator, regulator and auto- matic switch, together with certain minor auxiliary parts, the function cf which is of a protective nature, or which promote convenience in installation. Generator. — The generator in operation is essentially similiar to a stationary generator used for ordinary light- ing work. Regulator or "Bucker." — In any car lighting system employing a variable speed generator, it is necessary to 166 HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 167 provide regulation in two circuits : First, the generator field circuit to prevent undue increase in voltage as the speed increases, and Second, between the battery ter- minals and the lamp mains, to prevent the full charging voltage of the battery being impressed on the lamps. In the ordinary system, this regulation is obtained more or less effectually by means of automatically operated rheostats. In the Bliss System, the automatic rheostat with the attendant mechanical FIG. 73. GENERATOR SHOWING PERFORATED PULLEY AND SUPPORTING ARMS. complications, is eliminated, and regulation is obtained by opposing the flow of the current by means of counter volt- age, which varies with the operating conditions. This counter voltage may be said to "buck" the current which tends to flow through the generator field circuit, and also from the battery terminals to the lamps, and in conse- 168 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS quence of this action, the regulator has come to be gener- ally termed the "Bucker." Mechanically considered, it consists of two armatures of sufficient size to permit rugged construction, both mounted on a single shaft, and enclosed within a single casing. One of these armatures, with its corresponding field, forms a simple shunt motor, and the other arma- ture constitutes the regulating device and is provided with two windings and two commutators, one connected in the generator field circuit, and the other between the battery terminals and the lamps. FIG. 74. SIDE VIEW OF BUCKER SHOWING COUPLER HEAD. The required counter voltages are generated automati- cally in these two windings, one providing the necessary regulation for the generator field as the speed increases, and the other increasing as the .charging voltage of the battery increases, thus keeping the lamp voltage constant. HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 169 Automatic Switch. — The connection between the generator and the rest of the system is controlled by means of an automatic device called the "generator switch/' It is simply a solenoid composed of two coils, one the lifting or closing coil, the other the releasing or opening coil. These coils act upon a plunger, wdiich is drawn up by the lifting coil. When so drawn up, a metal brush attached to the plunger connects two termi- FIG. 75. BUCKER WITH LOWER FRAME REMOVED SHOWING ARMATURE IN LOWER FRAME. nals thus connecting the generator to the battery. The solenoid switch closes the connection between the main wires when the generator has attained an operating speed and opens automatically when the generator drops below the operating speed. Storage Battery. — In general, two groupings of storage battery have been standardized for railroad work, 170 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS i. e., 16 cells with operating voltage of 30 to 32, and 32 cells with operating voltage of 60 to 64. Where only single car lighting is considered, it is probable that neither system presents any marked advantage over the other, and decision has been based on individual operating con- ditions. The 16-cell equipment reduces the number of connec- tions in the battery, and also tends to reduce the cost of inspection and maintenance, on account of the smaller number of battery units. The 32-cell system, on the contrary, entails more apparent complication and inspec- tion, but in the minds of many this is compensated for by the reduction in wiring cgst, and the assurance of more perfect operatiofi, dv^ to the smaller currents to be handled. Where any extended system 'of train lighting, as dis- tinguished from car lighting, is considered, the 32-cell system has been almost universally adopted, and the 16- cell system has been set aside on account of the enor- mously increased copper section necessary to carry the current, and the difficulty of providing sufficient contact -surface in connectors. In consequence, where an ex- tended system of lighting is considered, the decision should be in favor of the higher voltage and increased number of cells, even on single car lighting apparatus, in order that the equipment may be interchange-through- out, so far as is possible. Wiring, Fixtures and Lamps. — Car wiring and fixtures may be as ornate and elaborate or as plain and simple as taste or expediency may dictate. Lamp practice, however, has 'become fairly standardized. Both 30 and 60-volt lamps are procurable in 6, 8, 10, 12 and 16 C. P. sizes, the 8 C. P. lamp being the one most universally HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 171 used. The 30-volt lamp, in general, has the advantage that its filament is short, of greater cross-section, and con- sequently less affected by vibration. The 60-volt lamp, on the contrary is generally cheaper, easier to procure and is considered less special than the 30-volt by the lamp manufacturers. Under normal conditions, the Bliss single car equip- ment has a capacity of 2,200 watts in the lamp circuit, in addition to the current which simultaneously charges 172 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS the batteries, thus providing lighting for from 70 to 75 eight C. P. lamps, this being the maximum which is ordi- narily installed. As pointed out later the maximum out- put capacity of the generator is in excess of this figure. General Operation. — As the car accelerates, the gen- erator developes an increasing voltage, sending current through the various circuits connected with it, and start- ing the motor armature of the bucker. When the car reaches the operating speed, the generator will develop normal lamp voltage and the motor and bucker will be running at full speed. PIG. RELATIVE POSITION OF BUCKER AND JUNCTION BOX ON BOTTOM OF CAR BODY. At this point, the automatic switch closes, connecting the generator to the rest of the system, and the feeding of current to the lamps begins. On further increase of speed, which would tend to cor- respondingly increase the voltage, the opposing influence of the bucker in the field circuit comes into play, weak- ening the field as the speed increases, and keeping the output of the generator within the predetermined limits. At the same time the opposing effect of the bucker in the HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 173- lamp circuit takes effect, and prevents the lamp voltage from rising co-incident with the speed and voltage of the generator as the car increases in speed. The apparatus is so adjusted that even at train speeds of 75 miles per hour or higher, the output of the generator is confined within safe limits by the field bucker winding, and the lamp voltaee is maintained constant at its normal value through the action of the lamp bucker winding, thus meeting all operating conditions. In addition, the lamp voltage will remain constant, irre- spective of the number of lamps in use, since the "buck- ing'' effect is the same irrespective of the current which may flow against it. This is not true in rheostatic regu- lation, in which the amount of resistance must be varied, not only as the battery voltage changes, but as the num- ber of lamps may be altered. Arrangement of Circuits. — By reference to the wiring diagram shown, it will be seen that the cur- rent flowing from the positive terminal of the generator passes through the automatic switch, and then divides, a certain portion of it passing through whatever lamps may be in use, the other portion passing through the stor- age battery in a charging direction, and also through the field winding of the bucker. Again, the current which has passed through the lamps, and that which has flowed through the battery and the field coil of the bucker unite and return to the negative terminal of the generator. It will be noted that the current for exciting the field magnet of the generator flows from the positive terminal of the same through the generator shunt field, and thence through the brushes of the commutator on one side of the bucker armature. It will further be noted that the current which has passed through the lamps is caused to 174 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS' flow through the other set of brushes, and the other com- mutator of the bucker armature. The two commutators referred to are each connected to an independent wind- ing, wound on the same core. These windings are to- tally distinct, and insulated from one another, the one in the circuit of the generator field being composed of a large number of turns of comparatively fine wire, while that in the lamp circuit is composed of a small number of comparatively heavy turns. On the shame shaft with this armature is another armature provided with the usual field magnet, which forms the shunt motor which has already been referred to. The connections of the shunt motor are obvious and have been omitted in the dia- gram for the sake of clearness. The field coil which acts upon the bucker armature is connected so that the current which flows through the battery must pass through it, and the bucker armature being in rotation at constant speed, it is obvious that an increase in the current flow through the battery, due' to increase in generator voltage, will increase the counter voltage generated by the field bucker, thus tending to weaken the generator field and reduce the increased cur- rent flow to the battery. Simultaneously, the counter voltage of the lamp bucker will be increased, thus compen- sating for the rise of voltage on the battery terminals and maintaining constant voltage on the lamp mains. Essentially considered, these operations constitute the regulation provided by the Bliss System, and maintain predetermined operating conditions in the battery and lamp circuits, irrespective of the speed of the car. In this connection, it should be noted that the regulating effects do not take place by steps, as in the case of rheostatic regulation, but are regular and infinitesimally small changes. HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 175 Battery Current Regulation. — The connection of the bticker field coil in the battery circuit serves an im- portant function, on which depends the satisfactory per- formance of the apparatus on the road. It insures that, irrespective of the lamp load, the battery shall always re- ceive a practically constant and predetermined charge, and the batteries are thus always charged, provided the car is run sufficiently to make up the losses at terminals. Xo current is taken from the batteries when running at average speed, irrespective of what the lamp load may be. "Total current regulation," on the contrary, which is the method ordinarily employed in other system^, and which inherently regulates to keep the generator output at a predetermined amount, must involve the disadvantage that the charging current is variable and uncertain. With no lamps in circuit, the charging current may be equal to the total output capacity of the generator. With all lamps lighted, the charge is not only reduced, but may even be turned into a discharge, the batteries helping the genera- tor to carry the load. As it is impracticable to control the extent to which lights may be used on the road, and as the tendency is always to use them more than freely, it is obvious that during a considerable portion of the run- ning- time, the battery in a system employing "total cur- rent regulation" may be discharging instead of charging, as is absolutely essential to good service. In any system employing "total current regulation" certain disadvantageous conditions result, which are in- herent and cannot be avoided. The battery is charged at uncertain rates at uncertain intervals, resulting in an indeterminate condition of charge, and also total uncer- tainty as to battery condition at any time. This makes 176 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS necessary terminal charging, which, aside from being in itself objectionable, is usually carried on under disadvan- tageous conditions, resulting in largely increased battery deterioration. "Battery current regulation/' as employ- ed exclusively in the Bliss System, insures charging at predetermined times and at predetermined minimum rates, thus providing that the battery is at all times fully charged. Terminal charging is eliminated, and the bat- tery being always charged at the lowest consistent rate, deterioration is reduced to a minimum. CAR GENERATOR— TYPE C. Outside Suspension. Straight Line Belt Tension — Split Frame. Type C Generator is a truck mounted, belt driven ma- chine supported on what is commonly known as an out- side suspension. The latter consists of two 3^/2"xi" FIG. CAR GENERATOR SHOWING OL'TSIDE SUSPENSION, PULK2T END. wrought iron suspension bars, which hook under the transom and pass over the end sill and are secured upon the latter by wrought iron or open hearth steel clamps. The details of this fastening may differ with different types of truck, but the same general plan is applicable to all M. C. B. trucks. The suspension bars extend beyond 177 178 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS the end sill about 30", and across their outer ends is bolted a 4"xi" wrought iron cross bar, which is laid flat and bent downward between the suspension bars, so that its upper surface is level with and equal in width to the top of the end sill. The frame is additionally stiffened laterally bv means of two diagonal wrought iron braces, bolted to the end sill and suspension bars. FIG. 79. SIDE VIEW OF GENERATOR SHOWING ARMATURE PULLEY, AXLE PULLEY, BELT AND TENSION MECHANISM. Arrangement of Generator. — The frame of the generator consists of cylindrical open hearth steel casting, divided longitudinally into an upper and lower portion. Upon the upper are cast four longitudinally projecting arms or lugs, under each of which is placed a roller bearing and plate. The generator, supported by these four lugs, is placed upon the end sill and cross bar, and is thus suspended outside, and clear of the truck. The armature shaft of the generator is set parallel with the car axle. Similar open hearth steel guides are clamped upon the end sill and cross bar, respectively, and secure the arms or lugs of the generator frame against lateral HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 179 and vertical displacement, although three inches of longi- tudinal movement of the generator upon the suspension frame is provided to allow for adjusting the tension of the driving belt. The guide upon the end sill is secured by means of bolts and wrought iron clamps, it being un- necessary to bore any holes through the end sill. Belt Tension Mechanism. — The guide upon the cross bar is interchangeable with the guide on the end sill, and is secured by bolts and clamps, one of which is an open hearth steel casting and forms, in addition, a bracket for the belt tension rod, and a seat for the belt tension spring. The tension rod is attached to the gene- rator frame by means of a clevis and pin, passes through a hole in the tension bracket, and then through the ten- sion spring. The tension on the latter is adjusted by means of the tension nut, which consists of an iron cast- ing, forming a spring seat and nut, and a weighted handle, which prevents the nut from turning by vibra- tion, and renders the use of a wrench and locking device unnecessary. The roller bearings under the supporting arms reduce the belt tension to a minimum. Pulleys and Belts. — In standard equipment, the gen- erator is provided with a flanged pulley, 10" diameter and 6)4 " face, crowned slightly, and accurately balanced. This pulley is fitted and keyed to the tapered armature shaft, and is interchangeable with the 8"x6j4" pulley and the fibre and steel pinions used on Forms I and 2 generator. The axle pulley is likewise flanged, 21 " or 23" diame- ter, 7" face and is flat. It is split and provided with a split bushing which is bored to fit the taper of the axle, and is clamped thereon by means of JKf" bolts. Any form of belt may be used, but should not be more than 180 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS 5" wide, and in thickness no lighter than the equivalent of four-ply rubber. One belt of proper dimensions with suitable fastenings is provided with each generator. The alignment of the belt can be adjusted by loosen- ing the guide and clamps on the cross bar and shifting the two outboard arms of the generator to one side or the other and then reclamping. d^A^^i . FIG. 80. SIDE VIEW OF GENERATOR SHOWING LOWER FRAME SWUNG DOWN, EXPOSING INTERNAL PARTS, ARMATURE REMAINING IN UPPER FRAME. Advantages of Bliss Suspension. — The advantages of this form of suspension over all others are : 1. The generator being supported entirely by the up- per portion, the lower portion is left free and clear for inspection and repairs ; the lower half of the field frame, armature, bearings, pulleys and all other parts can be removed without disturbing the supporting framework, HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 181 2. The adjustment of the belt tension is effected by means of a direct longitudinal movement of the genera- tor, which is the universal practice with all stationary belt driven generators and motors, the roller bearings practi- cally eliminating all sliding friction. The generator not being pivoted is not tipped or otherwise drawn out of its proper position in making wide adjustments of the belt tension. 3. The entire generator may be removed from the truck by removing the guides on the end sill and cross bar and unbolting the cross bar from the suspension bars. 4. The iron work is of the simplest possible design. There are no welds, and the amount of boring or other work on the truck frame is reduced to a minimum. One man and helper familiar with the work can install genera- tor on truck in four hours. "Nfcv •* tB ft *g FIG. 81. GENERATOR FIELD COILS AND RETAINERS. Field Frame, Magnets and Bearings. — All four forms of car generator are identical so far as the arma- ture, field magnets and brush mechanism are concerned and these parts are all interchangeable. The generator proper is of the iron clad type, having four internal radial 182 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS salient poles. The poles are placed at an angle of 45° with the horizontal, two poles being in the upper, and two in the lower half of the generator, which is divided longitudinally in a horizontal plane. The casing, which forms the yoke of the fields, is extended parallel with the axis of the shaft and is then turned in at right angles, thus forming ends which are bored out and have fitted into them round head-like castings which hold the arma- ture shaft bearings and oil wells. This construction was originated by the Bliss Company. When these heads are ) <£&£ ^£>A FIG. 82. END VIEW OF GENERATOR, SHOWING BEARING HEAD AND HAND HOLE COVER REMOVED, EXPOSING AUTOMATIC BRUSH MECHANISM. in place, the generator is almost hermetically sealed, and is absolutely dust and water proof. A suitable hand-hole is provided in the generator casing for purposes of in- spection, etc. The two heads which carry the armature bearings are each held in place by four bolts, two of which are tapped HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 183 into each half of the generator casing. By this construc- tion, the lower half of the generator may be removed, leaving the armature in the upper half, or the armature may be removed with the lower half. The heads being nicely fitted to the casing, insure perfect alignment of the armature shaft, no steady pins or other truing de- vices being required. FIG. 83. COMPLETE GENERATOR ARMATURE AND PULLEY, AUTOMATIC BRUSH MECHANISM AND ARMATURE COIL. By removing the head casting at the commutator end of the generator, and detaching the flexible cables from their respective brush-holders, the entire brush mechan- ism, as w r ell as the armature, may be removed without disturbing any of the other parts. Armature. — The armature is of the four-pole drum type, having a two-circuit singly re-entrant drum wind- ing of the straight-out, or barrel type. The coils are wound on formers and afterward placed on the core, thus providing a perfectly balanced winding, both electrically and mechanically. The armature coils are assembled on the armature in the usual manner and specially banded. With this con- 184 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS struction, it is possible to remove a single damaged coil by simply lifting out one-quarter of the coils, when the damaged coil can be replaced by a new one. While this feature is extremely valuable in facilitating repairs, and has been adopted for this reason, we have no record of the burn-out of a generator armature. Spider and Removable Shaft. — The core of the ar- mature consists of the usual annular stampings, slotted to receive the coils, and mounted on a ventilated spider. FIG. 84. ARMATURE SHAFTS AND NUTS OF GENERATOR AND BUCKER, SHOWING SPIDER AND REMOV- ABLE SHAFT CONSTRUCTION. The central portion of the spider forms a sleeve which is extended at one end to support the commutator. The sleeve is bored to take the armature shaft, which is suita- bly keyed and otherwise secured. This construction is unusual in w r ork of this capacity, and is only found in car lighting apparatus of our manufacture, and although entailing greater expense in construction, has been HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 185 adopted on account of its value from an operating stand- point. a < - . H H M K as J r \ o£g ^ tf » C?,ffl o fe 8 tf H ^ o r o h END AND MMUT £ o 10 U 00 Q . z O < This arrangement h, rmits the armature and commuta- tor to be quickly takei off the shaft without disturbing the windings, thus affording a ready means for making repairs, either to the sh^ft or to the armature itself. 186 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS Journals and Lubrication. — The armature shaft is extremely large for a machine of this capacity, and is manufactured from a fine grade of high carbon steel. The journals are unusually ample in their proportions, the commutator end bearing being i^4"x4", the pinion end bearing \y>"^y 2 ". The lubrication is entirely automatic, and is effected by oil rings operating in oil wells of unusual capacity. All the running parts are heavily proportioned and are de- signed to resist the heaviest shocks and stresses. The generator is connected as a plain shunt wound machine and is self-exciting. Hence, there is but a single wind- ing on the field, each pole being excited by a single coil, which is held in place by a special clamping device of extremely heavy construction. Brushes. — The armature winding, being of the two- circuit type, requires but a single pair of brushes to take the current from the commutator, but, for purposes here- inafter explained, two pairs of brushes are employed. Capacity and Rating. — The generator is nominally rated at 4 kilowatts, 80 volts and 50 amperes or 40 volts and 100 amperes, this being its normal continuous safe load. The 50 ampere generator, however, has been suc- cessfully operated at 90 amperes for five hours without undue rise in temperature. Few cars can possibly utilize such a large output to advantage. Brush Mechanism and Automatic Pole Changer. — The polarity of the terminals of the generator is pre- served in the following manner : The brush-holders are mounted on a carrier, which is supported on anti-friction bearings, which enable it to rotate freely within the cas- ing of the generator. The friction between the brushes and the commutator is sufficient to cause the brushes, HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 187 and with them the carrier, to be dragged around as the commutator revolves. The angular motion of the carrier is arrested by means of a removable stop. When the armature revolves in a right-hand direction, the brushes and carrier are rotated to the right and ar- rested by the stop in the correct position for commuta- tion, and. vice versa. It is obvious that the rotation of the armature having been reversed, and also the position of the brushes, the actual polarity of the generator termi- nals is preserved. It will be apparent that the angular ^ %% PIG. 86. AUTOMATIC BRUSH MECHANISM AND FLEXIBLE CABLES. motion of the brush carrier need be but 90 in a four- pole generator. The motion however is made a few de- grees greater than a quadrant, thus providing a certain lead which aids commutation. Lead is impossible with any other type of pole changer. A single pair of brushes would suffice to take the cur- rent from the commutator, but by using four brushes, or 188 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS two pairs, a short commutator is possible, a more sym- metrical disposition of the brushes is secured, and ade- quate contact between the brushes and the comnTutator is obtained, without undue pressure on a single brush. The brushes of similar polarity are connected together in the usual manner, while flexible cables, readily detach- able, convey the current from the brushes to the station- ary terminals of the generator. The preservation of the polarity of the brushes is thus secured mechanically, and without resort to contacts, switch-blades or other devices, which break or interfere with the continuity of the circuit. The friction between the brushes and the commutator cannot be avoided, and in the Bliss System is utilized to advantage. The stop which arrests the motion of the carrier is removable, in order that, for inspection purposes and the renewal of brushes, the carrier may be turned completely around, and all the brushes and holders brought opposite the hand-hole in the generator casing. BUCKER TYPE B. Provided with Coupler. The bucker is the distinctive feature of the Bliss Sys- tem, and was devised for both regulating an axle genera- tor and maintaining constant lamp voltage in connection with a generator and storage battery. It is a separate auxiliary and self-contained machine, which is bolted to the bottom of the car in any convenient place. This ma- chine contains a revolving shaft, on which are mounted two armature cores. One of these armatures, with its commutator and field, constitutes a plain shunt motor which takes its power from the generator mains, and HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 189 whose sole function is to rotate the shaft. It is obvious that this motor runs only when the generator is in opera- tion. The other armature has two windings and two commu- tators, and revolves in a field excited by the current flow- ing through the battery. This doublewound armature, with its two commutators and field, constitutes the "bucker" proper. The motor simply drives it. The z0ism FIG. 87. BUCKER WITH LOWER FRAME REMOVED SHOWING ARMATURE IN UPPER FRAME. winding connected in the lamp circuit is called the "lamp bucker," and the winding connected in the field circuit of the generator the "field bucker." The field of the bucker is referred to as the "series field;" that of the motor as the "motor field." As will be seen, by referring to illustrations, the bucker is entirely enclosed and hence is dust and water proof. It 190 PULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS is impossible for anyone to tamper with it, and it contains no delicate or complicated parts. Armatures. — The motor and bucker armatures are drum-wound for bipolar fields. They are built up of slotted annular punchings, and mounted, together with FIG. 88. COMPLETE BUCKER ARMATURE AND SHAFT. their commutators, on a sleeve which is fitted and keyed to the shaft. The construction is very similar to, and possesses all the advantages of that employed in the gen- erator armature previously described. There is no pulley or external mechanical connection on this machine. jfillt FIG. 89. BUCKER FIELD COILS AND POLE PIECES. Field Magnets. — The field is of the bipolar, iron clad type. Each armature core revolves between two salient pole pieces, which are bolted into the casing, and consist of a pole shoe and cor;.. Upon each core is placed a heav- HEATING AXD LIGHTING CARS 191 ily taped and painted coil. The pole pieces are placed in a vertical line, so that one pole and coil for each armature core is in the upper, and one in the lower part of the ma- chine. Brush Holders. — The brush holders are mounted rig- idly in the upper half of the machine. The springs and fingers are interchangeable with those of the generator. In taking off the bottom half of the casing, or in remov- ing the armature, no wire connections need be disturbed bevond disconnecting the upper and lower field leads. FIG. 90. BUCKER BRUSH HOLDERS AND DETAILS. Bearings. — The head castings, containing the arma- ture shaft bearings, are secured to the casing by four bolts, thus permitting the lowering of the bottom half of the casing with or without the armature. The illustra- tion shows the armature entirely removed, together with the head castings and armature shaft bearings. The sepa- rate parts of this machine are light enough to be easily handled, no jacks or lifting devices being necessary. By referring to the cuts, it will be seen that large hand hole covers are provided over each brush holder, thus afford- ing, by their removal, easy access to all internal parts. 192 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS Terminals and Connections. — The wiring of the bucker is entirely inside the casing-. All of the leads (six in number) are brought out through a single opening provided with proper outlet bushing. These leads termi- nate in a coupler head carrying six terminal sockets, each provided with two binding screws. A corresponding FIG. 91. INTERIOR VIEW OF BUCKER SHOWING CONSTRUC- TION OF UPPER FRAME, BRUSH HOLDERS AND WIRING. coupler block is furnished with each bucker, in which the six leads of the car wiring are secured. Ferrules are provided, which are soldered over the ends of the car wires, after the insulation has been removed, and the wires threaded through the coupler block. One of the ferrules is larger in diameter than the others, as is also HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 193 the hole in the corresponding terminal socket, thus pro- viding- a registering device which automatically insures the correct connection of the bucker to the car wires. The advantages of this construction are simplicity in installa- tion, elimination of mutilated wire ends, and certainty of correct connections. FIG. 92. END VIEW OF BUCKER SHOWING COMPLETE COUP- LER HEAD AND BLOCK AND METHOD OF CONNECTING CAR WIRES. BEARING HEAD AND HAND HOLE COVER REMOVED EXPOSING MOTOR COMMUTATOR. Operation of the Bucker.— It is obvious that when no current flows through the battery, none flows through the series field, since they are in series with one another, and hence no electro-motive-force is generated in the bucker ; but when current flows through this series field, electro-motive-forces are generated in the bucker, and in almost exact proportion to the strength of the field. (Af- ter the closing of the automatic generator switch, the motor runs at almost constant speed, its slight accelera- tion as the generator voltage rises from normal lamp 194 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS voltage to maximum being an advantage, as it compen- sates for the drooping curve of magnetization in the se- ries field.) No current will flow through the series field under the following conditions : i. When the generator is inoperative, automatic gen- erator switch open, and no lamps lighted; for example, car standing still in day-time. 2. When the generator is operative, automatic genera- tor switch closed, no lamps lighted and the generator voltage equal to the battery voltage ; for example, run- ning at cutting-in speed in day-time. 3. When the generator is operative, automatic genera- tor switch closed, lamps lighted, and generator just carry- ing the lamp load, batteries neither charging nor dis- charging. Under these three conditions, no regulation of genera- tor or lamps is necessary. Only one condition obtains when regulation is neces- sary, and that is : 4. When the generator speed and voltage have risen and the battery is being charged ; for example, running- above operating speed, day or night. Then the voltage at the lamps tends to rise, and it must be kept constant, whether the lamps are lighted or not. \ Constant Lamp Voltage. — The voltage at the termi- nals of the battery rises approximately in proportion to the current forced through them. The magnetism of the series field increases in proportion to this current. The counter voltages of the bucker increase in proportion to its field magnetism. Hence, the counter voltages of the bucker increase in proportion to the rise of electro-mo- tive-force at the battery terminals. The lamp bucker, HEATING AXD LIGHTING CARS 195 which is in the lamp circuit, will, therefore, produce a counter voltage always equal to the excess electro-motive- force necessary to impress on the batteries to charge them. The result will be a constant lamp voltage, inde- pendent of the number of lamps in use, or the speed of the train, since the latter now affects the charging cur ■ rent only. Regulation of the Generator. — The field bucker is connected inversely in series with the field of the genera- tor, and generates a counter voltage which weakens the field of the latter to such a degree that the voltage of the generator is just sufficient at the maximum train speed to force the maximum predetermined current through the battery and series field. The regulation tends to main- tain constant current through the battery and series field at a given train speed. The tamp load is carried by the generator precisely as in the case of a constant potential machine and does not affect the charging current flowing through the battery.. Economy of the Bucker. — Since the bucker receives or absorbs energy from the lamp circuit and the field cir- cuit of the generator, such energy is transformed into mechanical power and tends to revolve the shaft and thus relieve the motor of that work. In fact, when the appara- tus is fully loaded, the motor becomes a generator and puts back into the system about 60% of the energy con- sumed by the bucker in effecting regulation. Generator Switch. — It is necessary to provide an au- tomatic switch which will complete the circuit between the generator and the storage battery whenever the speed of the former and consequently its voltage, is equal to or greater than that of the battery. On the other hand, this switch must likewise break that circuit whenever the 198 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS Operation. — When the generator develops normal lamp voltage the switch will close, as the fine wire, or lifting coil, raises the plunger and causes the metal brush to make connection between the two metallic contacts. As the speed and generator voltage increase, current will flow through the contacts, brush and releasing coil., and through the battery, the releasing coil being wound in such a direction that this current aids the lifting coil in holding up the plunger and brush, maintaining a better contact for increasing current. When, however, the voltage of the generator becomes less than that of the battery, current will flow from the battery in a reverse direction, through the releasing coil and generator, and oppose the action of the lifting coil. The weight of the plunger and brush is then sufficient to cause the opening of the switch by gravity. Xo springs are used to secure the adjustment, which is made by vary- ing the length of the air-gap, and when once made is per- manent. Renewable carbon contacts, on which the final break takes place, protect the metallic parts against in jury by arcing. Triple Contact. — Upon the top of the iron frame of the automatic generator switch is mounted a triple con- tact, consisting of a three-part segmental socket and a conical plug fitting the same. The function of the triple contact is to short-circuit the lamp bucker and series field, thus avoiding the drop that would otherwise take place in the lamp circuit when the battery was discharg- ing, and to render the bucker inoperative below operating speeds, when the generator switch is open. The plug is raised and lowered by means of a tail-rod attached to the plunger of the switch. When the plunger is down and the generator switch open, the plug con- HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 199 tiects the three segments together. When the plunger and plug are raised by the lifting coil, the triple contact is broken. The plug is insulated from the tail-rod and a flexible conductor permanently connects the plug with an insulated terminal, mounted on a tarnsite base. FIG. 95. GENERATOR SWITCH WITH FOUR-CIRCUIT PANEL BOARD IN DOUBLE SECTION IRON BOX. One lead of a resistance coil is connected to this in- sulated terminal, and the other lead is connected to the rear segment of the triple contact. The negative lead of the generator is also connected to this segment. The leads of the lifting coil are connected, respectively, to the positive main contact, and the terminal to which the flexi- ble conductor is attached. Thus it will be seen that when 200 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS • the plug establishes the triple contact it also short-circuits the resistance coil. When the plug is raised, it throws the resistance into series with the lifting coil. Two advantages result from inserting resistance into the lifting coil circuit : First, to reduce the .current and consequent heating in the coil, which would otherwise change its resistance and alter the adjustment of the switch ; second, to reduce the magnetizing effect of the coil, so that less discharge current will be required in the releasing coil to open the switch, as above explained. Fuse Deck. — The generator switch is mounted on a tarnsite base and enclosed in an iron box provided at top and bottom with suitable conduit fittings. On the lower part of the base is mounted the fuse deck, which supports all the positive terminals, the negative terminals being on the base below and back of the fuse deck. As the name implies, the fuse deck also carries the fuses for the generator and battery. By the removal of these fuses, and the insertion of a special ammeter connection, read- ings of current can be quickly and easily made without the use of tools and the attendant danger of short circuit,. Adjustable Shunt. — In order to adjust the charging current delivered by the generator to the storage bat. tery, an adjustable shunt is provided which consists of a. number of steps of resistance enclosed in a smaU cast iron* case which is mounted inside the car and as near the switch box as convenient. This shunt is connected acrosr. the terminals of the series field of the bucker and serves to divert a certain portion of the charging current from said field. A number of binding posts are provided on the shunt so that its resistance may be varied, which is done by shifting one connecting wire from post to post until the proper adjustment has been secured and then HEATING AND LIGHTING CARS 201 the wire is made permanently fast. This shunt acts exactly like the shunt on the series field of a compound genera- tor. It affords a simple and easy method of adjustment and by its use the charging current can be varied about 1 00%. FIG. 96. ADJUSTABLE SHUNT. FIG. 97. EMERGENCY EXCITER SWITCH. Emergency Exciter Switch. — This switch consist- ing of a spring actuated lever turning upon two contact buttons, provides a quick and certain method of exciting the field of the generator directly from the storage bat- tery in case of loss of residual magnetism or any other cause preventing the generator from "picking up." Ordi- narily the field circuit is completed through this switch so that the generator is self-exciting, but by throwing the lever to the right, the field is connected directly to the battery, and of course excited. Upon letting go of the lever, the spring restores the original connection. This switch may be shifted while the apparatus is at rest or in motion and its manipulation will not affect the ap- paratus in the slightest. 202 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS Junction Box. — To facilitate and simplify the wiring of the apparatus, a cast iron junction box has been pro- vided, into which all the wires from the different pieces of apparatus are led. This box is secured to the bottom of the car body in any convenient location, and if possible, should be installed about six inches from the edge of the car body, and as near the generator as proper clear- ance will permit. FIG. 98. FRONT VIEW JUNCTION BOX, WITH COVER REMOVED. The two side openings are designed to receive tw r o- inch iron pipe or conduit, which should be used for en- closing and protecting all of the wiring on the bottom of the car. On the underside of the junction box is a fitting, into which are fastened four insulating bushings for the reception of the four wires w 7 hich lead to the generator. By properly securing these wires into the bushings, the fitting may be removed bodily from the bottom of the junction box, whenever it is necessary to remove the car truck. This renders it certain that the wires will be properly renlaced when the generator is reconnected. THE STANDARD CODE TRAIN RULES. AMERICAN RAILWAY ASSOCIATION. GENERAL RULES. A. Employes whose duties are prescribed by these rules must provide themselves with a copy. B. Employes must be conversant with and obey the rules and special instructions. If in doubt as to their meaning they must apply to proper authority for an explanation. C. Employes must pass the required examinations. D. Persons employed in any service on trains are sub- ject to the rules and special instructions. E. Employes must render every assistance in their power in carrying out the rules and special instructions. F. Any violation of the rules or special instructions must be reported. G. The use of intoxicants by employes while on duty is prohibited. Their use, or the frequenting of places where they are sold, is sufficient cause for dismissal. H. The use of tobacco by employes when on duty in or about passenger stations, or on passenger cars is prohibited. J. Employes on duty must wear the prescribed badge and uniform and be neat in appearance. K. Persons authorized to transact business at stations or on trains must be orderly and avoid annoyance to patrons. 203 204 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS L. In case of danger to the Company's property, em- ployes must unite to protect it. DEFINITIONS. Engine — A locomotive propelled by any form of energy. Train — An engine, or more than one engine coupled, with or without cars, displaying Markers. Regular Train — A train authorized by a time-table schedule. Section — One of two or more trains running on the same schedule displaying signals, or for which signals are displayed. Extra Train — A train not authorized by a time-table schedule. It may be designated as : Extra — For any extra train, except work extra. Work Extra — For work train extra. Superior Train — A train having precedence over other trains. Train of Superior Right — A train given precedence by train order. Train of Superior Class — A train given precedence by the timetable. ' Train of Superior Direction — A train given precedence in the direction specified in the time-table as between trains of the same class. Note — Superiority by direction is limited to single track. Time-table — The authority for the movement of regu- lar trains subject to the rules. It contains the classified schedules of trains with special instructions relating thereto. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 205 Schedule — That part of a time-table which prescribes class, direction, number and movement for a regular train. Division — That portion of a railway assigned to the supervision of a . Subdivision — A part of a division so designated on •the timetable. Main Track — A track extending through the yards and between stations, upon which the current of traffic may be in either specified direction. Single Track — A track upon which trains are operated in both directions. Double Track — Two main tracks, upon one of which the current traffic is in a specified direction, and upon the other in the opposite direction. Current of Traffic — The movement of trains on a main track in one direction, specified by the rules. Station — A place designated on the time-table by name, at which a train may stop for traffic, or to enter or leave the main track, or from which fixed signals are operated. Siding — An auxiliary track for meeting or passing- trains, limited to the distance between two adjoining lele- graph stations. Fixed Signals — A signal of fixed location indicating a condition affecting the movement of a train. Xote to Definition of Fixed Signals — This definition covers such signals as slow boards, stop boards, yard limits, switch, train order, block, interlocking, semaphore, disc, ball or other means for indicating stop, caution or proceed. Yard — A system of tracks within defined limits pro- vided for the making up of trains, storing of cars and other purposes, over which movements not authorized 206 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS by time-table, or by train orders, may be made, subject to prescribed signals and regulations. Yard Engine — An engine assigned to yard service and working within yard limits. Pilot — A person assigned to a train when the engine- man or conductor or both are not fully acquainted with the physical character or running rules of the road, or portion of the road, over which the train is to be moved. RULES FOR SINGLE TRACK. STANDARD TIME. t. Standard Time obtained from observatorv will be telegraphed to all points from designated offices at , m. daily. NOTE to Rule i. — In order to detect possible errors at junction points and to secure uniformity, the Commit- tee recommends that the time be disseminated to all points at the same hour. The Committee considers it of great importance that the time be obtained from some observatory of recognized standing. 2. Watches that have been examined and certified to by a designated inspector must be used by the con- ductor, enginemen and — *. The certificate in prescribed form must be renewed and filed with - everv *The committee recommends that in filling the blank each company add such other classes of employes as it may desire. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 20V (Form of Certificate.) CERTIFICATE OF WATCH INSPECTOR, This is to certify that on 19, ,. . . the watch of 3 .......... employed as ....... . ... on the was examined by me. It is correct and reliable, and in my judgment will, with proper care, run within a varia- tion of thirty seconds per week. Name of maker ...... o Brand ...*'. Number of Movement = Open or Hunting Case Metal of Case .. . Stem or Key Winding Signed, ...,.,,..,.,.. .......... Inspector. Address ....... v .... . , .... . ........ . . . . . . 3. Watches of conductors, enginemen and * must be compared, before starting on each trip, with a clock designated as a Standard Clock. The time when watches are compared must be registered on a prescribed form. NOTE to Rule 3. — The conditions under which con- ductors and enginemen whose duties preclude access to a standard clock are required to obtain standard time, vary so much on different roads that the Committee recommends that each adopt such regulations to cover the case supplementary to this rule, as may best suit its own requirements. 208 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS TIME-TABLES. 4. Each timetable, from the moment it takes effect, supersedes the preceding timetable, and its schedules take effect on any division (or subdivision) at the leaving" time at their initial stations on such division (or subdivi- sion). But when a schedule of the preceding timetable corresponds in number, class, day of leaving, direction, and initial and terminal stations, with a schedule of the new timetable, a train authorized by the preceding timetable will retain train orders and assume the schedule of the corresponding number of the new timetable. Schedules on each division (or subdivision) date from their initial stations on such divisions (or subdivisons) 5. Not more than two times are given for a train at any station ; where one is given, it is unless otherwise indicated the leaving time ; where two, they are the arriv- ing and leaving time. Unless otherwise indicated, the time applies to the switch where an inferior train enters the siding; where there is no siding, it applies to the place from which fixed signals are -operated ; where there is neither siding nor fixed signal, it applies to the place where traffic is re- ceived or discharged. Schedule meeting or passing points are indicated by figures in full-faced type. Both the arriving and leaving time of a train are in full-faced type w T hen both are meeting or passing times, or when one or more trains are to meet or pass it between those times. When trains are to be met or passed at a siding extend- ing between two adjoining stations, the time at each end of the' siding shall be shown in full-faced type. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 209 Where there are one or more trains to meet or pass a train between two times, or more than one train to meet a train at any station, attention is called to it by . NOTE to Rule 5. — The Committee recommends that each company adopt such method as it may prefer in filling the blank. 6. The following signs when placed before the figures of the schedule, indicate: "s" — Regular stop. "f — Flag stop to receive or discharge passengers or freight. — Stop for meals. <€ L" — Leave. "A."— Arrive. SIGNAL RULES. 7. Employes whose duties may require them to give signals must provide themselves with the proper appli- ances, keep them in good order and ready for immediate use. 8. Flags of the prescribed color must be used by day, and lamps of the prescribed color by night. 9. Night signals are to be displayed from sunset to sunrise. When weather or other conditions obscure day signals, night signals must be used in addition. VISIBLE SIGNALS. 10. COLOR SIGNALS. (a) Color, Red. — Indication. — Stop. (b) '. — -Proceed, and for other uses prescribed by the rules. 210 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS (c) . — Proceed with caution, and for other uses prescribed by the rules. (d) Green and white. — Flag stop. See Rule 28. (e) Blue. — See Rule 26. NOTE to Rule 10. — The Committee has omitted giving" the colors of signals "b" and "c" in Rule 10, leaving it discretionary wtih each road to use such colors as it* may prefer. 11. A fusee on or near the track, burning red, must not be passed until burned out. When burning green it is a caution signal. 12. HAND. FLAG, AND LAMP SIGNALS. (a) Maimer of Using, Swung across the track. — Indi- cation. — Stop. (b) Raised and lowered vertically. — proceed. (c) Swung vertically in a circle at half-arm's length across the track when the train is standing. — Indication, "Back." (d) Swung vertically in a circle at arm's length across the track, when train is running. — Train has parted. (e) Swung horizontally above the head when the train is standing — "Apply air-brakes." (f) Held at arm's length above the head, when train is standing — Release air-brakes. 13. Any object waved violently by anyone on or near the track is a signal to stop. AUDIBLE SIGNALS. 14. Engine Whistle Signals. Note.- — The signals prescribed are illustrated by u o" for short sounds ; " " for longer sounds. The sound STATION AND TRAIN WORK 211 of the whistle should be distinct, with intensity and dura- tion proportionate to the distance signal is to be conveyed. (a) o Stop. Apply brakes. (b) . . . .Release brakes. (c) ooo Flagman go back and protect rear of train. (d) — — — — ....Flagman return from west or south. (e) — — — -. .Flagman return from east' or north. (f) . When running, train parted; to be repeated until answered by signal prescribed by Rule 12 (d). Answer to 12 (d). (g) 00 Answer to any signal not other- wise provided for. (H.) 000. . . .When train is standing back. Answer to 12 (c) and 16 (c). When train is running, Answer to 16 (d). (j) 0000 Call for signals. (K.) — 00. . . .To call the attention of yard engines, extra trains or trains of the same or inferior class or inferior right of signals, displayed for a following sec- tion. (1) o o. .Approaching public crossings at grade. (m) Approaching stations, junctions and railroad crossings at grade. A succession of short sounds of the whistle is an alarm for persons or cattle on the track. 15. The explosion of one torpedo is a signal to stop; the explosion of two not more than 200 feet apart is a signal to reduce speed, and look out for a stop signal. 212 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS 16. AIR WHISTLE OR BELL CORD SIGNALS. Sound. Indication. (a) Two When train is standing, start. (b) Two When train is running, stop at once. (c) Three When train is standing, back the train. (d) Three When train is running, stop at next station. (e) Four When train is standing, apply or re- lease air-brakes. (f) Four When train is running, reduce speed. (g) Five When train is standing, call in flag- man. (h) Five When train is running, increase speed. TRAIN SIGNALS. 17. The head-light will be displayed to the front of every train by night, but must be concealed when a train turns out to meet another and has stopped clear of main track,- or is standing to meet trains at the end of double tracks or at junctions. 18. Yard engines will display the head-light to the front and rear by night. When not provided with a head-light at the rear, two white lights must be displayed. Yard engines will not display markers. 19. The following signals will be displayed one on each side of the rear of the train as markers, to indicate the rear of the train: By day, green flags. By night, green lights to the front and side, and red lights to the rear, except when the train is clear of the main track, when green lights must be displayed to the front, side and rear. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 213 20. All sections, except the last, will display two green flags, and, in addition, two green lights by night, in the places provided for that purpose on the front of the engine. 21. Extra trains will display two white flags, and in addition, two white lights by night, in the places provided for that purpose on the front of the engine. 22. When two or more engines are coupled, the lead- ing engine only shall display the signals as prescribed by Rules 20 and 21. 23. One flag or light displayed where in Rules 19, 20 and 21 two are prescribed, w T ill indicate the same as two ; but the proper display of all train signals is required. 24. When cars are pushed by an engine (except when shifting or making up trains in yards), a white light must be displayed on the front of the leading car by night. 25. Each car on a passenger train must be connected with the engine by a communicating signal appliance. 26. A blue flag by day and a blue light by night, dis- played at one or both ends of an engine, car or train., indicates that workmen are under or about it. When thus protected it must not be coupled to or moved. Workmen w T ill display the blue signals and the same workmen are alone authorized to remove them. Other cars must not be placed on the same track so as to intercept the view of the blue signals, without first notifying the workmen. USE OF SIGNALS. 27. A signal imperfectly displayed, or the absence of a signal at a place where a signal is usually shown, must be regarded as a stop signal, and the fact reported to the -. 214 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS 28. A combined green and white signal is to be used to stop a train only at the flag stations indicated on its schedule. When it is necessary to stop a train at a point that is not a flag station on its schedule, a red signal must be used. 29. When a signal (except a fixed signal) is given to stop a train^ it must, unless otherwise provided, be ac- knowledged as prescribed by Rule 14 (g) or (h). 30. The engine-bell must be rung when an engine is about to move. 31. The engine-bell must be rung on approaching every public road crossing at grade, and until it is passed ; and the whistle must be sounded at all whistling-posts. 32. The unnecessary use of either the whistle or the bell is prohibited. They will be used only as prescribed by rule or law, or to prevent accident. 33. Watchmen stationed at public road and street crossings must use red signals only when necessary to stop trains. SUPERIORITY OF TRAINS. 71. A train is superior to another train by right, class, or direction. Right is conferred by train order; class and direction by timetable. Right is superior to class or direction. Direction is superior as between trains of the same class. 72. Trains of the first class are superior to those of the second ; trains of the second class are superior to those of the third ; and so on. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 215 Trains in the direction specified by the timetable are superior to trains of~the same class in the opposite direc- tion. 73. Extra trains are inferior to regular trains. MOVEMENT OF TRAINS. 82. Timetable schedules, unless fulfilled, are in effect for 12 hours after their time at each station. Regular trains 12 hours behind either their schedule arriving or leaving time at any station lose both right and schedule, and can thereafter proceed only as authorized by train order. 83. A train must not leave its initial station or any division (or sub-division), or a junction or pass from double to single track, until it has been ascertained whether all trains due, which are superior or of the same class, have arrived or left. 84. A train must not start until the proper signal is given. 85. When a train of one schedule is on the time of another schedule of the same class in the same direction, it will proceed on its own schedule. Trains of one schedule may pass trains of anovher schedule of the same class, and extras may pass and run ahead of extras. 86. An inferior train must clear the time of a superior train in the same direction not less than five minutes, but must be clear at the time a first-class train, in the same direction, is due to leave the next station in the rear where time is shown. 87. An inferior train must keep out of the way of opposing superior trains, and failing to clear the main 216 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS track by the time required by rule, must be protected as prescribed by rule 99. Extra trains must clear the time of regular trains ■ minutes unless otherwise provided, and will be governed by train orders with respect to opposing extra trains. 88. At a meeting point between trains of the same class the inferior train must clear the main track before the leaving time of the superior train. At meeting points between extra trains, the train in the inferior timetable direction must take the siding, un- less otherwise provided. Trains must pull into the siding when practicable ; if necessary to back in, the train must .first be protected as prescribed by Rule 99, unless otherwise provided. 89. At meeting points between trains of different classes the inferior train must take the siding and clear the superior train at least five minutes and must pull into the siding when practicable. If necessary to back in, the train must first be protected as per Rule 99, unless otherwise provided. NOTE to Rules 88 and 89.— The Committeee rec- ommends that where greater clearance is necessary, Rule 88 should require a clearance of FIVE minutes, and Rule No. 89 of TEN minutes. 90. Trains must stop at schedule meeting stations, if the train to be met is of the same class, unless the switch is right and the track clear. When the expected train of the same class is not found at the schedule meeting sta- tion, the superior train must approach all sidings prepared to stop, until the expected train is met. Trains must stop clear of the switch used by the train to be met in going on the siding. 91. Unless some form of block signals is used trains STATION AND TRAIN WORK 217 in the same direction must keep at least five minutes apart, except in closing up at stations. NOTE to Rule 91. — The Committee recommends, that where greater clearance is necessary, Rule Xo. 91 should allow a clearance of TEX minutes or more. 92. A train must not arrive at a station in advance of its schedule arriving time. A train must not leave a station in advance of its schedule leaving time. 93. Within yard limits the main track may be used, protecting against — class trains. class and extra trains must move within yard limits, prepared to stop unless the main track is seen or known to be clear. 94. A train which overtakes another train so dis- abled that it cannot proceed, will pass it, if practicable, and if necessary will assume the schedule and take the , train orders of the disabled train, proceed to the next open telegraph office, and there report to the . The disabled train w T ill assume the schedule and take the train orders of the last-train with which it has exchanged and will, when able, proceed to and report from the next open telegraph office. When a train, unable to proceed against the right or schedule of an opposing train, is overtaken between the telegraph stations by an inferior train or a train of the same class having right or schedule which permits it to proceed, the delayed train may, after proper consultation with the following train, precede it to the next telegraph station, where it must report to . When opposing trains are met under these circumstances it must be fully explained to them by the leading train that the expected train is following. 218 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS 95. Two or more sections may be rim on the same schedule. Each section has equal timetable authority. A train must not display signals ,for a following sec- tion without order from the . 96. When signals displayed for a section are taken down at any point before that section arrives, the con- ductor will, if there be no other provision, arrange in writing with the operator, or if there be no operator, with the switchtender, or in the absence of both, with a flagman left there for the purpose, to notify all opposing inferior trains or trains of the same class leaving such point, that the section for which signals were displayed has not arrived. NOTE to Rule 96. — The Committee recommends, if a company desires to have all opposing trains notified, that the last sentence of Rule 96 be changed to read : "To notify all opposing trains that the section for which signals were displayed has not arrived." 97. Extra trains must not be run without orders from the •. 98. Trains must approach the end of double track, junctions, railroad crossings at grade, and drawbridges, prepared to stop, unless the switches and signals are right and the track is clear. When required by law, trains must stop. 99. When a train stops or is delayed, under circum- stances in which it may be overtaken by another train, the flagman must go back immediately with stop signals a sufficient distance to insure full protection. When re- called he may return to his train, first placing two tor- pedoes on the rail when the conditions require it. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 219 The front of a train must be protected in the same way, when necessary, by the . ioo. When the flagman goes back to protect the rear of his train, the must, in the case of passenger trains, and the next brakeman in the case of other trains, take his place on the train. ioi. If a train should part while in motion, trainmen must if possible, prevent damage to the detached portion. " The signals prescribed by rules 12 (d) and 14 (f) must be given. The detached portion must not be moved or passed until the front portion comes back. 102. When cars are pushed by an engine (except when shifting and making up trains in yards), a flagman must take a conspicuous position on the front of the lead- ing car. 103. Messages or orders respecting the movement of trains or the condition of track or bridges must be in writing. 104. Switches must be left in proper position after having been used. Conductors are responsible for the position of the switches used by them and their train- men, except where switchtenders are stationed. A switch must not be left open for a following train unless in charge of a trainman of such train. 105. Both conductors and enginemen are responsible for the safety of their trains and, under conditions not provided for by the rules, must take every precaution for their protection. 106. In all cases of doubt or uncertainty the safe course must be taken and no risks run. 220 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS RULES FOR MOVEMENT BY TRAIN ORDERS. 201. For movements not provided for by timetable, train orders will be issued by authority of the . They must contain neither information nor instructions not essential to such movements. They" must be brief and clear; in the prescribed forms when applicable ; and without erasure, alteration or inter- lineation. 202. Each train order must be given in the same words to all persons and trains addressed. 203. Train orders will be numbered consecutively each day, beginning- with No. — at midnight. 204. Train orders must be addressed to those who are to execute them, naming the place at which each is to receive his copy. Those for a train must be addressed to the conductor and engineman, and also to any one who acts as its pilot. A copy for each person addressed must be supplied by the operator. Orders addressed to operators restricting the move- ment of trains must be respected by conductors and en- ginemen the same as if addressed to them. 205. Each train order must be written in full in a book provided for the purpose at the office of the ; and with it recorded the names of those who have signed for the order ; the time and the signals which show when and from what offices the order w r as repeated and the responses transmitted ; and the train dispatcher's initials. These records must be made at once, and never from memory or memoranda. 206. Regular trains will be designated in train orders by their numbers, as "No. 10." or "2d No. 10/' adding engine numbers if desired. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 221 Extra trains will be "designated by engine numbers and the direction as "extra 798 'East' or 'West'." Other numbers and time will be stated in figures only. 207. ' To transmit a train order, the signal "31" or the signal "19" followed by the direction must be given to each office addressed, the number of copies being stated, if more or less than three — thus: "31 West copy 5," or "19 East copy 2." NOTE to Rule 207.— Where forms "31" and "19" are not both in use the signal may be omitted. 208. (A.) A train order to be sent to two or more offices must be transmitted simultaneously to as many of them as practicable. The several addresses must be in order of superiority of trains, each office taking its proper address. When not sent simultaneously to all. the order must be sent first to the superior train. 208. (B.) A train order to be sent to two or -more offices must be transmitted simultaneously to as many of them as practicable. The several addresses must be in order of superior- it}' of trains, and when practicable must include the operator at the meeting or waiting point, each office tak- ing its proper address. When not sent simultaneously to all, the 'order must be sent first to the superior train. Copies of the order addressed to the operator at the meeting or waiting point must be delivered to all trains affected until all have arrived from one direction. 209. Operators receiving train orders must write them in manifold during transmission, and if they cannot at one writing make the requisite number of copies, must trace others from one of the copies first made. NOTE to Rule 209. — If the typewriter is used for 222 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS copying train orders, when additional copies are made, the order must be repeated from such copies to the train dispatcher, and complete, given in the usual manner. 210. When a "31" train order has been transmitted, operators must (unless otherwise directed) repeat it at once from the manifold copy in the succession in which the several offices have been addressed, and then write the time of the repetition on the order. Each ope- rator receiving the order should observe whether the others repeat correctly. Those to whom the order is addressed, except engine- men, must then sign it, and the operator will send their signatures preceded by the number of the order to the ■. The response "complete, 1 ' and the time, with the initials of the , will then be given by the train dispatcher. Each operator receiving this response will then write on each copy the word "complete," the time, and his last name in full; and then deliver a copy to each person addressed, except enginemen. The copy for each engineman must be delivered to him personally by . ' XOTE to Rule 210. — The blanks in the above rule may be filed for each road to suit its own requirements. On roads where the signature of the engineman is de- sired, the words "except enginemen," and the last sen- tence in the second paragraph may be omitted. If pre- ferred, each person receiving an order may be required to read it aloud to the operator. 211. When a "19" train order has been transmitted, operators must (unless otherwise directed) repeat it at once from the manifold copy, in the succession in which the several offices have been addressed. Each operator receiving the order should observe whether the STATION AND TRAIN WORK 223 others repeat correctly. When the order has been re- peated correctly by an operator, the response "com- plete" and the time, with the initials of the ; will be given by the train dispatcher. The operator re- ceiving this response will then write on each copy the word "complete," the time, and his last name in full, and personally deliver a copy to each person addressed with- out taking his signature. But when delivery to engineman will take the operator -from the immediate vicinity of his office, the engineman's copy will be delivered by . Y\ nen a "19" train order restricting the superiority of a train is issued for it at the point where such superiority is restricted, the train must be brought to a stop before delivery of the order. 212. A train order niay. when so directed by the train dispatcher, be acknowledged without repeating, by the operator responding: "X ■ (number of train order) to ■ (train number), " with the operator's initials and office signal. The operator must then write on the order his initials and the time. 213. "Complete" must not be given to a train order for delivery to an inferior train until the order has been repeated or the "X" response sent by the operator who receives the order for the superior train. 214. When a train order has been repeated or "X" response sent, and before "complete'' has been given, the order must be treated as a holding order for the train addressed, but must not be otherwise acted on until "complete" has been given. If the -line fails before an office has repeated an order or has sent the "X" response, the order at that office 224 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS is of no effect and must be there treated as if it had not been sent. 215. The operator who receives and delivers a train order must preserve the lowest copy. 216. For train orders delivered by the train dis- patcher the requirements as to the record and delivery . are the same as at other points. 217. A train order to be delivered to a train at a point not a telegraph station, or at one at which the tele- graph office is closed, must be addressed to "C and E. (at ), care of ." and forwarded and delivered by the conductor or other person in whose care it is addressed. When form 31 is used "complete" will be given upon the signature of the person by whom the order is to be delivered, who must be supplied with copies for the conductor and the engineman addressed, and a copy upon which he shall take their signatures. This copy he must deliver to the first operator accessible, who must preserve it, and at once transmit the signatures of the conductor and en- gineman to the train dispatcher. Orders so delivered must be acted on as if "com- plete" had been given in the usual way. For orders which are sent, in -the manner herein pro- vided, to a train the superiority of which is thereby re- stricted, "complete" must not be given to an inferior train until the signature of the conductor and engineman of the superior train have been sent the . 218. When a train is named in a train order by its schedule number alone, all sections of that schedule are included, and each must have copies delivered to it. 219. Unless otherwise directed, an operator must not repeat or give the "X" response to a train order for a STATION AND TRAIN WORK 225 train which has been cleared or of which the engine has passed his train-order signal, until he has obtained the signatures of the conductor and engineman to the order. 220. Train orders once in effect continue so until ful- filled, superseded or annulled. Any part of an order specifying a particular movement may be either super- seded or annulled. Orders held by or issued for, or any part of an order relating to, a regular train, become void when such train loses both right and schedule as prescribed by rules 4 and 82, or is annulled. 221. (A). A fixed signal must be used at each train-order office, which shall indicate "stop" when there is an operator on duty, except when changed to "pro- ceed" .to allow a train to pass after getting train orders, or for which there are no orders. A train must not pass the signal while "stop" is indicated. The signal must be returned to "stop" as soon as a train has passed. It must be fastened at "proceed" only when no operator is on duty. Operators must have the proper appliances for hand signaling ready for immediate use if the fixed signal should fail to work properly. If a signal is not displayed at a night office, trains which have not been notified must stop and ascertain the cause and report the facts to the from the next open telegraph office. Where the semaphore is used, the arm indicates "stop" when horizontal, and "proceed" when in an inclined posi- tion. NOTE to Rule 221 A. — The conditions v/hich affect trains at stations vary so much that it is recommended each road adopt such regulations supplementary to this rule as may best suit its own requirements. 226 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS 221 (B). A fixed signal must be used at each train- order office, which shall indicate "stop" when trains are to be stopped for train orders. When there are no orders the signal must indicate "proceed." When, an operator receives the signal "31" or "19/' followed by the direction, he must immediately display the "stop signal" for the direction indicated and then reply "stop displayed," adding the direction; and until the or- ders have been delivered or annulled the signal must not be restored to "proceed." While stop is indicated, trains must not proceed without a clearance card (Form — "A"). Operators must have the proper appliances for hand signaling ready for immediate use if the fixed signal should fail to work properly. If a signal is not dis- played at a night office, trains which have not been noti- fied must stop and ascertain! the cause, and report the facts to the from the next open telegraph office. Where the semaphore is used, the arm indicates "stop" when horizontal, and "proceed'' when in an inclined posi- tion. NOTES to Rules 221 A and 221 B.— The Commit- tee has recommended two forms of Rule 221, leaving it discretionary to adopt one or both of these forms accord- ing to the circumstances of the traffic. 222. Operators will promptly record and report to the the time of departure of all trains and the direction of extra trains. They will record the time of arrival of trains and report it when so directed. 223. The following signs and abbreviations may be used: Initials for signature of the . STATION AND TRAIN WORK 227 Such office and other signals as are arranged by the C. & E— For Conductor and Engineman. X— Train will be held until order is made "complete." Com. — For Complete. O. S.— Train Report. Xo. — For Number. Eng. — For Engine. Sec. — For Section. Psgr. — For Passenger. Frt. — For Freight. Mins. — For Minutes. Jet. — For Junction. Dispr. — For Train Dispatcher. Opr. — For Operator. 3I or 19— To clear the line for Train Orders, and for operators to ask for Train Orders. S. D.— For "Stop Displayed." The usual abbreviations for the names of the months and stations. General Note. — Blanks in the rules may be filled by each road to fill its own organization or requirements. FORMS OF TRAIN ORDERS. FORM A. FIXING MEETING POINTS FOR OPPOSING TRAINS. at (I..) — - meet - at , (?•) - meet - at (and so on). EXAMPLES. (i.) No. i meet No. 2 at "B." No. 3 meet 2d No. 4 at "B." No. 5 meet Extra 95 East at "B." Extra 652 North meet Extra 231 South at "B." (2.) No. 2 and 2d No. 4 meet Nos. 1 and 3 at "C*f and Extra 95 West at "D." No. 1 meet No. 2 at "B" 2d No. 4 at "C" and Extra 95 East at 4 'D." Trains receiving these orders will run with respect to each other to the designated points and there meet in the manner provided by the Rules. FORM B. DIRECTING A TRAIN TO PASS OR RUN AHEAD OF ANOTHER TRAIN. (1.) pass at . (2.) pass when overtaken. (3-) rim ahead of to . (4.) run ahead of until over- taken. (5-) P ass at > an d run ahead of to . 228 STATION AND TRAIN WORK 229 EXAMPLES. (i.) No. i pass No. 3 at "K." (2.) No. 6 pass Xo. 4 when overtaken. (3.) Extra 594 East run ahead of No. 6 "M"' to "B." (4.) Extra 95 West run ahead of No. 3 "B" until over- taken. (5.) No. 1 pass No. 3 at "K" and run ahead of No. 7 "M" to "Z." When under (1), a train to pass another, both trains will run according to rule to the designated point, and there arrange for the rear train to pass promptly. Under (2) both trains will run according to rule until the second-named train is overtaken, and then arrange for the rear train to pass promptly. Under (3) the second-named train must not exceed the speed of the first-named train between the points designated. Under (4) the first-named train will run ahead of the second-named train from the designated station until overtaken, and then arrange for the rear train to pass promptly. When an inferior train receives an order to pass a superior train, right is conferred to run ahead of the train passed, from the designated point. FORM C. GIVING RIGHT TO A TRAIN OVER AX OPPOSING TRAIN. has right over to . EXAMPLES. (1.) No. 1 has right over Xo. 2 "G" to "X." (2.) Extra 37 East has right over No. 3 "F" to "A." This order gives right to the train first named over the other train between the points named. 230 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS If the trains meet at either of the designated points, the first-named train must take the siding, unless the order otherwise prescribes. Under (i), if the second-named train reaches the point last named before the other arrives, it may pro- ceed, keeping clear of the opposing train as many' min- utes as such train was before required to clear it under the Rules. Under (2) the regular train must not go beyond the point last named until the extra train has arrived, unless directed by train order to do so. FORM E. TIME ORDER. (1.) run late to . (2.) run late to ■ ■ and ■ late to etc. (3.) wait at until for (4.) ' — wait at until ■ until until — EXAMPLES. (I.) No. I run 20 min. late "A" to "G." (2.) No. 1 run 20 min. late "A" to "G" and 15 min. late "G" to "K," etc. (3.) No. 1 wait at "H" until 10:00 a. m. for No. 2. (4.) Nos. 1 and 3 wait at "N 7? until 10:00 a. m. "P" until 10:30 a. m. "R" until 10:55 a. m. Etc. (1) and (2) make the schedule time of the train named, between the points mentioned^ as much later as STATION AND TRAIN WORK " 231 stated in the order, and any other train receiving the order is required to run with respect to this later time, as before required to run with respect to the regular schedule time. The time in the order should be such as can be easily added to the schedule time. Under (3) the train first named must not pass the designated point before the time given, unless the other train has arrived. The train last named is required to run with respect to the time specified at the designated point or any intermediate station where schedule time is earlier than time specified in the order, as before, required to run with respect to the schedule time of the train first named. Under (4) the train (or trains) named must not pass the designated points before the times given. Other trains receiving the order are required to run with re- spect to the time specified at the designated points or any intermediate station where schedule time is earlier than the time specified in the order as before required to run with respect to the schedule time of the train or trains named. • All of these examples may be used in connection with an extra train under example (3) of form G, and the times at each point stated in the example have the same meaning as ''schedule times'' in the foregoing example. FORM F. FOR SECTIONS. (1.) display signals and run as to (2.) — : run as to ■ (2.) display signals to — for 232 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS (6.) is withdrawn as at — (7.) instead of display signals and run as to (8.) take down signals at (9.) and reverse position as and to EXAMPLES. (1.) Eng. 20 will display signals and run as 1st No. 1 A to Z. (2.) Eng. 23 run as 2d No. 1 A to Z. (3.) No. 1 display signals A to G for Eng. 63. 2d No 1 display signals B to E for Eng. pp. These examples may be modified as follows : (4.) Engs. 20, 25 and pp run as ist y 2d and 3d No. 1 A to Z. Example (1) is to be used when the number of the engine for which signals are displayed is unknown,' and is to be followed by example (2), both being singk order examples. Under examples (2) and (3) the engine named will not display signals. Under (4) the engine last named will not display sig- nals. FOR CHANGING SECTIONS. To add an intermediate section the following modifica- tion of example ( 1 ) will be used. (5.) Eng. 8 j display signals and run as 2d No. 1 N to Z. Following sections change numbers accordingly. Under (5) Eng. 85 will display signals and run as directed, and following sections will take the next higher number. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 233 To drop an intermediate section the following example will be used : (6) Eng. TIME TABLES. Question 21. — When does a new time table supercede an old one? (4). Answer. — From the moment it become effective. Question 22.— How should a train of the old time table wiiich has a corresponding number on the new time table proceed? (4). Answer. — When it corresponds in number, class, day of leaving, direction initial and terminal stations, it will STATION AND TRAIN WORK ZOD retain the corresponding number on the new time table. Question 23. — In the case of a train, the number of which does not correspond in number, class, day of leav- ing, direction, initial and terminal station, how should it proceed? (4). Answer. — Only by train order. Question 24. — In the case of a new schedule in a time table, when do they take effect? (4). Answer. — At the time for leaving the initial station on that division or subdivision. Question 25. — In what way is the date of a schedule arrived at? (4). Answer. — By the time of leaving its initial station on that division or subdivision. Question 26. — Is it permissible for more than one schedule of the same number and date to be in force on any division or subdivision? (4). Answer. — It is not. Xote. — The foregoing answers based on the Standard Code, Rule 4, have been framed in accordance with the sense of the ruling .rather than in exact accordance with its wording. By carefully reading the rule, it will be clearly seen that without exception the schedules of a new time table take effect on any division or sub-division at the initial station and leaving time- Question 27. — How many times are specified on the time table at any station? (5). Answer. — Never more than two. Question 28. — When only one time is shown, what is it? (5)- Answer. — Always the leaving time. Question 29. — When two are shown what do they in- dicate? (5). Answer. — The arriving - and the leaving time. 256 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS Question 30. — At what particular place does the time at a station apply? (5). Answer. — It applies to a switch where an inferior train takes the siding* unless otherwise indicated. If there is no siding it applies to the point from which fixed signals are operated. Should there be neither siding nor signals, it will then apply where traffic is received and discharged. Question 31. — In what manner are the meeting or pass- ing points shown in the schedule? (5). Answer. — The figures are usually printed in full face black type. Question 32. — If the arriving and leaving of a train are both shown in full face black tvpe, what does it mean? (5)- Answer. — That it is a meeting or passing point or that one or more trains are to be met between those times. Question 33. — If a train takes a siding between two adjoining telegraph offices, to be passed by one or more trains, how will the schedule show this? (5). Answer. — In full face black type and showing the time at each end of the siding. Question 34. — If one or more trains are to meet or pass a train between two times, how is attention called to it? (5)- Answer. — Question (b). — If more than one train is to meet a train at anv station, in what manner is attention called to it? (5). * Answer. — Note. — With reference to the answers to the two questions immediately above, the Standard Code leaves the sign to the discretion of the respective Railway Companies. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 257 Question 35. — In what manner are meal stops, flag- stops and regular stops shown on the schedule? (6). Answer. — By a paragraph sign for meal stops ; by the letter "F" for flag stops and by the letter "S" for regular stops. Question 36. — When- the letters "L" or "A" are shown in the schedule, what does it mean? (6). Answer. — "L" means Leave and "A" means Arrive. SIGNAL RULES. Question 37. — In the case of employees whose duty it is to give signals, state what appliances must be provided and when shoul'd they be ready for use (7). Answer. — They should be provided with the proper appliances, placed so as to be ready for immediate use when necessary. Question 38. — State what signals are used by day and what signals are used at night? (8). Answer. — By day, flags of the prescribed color must be used and at night lamps of the prescribed color must be used. Question 39. — AYhat is considered the length of time that night signals should be shown? (9). Answer. — From sunset to sunrise. Question 40. — In case of foggy weather or other un- usual conditions which obscure day signals, what should be done? (9). Answer. — In addition to the day signals, night signals should also be used. 258 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS VISIBLE SIGNALS. Question 41. — What does it signify when red is shown? (10). Answer. — Danger ; Stop. Question 42. — If white is shown what does it signify? (id). Answer. — Line clear ; proceed ; and other uses indi- cated in the rules. Question 43. — What does .it signify when green is shown? (10). Answer. — Use caution ; proceed carefully ; and for other uses indicated in the rules. Note. — It should always be remembered that green is used for markers, for fusees, and is also carried in the front of an engine to indicate when a section of the same numbered train is following. The color of the signal indicating "Proceed" and "Caution" has been left to the discretion of each road by the Standard Code Committee. Sometimes green is used for proceed and on some roads green and red for caution, while others use yellow for caution and green for proceed. The original recom- mendation by the Committee on Train Rules of the American Railway Association specify white for proceed and green for caution, as indicated by the above two questions immediately preceding this note. Question 44. — What does it signify when green and white are shown together? (10). Answer. — Not a regular stop but one known as a flag stop for passengers or freight. Question 45. — If blue is shown, what does it signify? (10). Answer.— That cars must not be moved when thus pro- tected. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 259 Question 46. — When may a red fusee be passed when one is found burning? (n). Answer. — When it is completely burned out. Question 47. — What does it signify when a green fusee is shown burning? (12). Answer. — It is a signal of caution. Xote. — To avoid the danger of fire care should be used when throwing fusees to see that they do not fall near wooden struc- tures. HAND, FLAG AND LAMP SIGNALS. Question 48. — When the hand, flag or lamp signals are swung across the track, what does it indicate? (12). Answer. — Stop ! STOP— Swung across the track. Question 49. — When raised and lowered vertically what is indicated? (12). Answer. — Proceed. 260 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS Question 50.— What signals should be given by hand, ilag or lamp if a train is to back? (12). Answer. — They should be swung vertically in a circle at half arm's length across the track when train is stand- ing. PROCEED— Raised and lowered vertically. BACK— Swung vertically in a circle across the track. Question 51. — What signals should be given if a train has parted? (12). Answer. — Swung vertically in a circle at arm's length across the track while train is running Question 52. — What signal should be given to apply the air brake? (12). Answer. — Swung horizontally in a circle while train is standing still. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 26] fit" t \ \ TRAIN HAS PARTED— Swung: vertically in a circle at arm's length' across the track*. APPLY AIR BAAKES— Swung hori- RELEASE AIR BRAKES— zontally in a circle, Held at arm's length above the head. 262 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS Question 53. — To release the air brake, what signal should be given? (12). Answer. — At arm's length above grade while train is standing still. Question 54. — When anyone on or near the track vio- lently waves any object, what is it considered a signal for? (13). Answer. — It is a signal to stop. Note. — The manner in which a signal should be obeyed is in- dicated by the speed at which it is given. When given rapidly, it indicates to move rapidly. When given slowly, it indicates to move slowly. AUDIBLE SIGNALS, Question 55. — To apply the brakes what signal is given? (14A). , Answer. — One short blast of the whistle. Question 56. — To release the brakes, what signal is given? (14B). Answer. — Two long blasts of the whistle. Question 57. — When the engineer desires the flagman to go back and protect the rear of the train, what signal does he give? (14C). Answer. — One long and three short blasts of the whistle. Question 58. — When a flagman is called in from the south and west, wdiat signal is given? (14D). Answer.— Four long blasts of the whistle. Question 59. — When the flagman is called in from the north and east, what signal is given? (14E). Answer. — Five long blasts of the whistle. Question 60. — When the engineman signals that the train is parted, what signal does he give? (14F). STATION AND TRAIN WORK 263 Answer.— Three long blasts of the whistle. Ouestion 61. — How often is the signal repeated? (hf). Answer. — Until answered. Ouestion 62. — When a signal is given that the train is parted, what signal does the engineman give in an- swer? (14F). Answer. — Three long blasts of the whistle. Ouestion 63. — What signal should trainmen give in answer to a signal from the engineman that train has parted? (14F). Answer. — Hand, flag or lamp swung vertically in a circle at arm's length across the track. Ouestion 64. — For answering signals not otherwise provided for, what signal does the engineman give ? (I4G).- Answer. — Two short blasts of the whistle. Note. — Enginemen are not required to answer fixed signals. All other signals given to stop a train either by hand, lamp, flag, fusees or torpedoes should be answered by two short blasts of the steam whistle. Three long blasts of the whistle should be used when answering a signal that the train has parted. Question 65. — When a train is standing, what is the signal to back? (14H). Answer. — Three short blasts of the whistle. Ouestion 65A. — When train is running what is indi- cated by three sharp blasts of the whistle? (14H). Answer. — It is an answer to the conductor's signal to stop at the next station. Ouestion 66. — When an engineman wants to call for signals from switchmen, watchmen, trainmen and others, what signal does he give? (14J). Answer. — Four short blasts of the whistle. 264 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS Question 67. — When crews of trains of the same or inferior class must have attention called to signals dis- played for following* sections what signal is used? (14k). Answer. — One long and two short blasts of the whistle. Question 67a. — Is the attention of crews, yard engines and extra trains called to signals displayed for following sections by the same signal: viz., one long and two short blasts of the whistle? (14k). Answer. — Yes. Question 68. — At public grade crossings, what signal is given? (141). Answer. — Two long and two short blasts of the whistle. Xote. — The American Railway Association failed to approve of a whistle signal for meeting point. Probably the middle order is the best way to protect the meeting point. Question Cxj. — For approaching stations, railroad cross- ings and junctions what is the signal? (14m). Answer. — ( )ne long blast of the whistle. Question 70. — When several short blasts of the whistle are given, what does it indicate? (14). Answer. — The warning or alarm for persons or cattle on the track and also for calling attention to danger ahead. Xote. — In giving these signals correctly every care should be taken and prompt attention given to any infraction of these rules. Extraordinary precautions in giving whistle signals in stormy weather should be used and care exercised to make signals clear and distinct. Question 71. — What is indicated by the explosion of one torpedo? (15). Answer. — Come to a dead stop. Question J2. — What is indicated when tw r o torpedoes explode not more than 200 feet apart? (15). STATION AND TRAIN WORK 265 Answer. — Speed should be reduced and a sharp lookout kept for the stop signal. Note. — Care should be taken not to place torpedoes at cross- ings or stations where people are likely to pass them. For various reasons torpedoes should not be wholly depended upon to stop trains. AIR-WHISTLE OR BELL-CORD SIGNALS. Question 73. — When train is standing' wdiat is indicated by two blasts of the air-whistle? (16a). Answer. — Start. Question 74. — What is indicated when two blasts of air-whistle are given when train is running? (16b). Answer. — Stop. , Question 75. — When train is standing and three blasts of air-whistle are given what does it indicate? (16c). Answer. — Back. Question 76. — When train is running and three blasts of air-whistle are given what does it indicate? (i6d). Answer. — Come to a stop at .next station. Question JJ. — When train is standing and four blasts of air-whistle are given what does it indicate? (i6e). Answer. — Apply or release the brakes. Question 78. — When train is running and four blasts of air-whistle are given, what does it indicate? (i6f). Answer. — Reduce speed. Question 79. — When train is at a standstill what does five blasts of the air-whistle indicate (i6g). Answer. — Call for the flagman to come in. Question 80. — When train is running and five blasts 266 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS of the air-whistle are given, what does it indicate? (i6h). Answer. — Speed should be increased. Note. — When a stop is to be made at the next station, signals should be given as soon as possible after leaving previous station, to avoid the possibility of mistaking the engineman's answer for an answer to a flagman's signal. TRAIN SIGNALS. Question 8l. — After sunset what signals should be pro- vided on front of a train? (i/). Answer. — A head-light. Question 82. — When a train starts out to meet an- other and has stopped clear of main track, or is standing to meet train at the end of a double track or at junctions, what should be done to the head light? (17). Answer. — It should be covered. Question 82a. — Should the head light be covered before the train is clear and the switch right? (17). Answer. — No. Question 82b.— Suppose there are two trains at a sta- tion for an opposing train and the second train is unable to clear on account of a too short siding, would they de- pend for protection on the head light on being streamed on the leading train? (17). Answer. — They would not. In such a case a flagman should be immediately sent out by the second train to afford full protection. Question 82c. — Then wdiere is the necessity of leaving the head light on the leading train uncovered? (17). Answer. — Because the train cannot properly be con- sidered clear of the main track while the main track switch remains open for the second train. Not until the switch is properly closed, may the head light be covered. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 267 Question 82(1. — Would not the head light of the leading engine be likely to have a blinding effect upon the eye sight of the engineer of the approaching train to such an extent that he would be unable to see the flagman from the train following. (17). Answer. — It would hardly interfere with his vision to the extent of preventing his seeing the flagman. The headlight is of itself an indication that the train is not clear, therefore the ap- proaching train ought to be moving with caution, fully prepared to stop at the switch. If the leading train had its headlight cov- ered the opposing train would approach at a much higher rate of speed so that the flags from the following train might be much less effectual than the headlight on the leading train. Note. — At a meeting point where there are more trains than the siding will hold the headlight of the leading train should not be concealed. Question 83. — After sunset, what signals must the out engine display? (18). Answer. — Head light at front and -rear or two white lights. Question 84. — Should yard engines display markers? (18). Answer. — No. Question 85. — What are markers? (19). Answer. — By day green flags ; by night a green light jto side and front and in the rear a red light. Question 86. — Where are markers displayed? (19). Answer. — The rear of a train. Question 87. — What do markers indicate.' (19). Answer. — The rear end of a train. Question 88. — Should a train meet or pass your train at a meeting or passing point without displaying mark- ers, what would you do? (19). 268 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS Answer. — I would signal the passing train and remain in the clear until the rear portion of same train has passed because the absence of markers would indicate a train had parted. Question 89. — What change must be made in the mark- ers when a train is clear of the main track? (19). Answer. — At front, side and in the rear, green lights must be displayed. Question 90. — When must the signals be displayed again? (19). Answer. — After the train to be met has gone cr passed. Question 91. — What signal must all sections of a train, except the last, display on the front of the engine when it is running in two or more sections? (20). Answer. — Two green flags during the day and at night two green lights in addition. Question 93. — When a train carries two white flags by day and at night two white lights in addition on the front of the engine what does it indicate? (21). Answer. — An extra train. Question 93a. — When should the white signals be re- moved from an extra train? (21). Answer. — When it has reached the end of its run and is entirely clear of the main track. Question 94. — When two or more engines are coupled together and carrying signals, how must they be dis- played? (22). Answer. — On the leading engine only. Question 94a. — When two or more engines coupled together are running backward as a section of a train carrying signals for following section on which engine STATION AND TRAIN WORK 269 will the display markers be placed, and on which engine the classification signals be shown? (22). Answer. — The classification signal must be displayed on the leading engine in the place provided for it near Lhe hecta light; The display markers on the place pro- vided for them on the pilot of the rear engine. Note. — When two or more engines are coupled together the sounding of signals and operation of the air should be done by the engineer of the leading engine. When running as an extra. the number on the leading engine is applied to the extra and orders addressed to this train should be addressed to the leading train, because the train is identified by its number. Copies of all clearances and all train orders must be provided for the engine- man of each engine. Question 95. — How must one flag the light up ahead when displayed as a classification signal (23). Answer. — In the same manner as if it were not dis- played. Question 96.— What must be displayed on the front of the leading car when cars are being pushed by an en- gine at night? (24). Answer. — A white light. Question 97. — Is there any exception to this rule? (24). Answer. — There is. It need not be done when switch- ing or making up trains in yards. Question 98. — In the case of a passenger train must each car have communication with the engine? (25). Answer. — Yes. Question 99. — For this purpose what appliance is used ? (25). Answer. — Air whistle signals or gong and cord. Question 100. — What must be done before coupling to, moving, or placing other cars in front of cars, engine, 270 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS or train, when protected by a blue signal if shown on the end of the car, engine or train? (26). Answer. — It must be removed by the person who placed it there. Question 101 — Is it permissible to place other cars on the same -track, thereby intercepting view of the blue signals. (26). Answer. — It is, provided the railroad men have first been notified. USE OF SIGNALS. Question 102. — In the event of the absence of a cus- tomary signal or a signal imperfectly displayed, how should it be regarded and what is your duty in such cases? (27). Answer. — It should be regarded as a signal to stop and your duty would be to report it to a superior officer. Note. — All fixed signals which include white lights are re- ferred to by Rule 27. Question 103. — What are the purposes for which the colors green and white are used? (28). Answer. — To stop trains at block stations. Question 104. — May the colors green and white be used to stop a train at a point other than a block stop for that particular train? (28). Answer. — No. In such a case a red signal must be used. Question 105. — When a signal other than a fixed sig- nal is given to stop a train how must it be acknowledged ? (29). Answer. — By two short blasts of the whistle. Question 106. — At what times is it absolutely requisite that the engine bell be rung? (30 & 31). STATION AND TRAIN WORK 271 liHill 2© < «•= < »- ° « 5» 9 •"I * * So" & o£ -a OC -J a, O X (9 *5 STATION* AND TRAIN WORK 273 274 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS STATION AND TRAIN WORK 275 Bpjfii izj3i < I|hq7 f-3 ©2 OB &• ■"SIR &a. ill til *Z© oaas i B5© SB w .1 -1 I 1 - & a '-c ■g as = * a a S Z 5 J *2 in iv rzz ^^m FCQ I I ^ Si ©3U° s*a ©«« 13 II 5 5 276 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS /% -k (Rear or Tender) fl Uf Jl ENGINE RUNNING BACKWARD BY NIGHT WITHOUT CARS OR AT THE FRONT OF A TRAIN PULLING CARS. White light at A. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 277 REAR OF TRAIN BY OAY Green fla^s at A A, as markers 278 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS STATION AND TRAIN WORK 279 JL 3 L^ T o 8 uJ *"" ES g CO 280 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS Answer. — Always when the engine is about to move when approaching every public road crossing at grade. Question 107. — At what other places must the whistle always be sounded? (31). Answer. — At all whistling posts. Question 108. — Is it prohibited to use the bell and whistle unnecessarily? (32). Answer. — Yes. Question 109. — At Public roads and street crossings when will the rights be used by switchmen? (33). Answer. — Only when necessary to stop trains. SUPERIORITY OF TRAINS. Note. — Except in the case of extra trains moving in the same direction on which the time table confers superiority by permit- ting it to hold the main track at a meeting point with an op- posing extra train, there is no superiority between extra trains. Question no. — In what manner is one train superior to another? (71). Answer. — By right, class or direction. Question in. — In what manner does a train acquire its rights? (71). Answer. — By a train order. Question 112. — How does a train acquire its class and direction? (71). Answer. — By the time table. Question 112a. — Explain which is superior, right, class or direction? (71). Answer. — Right is superior to class or direction and direction is superior when governing trains of the same class. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 281 Question 112b. — Explain relative superiority of trains to their respective classes. (72). Answer. — First class trains are* superior to trains of the second class and all successive classes. Second class trains are superior to third and all successive classes and so on. Trains in the direction as specified in the time table are superior to the trains of the same class run- ning In the opposite direction. Question 112c. — In this division in which direction are trains superior to trains of the same class in an opposite direction? (72). Answer. — Question H2d. — Are extra trains inferior to regular trains? (73). Answer. — They are. MOVEMENT OF TRAINS. Xote. — No matter how late they may be all schedule trains should register on the page which corresponds with the date on which the train is due to arrive or leave a station. Extra trains register on the page corresponding with the date they actually do arrive. Question 113. — How late must a regular train be, be- fore it loses both right and class? (82). Answer. — After regular trains have become twelve hours late from schedule arriving or leaving time at any station they lose both right and schedule and thereafter proceed only as authorized by train order. Question 114. — Suppose No. 6 is due to arrive at at 9:30 a. m. and leave at 10:30 a. m., when will it have lost both its right and class? (82). Answer. — If it fails to arrive at before 9 -.30 282 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS p. m. or to leave before 10 130 p. m., it will have lost its rights. Question 115. — In* such a case may No. 6 flag into • at 9 140 p. m. and leave there as No. 6 if it can get out before 10:30 p. m. and so retain its rights? (82) Answer. — No, it cannot. Question 116. — Would it be possible for it to leave as No. 6 before 10:30 p. m. providing the dispatcher author- izes it by train order? (82). Answer. — Yes. Note. — When trains are run in sections, any' section which becomes twelve hours late on schedule, loses both its rights and class according to Rule 82; no allowance being made for sections running five minutes apart. A train which holds an order to run late, will lose both right and class as soon as it is twelve hours behind its schedule time. The fact that it has an order permitting it to run late does not lengthen the life of a train. In every case the schedule time as shown upon the time tafile is referred to by Rule 82. Question 116a. — Suppose an opposing train has an or- der to meet No. 6 at a certain station and No. 6 came twelve hours late in arriving at that particular station,, should the opposing train proceed against No. 6? (82). Answer. — Yes. Question 117. — Before leaving a junction terminal or any other stopping point or before passing from a double to a single track what must be ascertained? (83). Answer. — It must be positively ascertained that all. trains of the same or superior class have gone. Note. — Rule S3 has reference to trains of the same class, even though they may be moving in the inferior direction, for the reason that a train of superior direction must approach all sidings prepared to stop, until in accordance with Rule 99 such train is. met. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 283 Question 118. — Without a proper signal may a train start? (84). Answer. — No. Question 119. — May a train proceed in advance of a train of the same class in the same direction? (85). Answer. — Yes. Question 120. — May one extra train pass another extra or may one train of a certain class pass a train of the same class? (85). Answer. — Yes. Question 121. — How must the time of a superior train be cleared by an inferior train going in the same direc- tion? (86). Answer. — By not less than five minutes. Question 121a. — How must a first class train be cleared by an inferior train going in the same direction? (86). Answer — The inferior train must be cleared at the time the first class train is due to leave the next station, in the rear where the time is shown. Question 121b. — With respect to approaching superior trains what is required of an inferior train ? (87). Answer. — It must keep out of the way. Question 121c. — How must a train be protected which fails to clear the main track as required by rules? (87). Answer. — In accordance with rule 99, it must be pro- tected by flag. Question I2id. — By how many minutes must the time of regular trains be clear by extras? (87). Answer. — By minutes. Question 12 ie. — With respect to opposing extras how should extras be governed? (87). Answer. — By train order. Question 122. — Between trains of the same class at 284 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS meeting points, when must the inferior train clear the main track? (88). Answer. — Before the leaving time of the train of the superior class. Note. — Trains should not wait on a siding an unreasonable length of time for another train. In such cases a communication should be opened with the telegraph office for further instruc- tions. When holding the main track at the meeting point or passing point, care should be taken to adjust the switch for other trains. Question 123. — What must be done should it become necessary to back in, in order to clear the main track? (88). Answer. — In accordance with rule 99, a flagman must be sent out unless other provision has been made. Question 123a. — Which extra should take the siding when two extras pass at a meeting point? (88). Answer. — The extra in the inferior time table direc- tion. Xote. — When Rule 88 was adopted in the Convention it was the sense of the Convention that at a meeting point should an inferior train have occasion to back, it must stop the superior train before passing the switch where the inferior train enters. If the back-in provision is covered by a train order or special instruction it would be unnecessary to stop the superior train before backing in, although the flagman should be sent out in accordance with Rule 99 before the switch has been passed by the inferior train. Question 124. — At meeting points between trains of unequal classes, by how many minutes must the inferior train clear? (89). Answer. — The inferior train must take the siding and by at least five minutes, clear the time of the superior train. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 285 Question 125. — What must be done in case the infe- rior train has to back in? (89). Answer. — In accordance with rule 99, a flagman must be sent out to protect the train. Question 126. — By how many minutes must an infe- rior train clear the time of a superior train going in the same direction? (89). Answer.— Five minutes. Question 127. — When are trains required to stop at scheduled meeting or passing points, although o^ the same class. (90). , Answer. — They are required to stop unless they can plainly see that the switch was right and the track clear. Question 128. — At what point should the train be stopped? (90). i Answer. — It should be stopped clear of the switch in which the train to be met or passed uses when going on the siding. Question 129. — Suppose a train to be met or passed is not the schedule meeting or passing point, in what way would the train be governed which has the right of track? (90). Answer. — It should proceed with caution, approach the sidings prepared to stop, under full control until the expected train is met or passed. Question 130. — In the absence of block signals, by how many minutes must trains going in the same direc- tion be kept apart? (91). . Answer. — They should be kept at least five minutes apart in closing up at stations. Question 130a. — Suppose trains No. 2 and No. 4 to be of the same class and No. 2 is scheduled to pass No. 286 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS 4 at . In the event No. 2 or No. 4 should be late would it affect its passing point? (91). Answer. — It would not. If number 4 were late, No. 2 would proceed to and wait there for No. 4 to pass. Question 130b. — If it were desirable that No. 2 should proceed ahead of No. 4. what form of order should be issued? (90). Answer. — An order issued to read, "No. 4 will pass No. 2 at ." (See form B, example 1 Standard Code). Question 131. — Is it permissible for train to leave at a station in advance of the schedule time shown for it to leave? (92). Answer. — No. Question 132. — May a train leave a station before its leaving time as shown in the schedule? (92). Answer. — No. Question 133. — What class of trains may hold the main track by protecting against other trains when within yard limits. (93). Answer. . — Class. Question 133a. — When moving within yard limits, how should class and extra trains proceed? (93). Answer. — In full control, prepared to stop unless main track is seen or known to be clear. Question 134. — Suppose a train overtakes another train of the same or superior class unable to move because of a breakdown, what should be done? (94). Answer. — Assume the schedule and take the orders of the disabled train, if necessary, proceed to the next open telegraph office and report the particulars to the superintendent. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 261 Question 135. — When a disabled train has surrendered its orders and rights to a following train that has passed it, on what rights does the disabled train then move? (94). Answer. — On the rights of the train with which it exchanged orders? Xote. — If a disabled train has rights of its own to make the next telegraph office it is unnecessary for a passing train to assume its schedule and take its train orders. An exchange of orders and schedule would avail nothing in case the disabled train had been so long delayed that it had forfeited all rights to proceed. In that case the following train might have no rights and so both trains would be tied up. The exchange of orders and schedules should always be made complete. (See Rule 94.) Question 135a. — If a train of inferior or the same class with rights or schedule to proceed should overtake a train between telegraph offices which is unable to pro- ceed against the right of schedule of an opposing train, how should they be governed? (94). Answer. — After proper consultation with the following- train the delayed train precedes it to the next telegraph station, where it will report to . Question 135b. — What shoa I be done when opposing trains are met under these circumstances? (94). Answer. — It must be fully explained by the leading train that the excepted train is following. Question 136. — Is it allowable for more than one sec- tion of a train to be run on the same schedule? (95). Answer. — Yes. Question 137. — Where there are more than one section of a train, does each section have equal timetable author- ity? (95). Answer. — Yes. 288 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF- TRAINS Question 137a. — When signals are displayed by whose authority is it done? (95). Answer. . Note. — The practice varies on different railroads. Yardmas- ters are authorized to issue instructions to a train to display signals on some roads. Where the business is heavy, and the issuing of such orders by the Dispatcher would interfere with his other duties, it is customary for the yardmaster to issue such instructions. This practice is considered safe, because all sec- tions must examine the register to ascertain before leaving that the section ahead of them has registered signals. Question 139. — On a single track when signals dis- played for following train are taken down at any point before the following train arrives, how should a con- ductor be governed under the respective conditions as follows: (96). A. At a point where there is an agent, operator, switch tender or register book. Answer. — Arrangements should be made by the Con- ductor with the agent, operator or switch tender to notify opposing train of, same or inferior class. B. Where there is no agent, operator or switch tender, what should be done? Answer. — In this case, a flagman must be left to notify opposing train of the same or inferior class. Question 139a. — How should these arrangements be made, verbally or in writing? (96). Answer. — In writing. Question 140. — When extra trains are run, by whose authority do they move? (97). Answer. . Note. — The displaying of signals or running of an extra train is left by the Standard Code to the discretion of the railroad. Usually for this purpose the Superintendent's initials are used. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 289 Question 141. — When approaching the end of a double track, railroad crossings at grade, draw-bridges and junc- tions, how should trains proceed? (98). Answer. — Under control prepared to stop unless switch and signals are right and track clear. In cases when it is required by law, trains must stop. Question 142. — How must a train be protected which becomes delayed or stops under circumstances in which it may be overtaken by another train? (99). Answer. — Flagman must immediately go back a suffi- cient distance to procure full protection provided with the usual stop signals. Question 143. — Before returning, when the flagman is recalled to his train, what should he do? (99). Answer. — Place two torpedoes on the rails. Question 144. — When moving on a single track, how should front of engine be protected? (99). Answer. — It should be protected by flag which should be shown by the head brakeman and in case he is unable to go by the fireman. Note. — In regard to Rule 99, it may be noted the flagman must immediately go back without waiting for the conductor to send for him or the engineman to whistle him back. Question 145. — Who must take the place of the flag- man after he has gone back to protect the rear of the train? (100). Answer. — The , if it is a passenger train and in the case of other trains, the next brakeman. Question 146. — If a train should part while in motion, what should be done? (101). Answer. — The train parted signals should be given as prescribed by rules 12 (d) and 14 (f) and attempt made 290 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS to prevent the detached portions from becoming dam- aged. The detached portion should not be moved or passed until the front portion (which has right of track to return) comes back. If the vision is obstructed, a flag- man should be sent ahead to the foremost portion which must run with great caution. Question 147. — How would you proceed in case you overtook a train that had parted? (101). Answer. — Would neither move or pass around the rear portion. Question 148. — What precaution must be taken to in- sure safety when train is being pushed by an engine? (102). Answer.- — In order to signal in case of necessity the flagman must ride on the head car. Question 149. — In what form ought messages to be given respecting the movements of trains or condition of track and bridges? (103). Answer. — In writing. Question 150. — After using switches how should they be left? (104). Answer. — In proper position. Question 151. — What member of the train crew is re- sponsible for the proper adjustment of switches? (104). Answer. — Except in cases where switch tenders are stationed, the conductor. Question 152. — If a section of a train is following, is it permissible to leave the switch open? (104). Answer. — It is not, unless it is in charge of a trainman of the following train. Question 153. — What members of the train crew are held responsible for the safety of their train? (105). Answer. — The Conductor and the Enrineman. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 291 Question 154. — What must be done by Conductors and Enginemen when an emergency arises that is not covered by the rules? (105). Answer. — Every precaution must be taken to prevent accident. Question 155. — What should be done in case of doubt or uncertainty? (106). Answer. — The safe course must always be taken and no risks run. RULES FOR MOVEMENT BY TRAIN ORDERS. Question 156. — Why are train orders used and in what form should they be issued? (201). Answer. — To govern the movements of trains not pro- vided for by timetable; they must be issued in the- pre- scribed forms. Question 156a. — What must train orders contain and how should they be worded? (201). Answer. — They must contain only information and instruction governing the movements of trains ; in their wording they must be brief and clear. Question 156b. — Is it proper to accept train orders which show erasures and interlineations? (201). Answer. — No. Question 157. — When the same train orders are issued to various persons or trains, must they be given in exact form and wording to each? (202). Answer. — Yes. Question 158. — When a new series of numbers for train orders is started, at what time each day will it begin and in what order are they numbered? (203). 292 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS Answer. — A new series begin at midnight and they are numbered in consecutive order. Question 159. — When train orders are issued, to whom are they addressed? (204). Answer. — When issued to a train, they must be ad- dressed to the conductor, engineman and also to anyone who acts as pilot and in other cases to those who are to carry them into execution. Question 159a. — Should each engineman have copies of all orders affecting a train when two or more engines are attached to it? (204). Answer. — Yes. Question 159b. — May the train order issued to one train be applied to and used by any other train? (204). Answer. — No. Question 159c — When train orders are addressed to operators, restricting movements of trains, how should they be respected by conductors and enginemen? (204). Answer. — The same as if addressed to them. Question 160. — Must train dispatchers keep a record of train orders, and if so, when must such records be made ? (205). Answer. — The train dispatcher must keep a full record of all train orders issued in a book provided for the pur- pose, must record the names of those who have signed for the orders, the time, signals and from what office the order was repeated and the response transmitted. Must also have the train dispatcher's initials. Such record must be made immediately at time orders are given and completed and never from memory or memorandum. Question 161. — In what manner are regular trains designated in train orders? (206). Answer. — Always by their numbers. For example, STATION AND TRAIN WORK 293 "first No. 6 or second No. 6" and where desirable the engine number may also be added. Question 161a. — How are extra trains designated in train orders? (206). Answer. — Extra trains are designated by their engine numbers with the direction of the train added. For ex- ample, "Extra 678 West/' Question 161b. — How should train numbers and time be stated on train orders? (206). Answer. — Only in figures. Question 162. — When dispatcher is transmitting an order what signal does he give to each office? (207). Answer. — "31 or 19" followed by direction and by in- formation that more or less than three copies are desired, the operator is informed. For example, "31 West copy |" or "19 East copy 2." Note. — These signals may be omitted where figures 31 and 19 are not both in use. Question 163. — When a train order is to be sent to two or more offices, in what manner must it be sent? (208a).. Answer. — Simultaneously to as many as practicable. Question 163a. — In what order must several addresses be given when a number of orders are sent simulta- neously? (208a). Answer. — In the order of superiority of trains, each office taking its proper numbers. Question 164b. — When train orders are not sent simul- taneously to all, how will the order be sent? (208a). Answer. — To the superior train first. Question 164c. — What will the operator at the meet- ing or waiting point do with the train orders? (208b). Answer. — Deliver copies of the order to all trains affected, until all have arrived from one direction. 294 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS Question 165. — When operators are transmitting train orders should they make copies of them on manifold blanks and in case he fails to make enough copies how may he supply them? (209). Answer. — He must write copies in manifold and failing to make sufficient number must trace others from one of the copies first made. Question 166. — When operators have a "31" order to repeat, how should they proceed? (210). Answer. — They must repeat the order immediately from the manifold in the succession in which the several offices have been addressed and watch to see that others repeat it correctly unless Otherwise directed. Question 167. — Who is to sign for it after the order has been repeated? (210). Answer. — The person to whom the order is addressed, except enginemen. Question 168. — What must the operator do after the order has been signed? (210). Answer. — Send the signature to the dispatcher who will then give the "complete" and time; also the initials of the after which the operator will write on each copy the word "complete," the time and his last name in full and deliver a copy to each person addressed except the engineman. The copy to each engineman must be delivered to him personally by . Note. — In regard to Rule 210, the blanks may be filed to suit the requirements of each road. On roads where the signature of the engineman is desired the words "except engineman" may be omitted. If preferred each person receiving an order may be required to read it aloud to the operator. Question 169. — What must be done when a "No. 19" order is received? (211). STATION AND TRAIN WORK 295 Answer. — Unless otherwise directed the operator must repeat it at once from the manifold copy in the succes- sion in which the several offices have been addressed, care being taken by each operator to see that the others repeat it correctly. When the order has been correctly repeated the response "complete" and the time with the initials of the will be given by the train dispatcher. The operator will then write on each copy the word complete, the time and his last name in full and personally deliver a copy to each person addressed without taking his signa- ture. If in order to deliver a copy to the engineman the operator must leave the immediate vicinity of the office, the engineman's copy will be delivered by . Question 169a. — How will delivery be made when a "19" train order is issued for a train at a point where its superiority is restricted by such an order? (211). Answer. — Train must be brought to a stop before de- livery of an order. Question 170. — When may W X" response be given in acknowledgment of a train order having been delivered? (212). Answer. — A train order may, when so directed by the train dispatcher, be acknowledged without repeating by the operator and he will say "X" (order) No. to (train) No. , giving also his initials and office signal. After having done this -he will write on the order his initials and the time. Question 171. — In the case of an inferior train when may ''complete'' be given? (213). Answer. — When the order has been repeated or "X" response has been sent by the operator who receives the order for the superior train. Question 172. — Before "complete^ has been given and 296 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS after it has been repeated or "X J> response sent, how is an order regarded? (214). Answer. — As a holding order. Question 172a. — When a train order has been repeated or "X" response sent and before "complete" has been given how then must the order be treated? (214). Answer. — As a holding order for train addressed. Question 172b. — In case the wire fails after a "31" or- der has been sent and repeated or "X" response sent and before "complete" .has been received, has the train the right to proceed to which the order is addressed? (214). Answer. — Xo. Question 172c. — If before an office has repeated an order or "X" response has been sent the wire should fail, would the order be effective? (214). Answer. — No. Question 173. — Which of the copies of the train order should be kept by the operator? (215). Answer. — The lowest copy. Question 174. — When train orders are delivered by the train dispatcher what are the requirements as to record and delivery? (216). Answer. — Same as at other points or offices. Question 175. — In the case of a train order being de- livered to a train at a point not a telegraph office or at a station at which the telegraph office is closed, how should it be addressed? (217). Answer. — Conductor and Engineman at No. care . Question 175a. — When form "31" is used, whose sig- nature must be taken before " complete'' is given and what copies should the person delivering the order have? (217). STATION AND TRAIN WORK 297 Answer. — The person in whose care the order is sent should sign it and should have one copy for the engine- man, one for the conductor and one for the person who delivers the order. Question 175b. — Whose signature must appear on the copy which he retains and what must he do with it? (217). Answer. — The signature of the conductor and engine- man of the train to which the order applies. It should be delivered to the telegraph office which he can first reach. Question 175c. — Is the order to be regarded as if "com- plete" had been given in the usual manner by the train receiving it and so be governed accordingly? (217). Answer. — Yes. Question I75d. — May '"complete" be given to an in- ferior train when orders are sent as above, before the signature of the conductor and engineman of the supe- rior whose rights are thereby restricted? (217). Answer. — No. Question 176. — When a train is running in more than one section, are all its sections included when it is named in an order unless particular sections are specified and should copies of the orders be furnished to each section? (218). Answer. — Yes. Question 177. — May the "X" response or repeat be given by an operator to a train order for a train, the engine of which has passed the train order signal before they ascertained that the conductor and engineman had been notified that he has orders for them? (219). Answer. — No, not unless otherwise directed. Note. — The "X" response is to be used to save time in getting an inferior train started. Quite a saving of time is effected when 298 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS several orders are concerned. The Dispatcher, however, should require a repetition of the order as soon as he can get it when the "X" response has been used. Question 178. — After train orders have once taken effect, how long do they continue in force? (220). Answer. — Until fulfilled, superseded or annulled. Question 179. — May a particular portion of an order which specifies a particular movement be annulled or superseded? (220). Answer. — It may. Question 179a. — Suppose a train has lost its rights as per rule 4 and 82, would orders held by or issued for it be effective? (220). Answer. — No. Question 179b. — Suppose a certain part of an order re- lating to a regular train should become void when such a train has lost both right and class in accordance with rule 4 and 82 or is annulled, does that part of the order become void? (220). Answer. — It does. Note. — The annullment indication of the signal on some roads is "proceed." Where such is the case, the following five ques- tions do not apply. Question 180. — When the operator is on duty at train order office, what does the fixed signal indicate? (221a). Answer. — Stop. Question 180a. — When a stop signal is displayed may a train pass? (221a). Answer. — No. Question 180b. — When is this signal fastened at "Pro- ceed?" (221a). Answer. — When there is no operator on duty. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 299 Question 181c. — What is required of conductor and engineer if the train order signal is not displayed at a night office? (221a). Answer. — Bring the train to a stop, learn the cause and report the facts from the next open telegraph office. Question i8id. — In case fixed signals fail, what signals must operators keep on hand to use in their stead? (221a). Answer. — Hand signals. Note. — Where the annullment indication of the signal is "stop," as it is on some roads, the following seven questions will not apply. Question 182. — At a train order office what is indicated when fixed signal is displayed and there are no orders? (221b). Answer. — Proceed. Question 182a. — When there are orders what will the fixed signals indicate? (221a). Answer. — Stop. Question 182b. — In case an operator receives the signal "31" or "19" what should he do? (221b). Answer. — Display the stop signal immediately and re- ply "Stop and Display." Question 182c. — When the dispatcher gives the "31" or "19" signal must he give the direction also? (221b). Answer. — Yes. Question i82d. — Under what conditions may a train pass a train order stop signal? (221b). Answer. — When a clearance card is issued. Note. — No trains must pass while a train order signal re- mains at block, notwithstanding they may have received orders without first getting a clearance card. 300 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS Question 183c — What must be done if signals are not displayed from a night office? (221b). Answer. — Bring the train to a stop, learn the cause and report at the next open telegraph office. Question i83f. — When the signal indicates stop, in what position is it? (221b). Answer. . Question i83g. — In case these signals fail what must operators have on hand ready for use? (221b). Answer. — Hand signals. Note. — If an operator changes signal from stop to proceed after the train has stopped the conductor may signal it to leave, and it may proceed without orders or clearance card, provided that the engineman can see the signal is clear. Question 184. — Should operator record the time of trains and report same? (222). Answer. — Yes. Question 185. — What abbreviations are customary? Answer. — Signs for the signature of the . Such offices and other signals as are arranged by the C. & E. — for Conductor and Engineman. "X" — Train will be held until order is made "com- plete/' Com. — for Complete. O. S. — for train report. No. — for Number. Eng. — for engine. Sec. — for section. Psgr. — for passenger, Frt. — for freight. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 301 Mins. — for minutes. Jet. — for junctions. Dispr. — for dispatcher. Opr. — for operator. "31" or "19" to clear the line for train orders and for operators to ask for train orders. S. D. — for Stop and Display. The usual abbreviations for the minutes and the stations. FORMS OF TRAIN ORDERS. After a train has been signed for by the conductor, he is held responsible for his train being safely moved or held in accordance with the order. After the engineman has received his copy of the order he is held equally responsible with the con- ductor. Unless he is positive that he has his train fully under his control the conductor has not the right to sign for an order. When a train is running extra on a schedule it does not lose its rights when it is twelve hours late. Question 186. — How would the conductor or engine- man of train No. 4 be governed if holding an order which read : "No. 4 meet No. 3 at D." In case No. 3 arrived at D displaying signals? Answer.— Should hold No. 4 at D for following sec- tions because no particular section having been specified in the order, all sections are included and should be given copies of the order. Question 187. — Suppose an order that train No. 4 would meet second No. 3 at D and then that second No. 3 arrived with signals. No. 4 being a train of superior class what should be done ? Answer. — A particular section being mentioned in the order and therefore no other section being included No. 4 would proceed. 302 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS Question 188. — In the event second No. 3 carried no markers and arrived without signals would train No. 4 proceed ? Answer. — No. Until its markers have arrived a train is considered not to have been met. Note. — Let us sunnose the following orders have been issued: "No. 3 will meet Xo. 4 at D. No. 4 will sidetrack/' "No. 3 will meet No. 4 at E. instead of D." Now which of these two trains will take the siding at E. ? According to the rules No. 4 should go on the sidetrack at E., because the first was a two- moyement order yet only one movement has been superseded, It is clearly to be seen that No. 4 has certain privileges, one or more of which it may have taken away by a train order. For instance, No. 4 being a train of superior direction may proceed against No. 3. But, if a meeting point is fixed with No. 3, the privilege to proceed against No. 3 beyond the specified meeting point is lost to No. 4, although No. 4 still has the privilege of holding main track at the meeting point indicated in the order, unless the privilege also has been taken away. Each of these privileges is distinctly separate and the superseding of the por- tion of the order relative to the meeting point does not operate to supersede the sidetracking provision. In the same manner and by the same principle superseding the sidetracking provision does not supersede the meeting point provision. Question 189. — Suppose the Conductor or Engineman of train No. 4 held an order reading: "No. 4 meet first No. 3 at C and second No. 3 at E," and if upon arrival at E another order were received reading: "No. 4 meet second No. 3 at F," how should they be governed? Answer. — They should stay at "E" until proper orders were received because as the order to meet at "F" did not say "instead of" it does not supersede the former order. Question 190. — Suppose train No. 1 holds order No. 4 to meet No. 2 at B and first No 2 should arrive at B with signals and the dispatcher gave train No. 1 order No. 5 STATION AND TRAIN WORK 303 reading: "No. i will meet second No. 2 at C," what would be the effect on the movement of train No. 2? Answer. — It could not proceed. The words ''instead of" not being in order No. 5 prevents it superseding the original order and besides it is not a proper form or order to give. It ought to read: "No. 1 w T ill meet second No. 2 at C instead of B." If thus worded No. 1 could pro- ceed to C. Question 192. — What should train No. 1 do supposing it held orders No. 4 and No. 6 in case second No. 2 should arrive at C with signals? Answer.— Expecting third No. 2 to be on the way to B by reason of the right of order No. 4, train No. 1 must immediately get clear, as in that case only that part of order No. 4 was superseded which had reference to No. 2. FORM B. Question 193. — Suppose an order reading : "No. 5 pass No. 7 at H," how should the Conductor or Engine- man of No. 5 be governed thereby ? Answer. — They should approach H under control pre- pared to stop unless it should be clearly seen that No. 7 was in the clear and the switches set right. Question 194. — Suppose an order reads : "Extra 690 East run ahead of No. 8 D to E," how should the Con- ductor or Engineer be governed thereby? Answer. — Would neither pass the extra specified in the order nor exceed their speed between the points named, and should approach E prepared to stop unless Extra 690 East was clear and the switches right. Question 195. — If Extra 24 received an order reading: /'Extra 24 pass No. 4 at E," would the order be sufficient 304 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS authority for the extra to pass and proceed ahead of No. 4? Answer. — It would. An order for an inferior to pass a superior train is proper authority for the inferior train to proceed ahead of the superior one. Question 196. — Must trains of any one class have or- ders to pass trains of the 'same class in the same direc- tion? Answer. — No. Question 197. — Do extra trains require orders to pass extras ? Answer. — Thev do not. FORM C. Question 198. — Suppose the Conductor or Engineer of train No. 4 held an order reading: "No. 3 has right over No. 4, A — to B — ," should No. 4 pass B before arrival of No. 3? Answer. — Yes, in case the running time and clearance of No. 4 would enable it to make an intermediate point for No. 3. Question 199. — If an order reads : "Extra East, 769 — has right over No. 5, G to K," would No. 5 go beyond K before the arrival of the extra; if not, why? Answer. — It would not, because the time of Extra 769 w r ould not be restricted by the time-card. Question 200. — How should the Conductor or En- gineer of Extra 769 be governed .? Answer. — Proceed against No. 5 G — to K — and at K — take the siding. Question 201. — Suppose the order to the Conductor or Engineer of the extra extended beyond K and No. 5 STATION AND TRAIN WORK 305 had failed to arrive on arrival of Extra 769 at K, would the extra proceed against No. 5 and under what circum- stances ? Answer. — In case of sufficient time for the Extra to make a point beyond K and to clear the time of No. 5 would proceed and clear the time of No. 5 as provided by the rule. Question 202. — Suppose the Conductor of No. 4, a superior train, held an order which read : "No. 3 has right over No. 4 B — to G — ," and he received another order reading: "No. 4 will meet No. 3 at ;" should he pass by ? Answer. — Yes ; he would have the right to proceed to D — and go on sidetrack for No. 3. The right of a track order merely operates to reverse the rights of the trains only between the points mentioned in the order. Question 203. — Suppose the Conductor of No. 4 held the same orders excepting that the meeting point were B, would he then go on the sidetrack? Answer. — He would not. If the trains met between the designated points No. 4 must sidetrack. If. however, they meet at one of the points specified No. 3 must go on the sidetrack. Question 204. — If an order giving right of track is issued to a train of an inferior class against a train of a superior class to a certain named point, which of the two trains must go on the sidetrack? Answer. — If they meet between the points named in the order the train of the superior class will take the sid- ing. Question 205. — If, under the conditions indicated in the foregoing questions, a train of superior class should reach the second point indicated in the order before the 306 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS train of the inferior class arrived there, could it proceed and if so under what circumstances? Answer. — It may proceed by keeping clear of the op- posing train's time by as many minutes as such train was, under the rules, before required to clear it. Question 206. — If an extra train gets a right of track order against a train of superior class to a specified point, may the superior train proceed beyond the point named in case the extra fails to arrive? Answer. — No. Question 207. — We will suppose that No. 4 of superior direction receives an order that second No. 3, a train of the same class, has right over No. 4 — B to E, the regular schedule meeting point for No. 3 and 4. It is expected that first No. 3 will make E on time, but because of a hot-box No. 3 takes the sidetrack for No. 4 at D, a blind siding. In that case, what should No. 4 and second No. 3 do? Answer. — No. 4 should go on to D against first and second No. 3, because the form C order merely reversed the rights of the trains. No. 4 possessing rights over first No. 3 would proceed against second No. 3 until meeting first No. 3. In such a case second No. 3 would have no authority to use the schedule time of No. 3 ahead of the signals carried by the latter. Before second No. 3 gets authority to pass a given point the signals carried by first No. 3 must have passed that point. FORM E. Question 208. — How should the conductor of No. 4 be governed if he held an order reading : "No. 4 wait at Hinsdale till 11 :oo a. m. for No. I?" STATION AND TRAIN WORK 307 Answer. — He should not pass Hinsdale before 1 1 :oo a. m. unless No i had previously arrived. Note. — Trains using the same time must clear such time the same as before required to clear the regular schedule time when moving under direction of a Form E. order. Question 209. — How should the conductor of Xo. 3 be governed seeing that both are trains of the first class? Answer. — He should proceed to Hinsdale and go on sidetrack to clear the main track by 11 :oo a. m. Question 210. — Suppose the conductor or engineer of a train of inferior right received an order reading: "Xo. 3 will run 20 minutes late Hinsdale to Aurora," how should he be governed' thereby ? Answer. — He should consider the schedule time of Xo. 3 to -be 20 minutes later than its time as indicated on time-card between Hinsdale and Aurora. Question 211. — Suppose the conductor of an inferior opposing train received an order reading: i4 Xo. 3 run two hours late Galesburg to Chicago," how much time would he have in which to make Galesburg ? Answer. — One hour. Xote. — Under Form E. only may the trains use the time, and then only between the points named in the order, and never from an intermediate point beyond the point named to make either of the points specified in the order. FORM F. Question 212. — Suppose an order were issued which read: "Xo. 3 display signals Galesburg to Chicago for engine $2," would that give authority to engine 52 to proceed, and if so, as what? 308 RULES FUR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS Answer. — Yes. It should proceed as second No. 3. (See example (3) under Form F, Standard Code.) Question 213. — How should engine 60 run under the following order : "Engine 52, 60 and 75 run as first, sec- ond and third Xo. 3. Aurora to Hinsdale ?" Answer. — Engine 60 would run as second No. 3 with signals. Question 214. — What form must be used when it be- comes necessary to annul a section for which signals have been displayed over a division or any part thereof, when no train is to follow the signals? Answer. — Form K. Question 215. — Suppose second No. 3 received an or- der at Downer's Grove, an intermediate station, reading: "Engine 60 is withdrawn at Downer's Grove following section change numbers accordingly." What should be done? Answer. — Get into the clear on the sidetrack and re- move signals as rights would then have been lost. Question 216. — As what would engine 75 run from Downer's Grove? Answer. — As second No. 3 without signals. , FORM G (EXTRA TRAINS.) Question 217. — If an order reads : "Engine 99 run ex- tra A to D," how would it proceed? Answer. — It would run to D, taking care to keep clear of all regular trains. Note. — Upon reaching the last station specified in their orders extra train must take the sidetrack at switches where inferior trains going in that direction clear for superior trains. The main track must not be held by extras at their originating or terminating points. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 30!) Question 218. — Under the order immediately preceding the above note must opposing trains be protected against ? Answer. — Xo. Question 219. — Under this order is the right given to occupy the main track at D? Answer — Xo. The siding at D must be taken. Question 220. — What trains and by how much time must extra trains clear? Answer. — All regular trains and by five minutes. Question 220a. — Suppose engine 85 had an order to run extra A to F — and return, would it have to go to F as extra 85 before making the return trip? Answer. — Yes. Because failing so to do the order would not have been fulfilled. Question 220b. — If according to examples 3, under Form G, Standard Code, engine 65 held an order to run extra would it lose its right when it became twelve hours late? Answer. — No. Question 220c. — If engine 69 held order No. 1 to run extra A to F and meet No. 36 at F and should be given order No. 2 upon arrival at F to run extra F to G and meet X T o. 36 at G, should it be regarded as a proper order ? Answer. — Yes ; because when engine 69 arrived at F its order was fulfilled and it ceased to be an extra, there- fore it possessed no further rights ; but upon receiving order No. 2 it again became an extra. Question 22od. — Suppose engine 69 arrived at F under order No. 1 and was given order No. 3 to run extra to G instead of F and was given also order No. 4 to meet No. 36 at G, could it run to G for No. 36? 310 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS Answer. — No. Order No. 3 would not make engine 69 a new extra from F, therefore order No 4 would be improper by not stating "instead of." Note. — The dispatcher should in each and every case, when originating an extra, fix a meeting place for them with all oppos- ing extras, that one extra would wait for another extra until a certain time at a designated station. Such an order is an improper one for the protection of extra trains, as it fails to restrict the rights of opposing extras. f FORM H (WORK EXTRA). Question 221. — Suppose an order were issued to the engineman on engine 292 reading : "Engine 292 works 7 :oo a. m. to 6 :oo p. m. between D & E/' how should he be governed thereby? 1 Answer. — He should clear the time of regular trains and protect against extras in both directions. Question 222. — Suppose the order specified, "Not pro- tecting against extras," then how should he be governed? Answer. — He should clear the time of regular trains, but should not protect against extras. Question 223. — What governs in case extra 292 should receive an order reading: "Work extra 292 clears (or protects against) extra 64 east between D and E after 2 : 10 p. m. ? Answer. — Extra 292 would have to either clear at 2:10 p. m. or protect as directed. Question 224. — How would the order afifect extra 64 east, and in what way would it proceed? Answer. — It would not enter the prescribed limits be- fore 2:10 p. m. After that time it would proceed in ex- pectation of finding a clear main track or the work extra protecting as directed by the order. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 311 Question 225. — What should be clone if a work extra received an order reading: "Work extra 292 protects against No. 35 between D & E?" Answer. — It should work on the time of No. 35, pro- tecting in accordance with rule 99. (See examples under "Form H," Standard Code.) FORM J. Question 226. — If an operator held an order reading: "Hold No. 2," how should it be respected by the conduc- tor or engineer of No. 2 ? Answer. — Exactly the same as though addressed to them. They should not leave until an order was re- ceived annulling the order, or until an order was received by the operator reading: "No 2 may go." (See ex- amples in Standard Code.) Question 227. — In what manner should the operator handle this form of orders? Answer. — He should acknowledge them in the usual manner and deliver them to the conductors and engine- men of all trains affected by them. Question 228. — Y\ nat is a Form J order called? Answer. — An holding order. Question 228a. — When should a Form J order be used? Answer. — Only to hold trains until orders can be de- livered or in cases of emergency. Question 229. — May 'a train proceed after having been held by a Form J order if it receives an order reading: f< _ mav g 0y " and yet the signal remains at "Stop?" Answer. — No. The order permitting it to go merely 312 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS clears the train on the "Hold" order, not, however, clear- ing it on the stop signal; therefore, without first receiv- ing a clearance card, in addition to the "may go" order, it cannot proceed while the signal remains at stop. In accordance with Rule 221, a clearance card is positively necessary. FORM K. Question 230. — How would the rights of train No. 1 be affected, if under Form K an order were issued read- ing: "No. 1 of Feb. 29th is omitted A — to Z — ?" Answer. — It would lose all rights between the points designated. Question 231. — When a train is annulled to a given point, are its rights beyond that point affected by the annulling order? Answer. — Xo. Question 232. — May a train thus annulled between given points be restored by special order? Answer. — Xo. Question 233. — Suppose an order were held by a con- ductor reading to meet X T o. 1 at Hinsdale and later he received an order to the effect that Xo. 1 had been an- nulled, how should he proceed? Answer. — The order reading to meet No. 1 should be considered void according to Rule 220. Question 234. — How would the rights of No. 1 be affected by an order reading: "Second No. 1 of Feb. 29th is annulled E to G?" Answer. — It would have no rights or schedule between the points designated. (See examples given in Standard Code under Form K.) STATION AND TRAIN WORK 313 FORM L. Question 235. — How should an order read which is to annul an order previously issued? Answer. — "Order Xo. is annulled." Question 236. — Should it be numbered, transmitted and signed for the same as other orders? Answer. — Yes. Question 237. — When an order has been annulled or superseded, may it be restored under its original number? Answer. — Xo. FORM M. Question 238. — May a part of an order be annulled when it provided for two or more movements, and if so, how ? Answer. — It may. By an order reading: "That part of order Xo. reading is annulled." Question 239. — Would' a form M order so issued af- fect either of the other movements not so annulled? Answer. — Xo. FORM P. Question 240. — When it is necessary to supersede an order or a part thereof, how should it be done? Answer. — By adding to the prescribed forms the words, "instead of ." Question 241. — May an order when once superseded be again issued under its original number? Answer. — No. RULINGS OF THE AMERICAN RAILWAY ASSOCIATION. Question. — Who fills out the "Train Number" on bot- tom of 31 orders? Answer. — It is the opinion of the committee on Train Rules that the conductor, when he signs the order, should indicate the train he is running in the space provided for the purpose. Question. — At the last change of time, on one of our divisions, the time-table went into effect at 12:30 a. m., Sunday, Sept. 25th. On the old card train No. 1 left "A" at 6:30 p. m., arriving at "B" — the end of the run — at 10:00 p. m. On the new card this train (No. 1) was scheduled to leave "A" at 6:20 p. m., and run through to "Dy" leaving "B" at 9:50 p. m.. and arriving at "D" at 1 1 :zj.o p. m. No. 1 w r as daily except Sunday, on both cards. The question is, would No. 1, leaving "A" Satur- day, the 24th, have a right to proceed north of "B" after 12:30 a. m. of the 25th? Answer. — In answer to the question: " Would No. 1, leaving 'A' Saturday, the 24th, have a right to proceed north of 'B' after 12:30 a. m. of the 25th?" It is the /opinion of the committee that it would not. Question. — L T nder the Standard Code of Train Rules, can a light engine running as first section of regular train No. 2 (a mixed train) be given an order by the dis- patcher to run ahead of time ? Answer. — The Standard Code does not provide for the running of a regular train ahead of time. In the opinion of the committee, the practice should not be permitted. 314 STATION AND TRAIN WORK 315 RIGHTS OF TRAINS IN YARD LIMITS. Where yard limits are defined by yard limit boards, does it authorize yard engine, or in fact any train within those -limits, to occupy main line on the time of same or superior class trains without protection ? For example : Extra arrives at station where yard limits are denned by yard limit boards. Can it proceed with its work in yard limits without protection on the time of regular trains? Answer. — Xo. Ruling Sept. 24, 1900. YARD ENGINES. Is it supposed to be understood that yard engines will conceal their headlights when they are working on tracks in yards adjacent to the main track? I do not find where this question has been discussed and will thank you for any information you can give me on the subject. We have discussed the question several times at our local meetings, but are undecided whether headlights of switch engines in yards should be concealed or not. Answer. — Yard engines under the rules are not re- quired to conceal the headlights in yards. Ruling Sept. 24, 1900. RULE 82. Under Rule 82. A train scheduled to arrive at B at, say 10:00 a. m.. leaves B at 10:30 a. m. and to arrive at C at 11 :oo a. m., fails to reach B before 10:00 p. m. and flags itself to B. Has it a right under the rules to pro- i 316 R ULE s for MOVEMENT OF TRAINS ceed to C provided it can leave B before io-, n , arrive at C at or before 1 1 :oo p. m. ? P ' Answen-Xo ; unless authorized by train order Ruling Sept. 24, 1900. REGULAR TRAINS PASSING. Say a loeal freight, No. ,, was scheduled at fi I eh Z 9: °° f °, ClOCk and kave at 9:30. A thro freight. No 3) of the same class and running in the s- drrection, scheduled to pass B at IO :oo o'clock. IN finds No, at B at xo:oo o'clock, or at any tin* th after, and not ready to leave, can No. 3 run ahead *o. 1 without train orders? Answer.-No; unless No. 1 i s disabled Ruling Sept., 1900. EXTRA TRAINS PASSING. to n? en /V Xtra ° VertakeS an ° ther extra > ha s it a ri made it of no value? Answer. — A train order is in effect when it has been repeated or "X" response sent as provided in Rule 214. Train orders once in effect continue so until fulfilled, superseded or annulled as per Rule 220. RULE 3. 1. The schedule leaving time of train 800 at Dover, a terminal station, is 1 :io p. m. The schedule arriving time of train 801 at Dover is 1 :io p. m. Is Dover a regu- lar meeting or passing point for those two trains, and is it to be indicated on the time-table in full faced type? Trains 800 and 801 are first-class trains, No. 800 being the train of superior right. 2. The schedule leaving time of train 800 being 1 :ii p. m. and the schedule arriving time of train 801 being 1 :io p. m., is Dover still to be regarded as a regular meet- ing or passing point and full-faced type used? If the response to the second query be "yes/' then what differ- ence in the leaving and arriving times will warrant us in regarding Dover as no longer the regular meeting or passing point ? STATION AND TRAIN WORK 319 Answer. — In response to the first question, the com- mittee's answer is "yes," and to the second question, pio." NEW TIME TABLE. "A" contends that under Standard Rule 4 (b) a train on the old time table due at a division terminal prior to the new time table takes effect and failing to make such division terminal by the time new card becomes effective loses its right and class, and cannot assume the rights of corresponding number on new time table. \B" contends that its time at division terminal has no bearing on the rule, and that such train can assume the rights and time of corresponding number on new card. A ruling on the above will be appreciated. Answer. — Under Rule 4 (b) the train in question would retain its train orders and take the schedule of the train of the same number on the new time table. NEW TIME-TABLE. Xo. 1 runs daily, except Sunday, on both the old and the new time-table. The new card takes effect 12:01 a. m. Sunday. No. 1 leaves A 7:00 a. rri., arrives at ter- minal F 7:00 p. m. At 12 o'clock Saturday night No. I is at D, has No. 1 any right to complete their schedule on Sunday — they not being represented to run until Monday — or is it your opinion train should be given orders to proceed as an extra ? Answer. — Yes. Rule 4-B authorizes a train to retain its train orders, and take the schedule of the train of the same number on the new time-table. Rule 82 permits No. 1 to be on the road until it is twelve hours behind its schedule tirhe. Ruling March 19, 1902. 320 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS NEW TIME-TABLE. Train No. i, under the old time table, leaves B at 10:00 a. m. The new time table takes effect at 10:00 a. m„, June 1st. On the new time table No. i leaves B at 9:00 a. m. and C at 10:00 a. m. Does the new time table pro- vide for No. 1 between B and C on June 1st, or is the train annulled? If annulled, is it annulled only between B and C or is it annulled from B to the end of the divi- sion ? If not annulled, should No. 1 consider itself one hour late and govern itself accordingly? Answer. — In reply to this question, the committee would say that, should an instance occur as stated, the plain duty of the superintendent is to conform to Rule 2, and issue special instructions to provide for such a con- tingency, as it can only affect the train for one day. RULE 4-B. I am not satisfied with the American Railway Associa- tion time table Rule 4-B ; at least, I have some misgivings as to whether it reads the way it should in order to con- vey the meaning that I believe it is intended of the com- mittee to convey. The first instance completely elimi- nates the preceding time table. The next sentence states that "a train of the preceding time table (which has been suspended as per the first sentence) shall retain its train orders," etc. I am preparing a new book of train rules, and I wish to submit to the committee my substi- tute for their Rule 4-B, and expect to change standard STATION AND TRAIN WORK 321 Rule 4-B to read as below, unless the committee can give me some good reason why my wording of the rule is not better, or at least as good, as the committee's Rule 4-B. In my opinion, my substitute covers the ground more fully. Our suggestion is that this rule should read 'as follows : "Each time table from the moment it takes effect, supersedes the preceding time table ; but each train on the new time table shall retain the train orders and take the schedule of the train of the same number on -the old time table. A train running in accordance with the schedule of the new time table which had not the same number on the preceding time table shall not run on any division until it is due to start from its initial point on i that division after the time table takes effect." Answer. — It is undesirable to change Rule 4-B in the Standard Code, since the language clearly defines the action necessary. Ruling March 19, 1902. RULE 14 (K). To call the attention of trains of the same or inferior class to signals displayed for a following section. Engine steam whistle 14 (k) is to call the attention of the same or inferior elass (only) to signals displayed for a following section. If, therefore, No. 23, a second class train, which is dis- playing signals for a following section, receives an order as per Train Order Form A, in which order no particular sections of No. 23 are specified, and, therefore, as per rule 218. all sections are included, to meet No. 4, a first- class train, at B. No. 23 is hot required, as No. 4 is a 322 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS train of superior class, to give whistle signal 14 (K) to it at B. . Is it not as important in such a case that whistle signal 14 (k) be given to a train of superior class as to a train of the same or inferior class? Answer. — Whistle signal 14 (k) is merely an auxiliary requirement, and the identity of trains is not dependent thereon ; therefore it is non-essential, and might be dis- pensed with altogether without jeopardizing safety of operation. In the opinion of the committee it would be objection- able to extend its application to superior trains for the reason that the great increase of whistling that would result therefrom would be seriously annoying to passen gers, particularly at night. In framing Rule 14 (k) the committee relied upon the provisions of Rule 218, which, in the case referred to, would require the conductor of Xo. 4 to find out and meet all the sections of Xo. 23. RULE 206. When there are two or more engines coupled to an extra train, which engine number should be used to desig- nate the extra train under Rule 206? Rule 22 prescribes that the leading engine shall display the green or white signals, but the question is whether the number of the leading engine should be used to designate the extra train. Answer. — The recommendation of the committee is that the number of the leading engine should be used. Ruling Sept. 24, 1900. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 323 ARRIVING TIME. Referring to Rule 92, second clause. A train must not leave a station in advance of its schedule leaving time. In consideration of this rule by the Committee on Train Rules, kindly advise if it was understood that a train would have the right to go . to a station in advance of schedule leaving time or in advance of time shown in time table when it was understood that such time was leaving time. Under this rule it is possible for a freight train to leave a station on time at schedule leaving time and reach the next station in advance of schedule leaving time. Some of our division superintendents want to make the rule that where only one time is shown at a station that it should be both arriving and leaving time. in order to prevent train from coming to station ahead of schedule leaving time. Answer. — Unless the arriving time is shown there is nothing in the Standard Code to restrict a train from arriving at a station ahead of its leaving time. Ruling Sept. 24, 1900. CLEARANCE CARD. It is suggested that the Standard Code clearance card be changed so as to show the numbers of train orders delivered to the trains receiving the card. So that if any question should arise as to whether or not an order, pos- sibly an 19 order which was not signed for, was deliv- ered, the clearance can be produced as an actual record of the delivery or non-delivery. 324 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS Answer. — The clearance card as printed in the Stan- dard Code, gives all the information necessary. The re- quirement of further information might lead to error on the part of the operator. PILOT. The responsibilities of a pilot are the same as the re- sponsibilities of the engineman or conductor, or both, whom he pilots. DIRECTION. The American Railway Association recommends that odd numbers shall be given west and southbound trains, and even numbers to east and northbound trains. COLOR. Recommend that no cross-arm or telegraph poles be painted red or green. BLUE SIGNAL. A question has been asked in regard to Rule 38 (pres- ent Rule 26), as to whether or not it is intended to cover the case where a fireman or some one else is underneath an engine, cleaning out the ashpan. etc. Answer. — The committee would state that the rule is only intended to protect car inspectors at work under or about the car or train, and. while admitting the force of the suggestion to protect the fireman or other persons under the engine cleaning out the ashpan, etc., the com- mittee finds so many other cases wdiere it is dangerous STATION AND TRAIN WORK 325 to move the car or train that it will be impossible to modify the rule to cover all the cases, and thinks it is a proper matter for each superintendent to formulate special rules to cover the particular exigencies on his division. SWITCH LIGHTS. A letter was submitted in regard to the proper color to be used for switch lights. It is the unanimous opinion of the committee that red and white are the proper colors, but it has purposely omitted any mention of the same in the Rules, believing that the signification of the colors determines same, there being no question about the use of red for open switches. If white is used, it means that there is no restriction as to speed unless otherwise or- dered. If green is used, it means that caution is to be used, and it is a signal to go slow. FORM A. Assuming that a road is working under Standard Rule for single track, and is double track between A and B, single track between B and C and double track between C and D. In case order is issued: "Engine i will run extra A to D and meet Xo. 2 at C." Will it be necessary for extra 1 to wait at C until No. 2 arrives, in the absence of any orders regarding Xo. 2 using the track which extra 1 would use under time table rules C to D, both B and C being register points, so that No. 2 would know that extra 1 had arrived at C ? . Answer. — In answering, attention is called to the fact that the inquiry is based on the use of a wrong form of 326 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS order, and therefore is not one which the committee can rule on. i\n order as per Form C should have been used, reading: "Extra I has right over No. 2 B to C. v Ruling Sept. 11, 1901. FORM A AND C. I would be pleased to have a ruling as to the proper interpretation of the following train orders : At A extra 375 receives order Xo. 50 to meet Xo. 25 at B. Upon arrival of extra 375, at B, conductor was proffered order No. 51, giving him right over Xo. 25 to C. Conductor refused to accept order Xo. 51 until order No. 50 had been annulled. The dispatcher proceeded to annul order No. 50, completing order Xo. 51. then extra 375 pro- ceeded towards C. Previous to annulment of order Xo. 50 to extra 375 at B, Xo. 25 had received and accepted both orders, Xos. 50 and 51, at B, and had departed. Having in their possession two orders, neither of which had been annulled to them, and with no intervening tele- graph station between D and C, upon their arrival at C they proceeded towards B and met extra 375 on main line. The mistake of the dispatcher is unquestioned. What I desire to have your ruling on is as to the manner in which Xo. 25, with two orders, should have observed them. In other words, should No. 25 have attempted to pass C before the arrival of extra 375, and if so, in what manner ? Answer. — In the opinion of the committee No. 25 should not have passed C before the arrival of extra 375. Ruling Sept. 21, 1904. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 327 FORM B. The question has been asked me whether train order Form B (3) gives the first-named train the right to run on time of the second-named train, and if so, under what regulations ? Answer. — Yes ; under the restrictions as given in the last paragraph of Form E. Ruling Sept. 24, 1900. FORM C. There has recently been considerable discussion among transportation men in this locality embracing several of the larger railroads, in regard to Form C, and by a num- ber it is stated that this rule is not clearly understood, although embodied generally in all Books of Rules. We think we understand all but the last paragraph, wherein it specifies, that if- the -second named train, "be- fore meeting," reaches a point within or beyond the limits named in the order, the conductor must stop the other train where it is met and inform it of his arrival. We do not see how the second train can get beyond the limits without a second order making a meeting point or in some similar manner advising the first named train of the identity of the second train. If so, this necessity for stopping and advising what train it is appears to us to be superfluous. The special point in this paragraph is the words "before meeting/' which causes difference of opinion. Answer. — Form C was formulated for the purpose of reversing the superiority of trains, the inferior train be- coming superior within the limits named in the order. 328 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS The intention is that the second named train may con- tinue until it meets the first named train, clearing it properly within the limits named in the order. Ruling March n, 1903. The paragraph to which reference is made is intended to insure the identification by the first named train of the second named train wherever they may meet, so that the first named train may continue beyond the limit named in the order. SUPERSEDING AN ORDER. What is the general practice where rights are extended as well as shortened ? For example, Order No. 1 : No. 1 has right over No. 2 A to D. Order No. 2 : No. 1 has right over No. 2 to G, would you say No. I has the right over No. 2 to G instead of D ? Answer. — The examples here given are not in accord with the Standard Code practice. The question may be answered by simply quoting from the Standard Code the forms therein provided, and which should be used : Form C, Order No. 1 : No. 1 has right over No. 2 A to D. Form P, Order No. 2 : No. 1 has right over No. 2 A to G instead of D. Ruling Sept. 21, 1904. MEETING POINT. We have recently had a bad accident that occurred through an engine man overlooking his meeting orders and inability of the conductor to stop the train. * * * Feeling the necessity for a rule requiring communica- tions between conductors and engine men of passenger STATION AND TRAIN WORK 329 trains, I have prescribed the following for use on our lines, * * * and I would bring to the attention of the Association the necessity of incorporating some such signal in the Code Rules: "Conductors of passenger trains when approaching meeting points, whether by schedule or train order, must in all cases give two long and one short blast of the air whistle, as notice to the engine man that the train is approaching a meeting point, and the engine man must promptly acknowledge his understanding of the same as provided in Rule 14-G. Answer. — Rule supplementary to the Code may be formulated by railways upon which the conditions of the service are not fully met by the Code Rules, when such supplementary rules are in accordance with the principles of the Code. The committee does not deem it wise to incorporate in the Code rules which are of special appli- cation to the requirements of particular railways, and objectionable for use on other railways, upon which it may be advisable and proper to provide for conditions in a different manner. Ruling March 19, 1902. FORM E. No. 1 is instructed to run 10 minutes late New 'York to Rochester ; they pass Syracuse 10 minutes late, which is the last station they are timed at east of Rochester, which is the leaving time, and, consequently, there is no time for them to arrive 10 minutes late by. Their run- ning time from Syracuse is slow enough to enable them to make up this 10 minutes and be ready to leave Roch- ester on time, or within one or two minutes of it, and as their order expired as soon as they arrived at Rochester, 330 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS what prevents them from leaving Syracuse 10 minutes late and arriving at Rochester at their leaving time, they have no arriving time and its being generally understood that train is due to reach next station (if no arriving is given) as soon as they can get there after leaving the last station as ordered or required by schedule. Answer. — No. i with an order to run 10 minutes late New York to Rochester, should leave all intermediate stations 10 minutes late, and arrive at Rochester (as no arriving time is shown there) as much ahead of its leav- ing time as it would be permitted to do when running without an order, that is to say, the only difference this order makes is that the figures on the time table are changed 10 minutes later between the points specified in the order, and, as there is only one time given at Roch- ester, which is the leaving time, the order practically ex- pired when the train left Syracuse. FORM E. Under example i, Form E, special East leaves Omaha with an order that No. I will run 30 minutes late New York to Chicago. Will this give the special until 3:25 to reach Chicago, or must they reach there at 2:55? If they must reach there by 2:55 of course they are not aided any against No. 1 by the order, as they have a right to go there at 2:55, 3 o'clock being the leaving time of No. 1. It is argued that No. i's order has expired on her arrival at Chicago 30 minutes late, at 3 o'clock, and has nothing to do with her leaving at 3 K or 3 :oi\, provided her work is done, or she has ncne to do, and of course, in this event the special would not be helped any by the STATION AND TRAIN WORK 331 order. A great many conductors have said they would run against No. i until 3 125 to make Chicago. Answer. — Inasmuch as the order delivered to the special at Omaha did not control the movement of No. 1 west of Chicago, the order could not have been used by the special until after its arrival at Chicago. It was therefore an improper order to issue to move the special from Omaha to Chicago. If it was the purpose to move the special to Chicago against No. 1 the order prescribed in No. 2 (now No. 3), Form E, should have been used. In the opinion of the committee the issuing of this order as stated, gave rise to the difficulty which the gentleman mentions. FORM E. The question has been raised whether, under "Form E, Example 2," of the rule governing forms of train orders, a train can properly be held at more than one point in one order for the same opposing train. For instance : No. 1 will wait at A until 2 140 p. m. for No. 2, and will wait at B until 3 :oi p. m. for No. 2. Form E does not specifically authorize such an order. Answer. — The reply of the committee is that under the Revised Code, Form E, Example 3, a train can properly be held at more than one point in one order for the same opposing train. Ruling Sept. 24, 1900. FORM F. Please refer to Form F, Standard Code, which reads as follows : Engines 70, 85 and 90 will run as 1st, 2d and 3d No. 1, London to Dover. 332 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS In the event that it is desired to cut out the second section of No. i at Chatham, would it be necessary under the rule to give notice of such change to Engine 70, rep- resenting first section of that schedule? The above proposition has brought out considerable discussion among our local people here, and I am desirous of having the Committee on Train Rules pass upon the question. Answer. — When this form of the order is used the first section should have a copy of the order annulling the second section. Ruling Sept. 24, 1900. FORM G. Will you kindly say if special trains should carry a white signal? There is a wide difference of opinion on the subject, and I respectfully refer the matter to you. Answer. — A train running under example 1, Form G, would carry the white classification signals, because it is a train not represented on the time table, and is therefore an extra train. A train running under example 2 (this is the form used for running a train on a schedule and mak- ing it a supplement to the time table ; it is no longer a Standard Code example), Form G, would not carry the white classification signals, because the order expressly states that its schedule is a supplement to the current time table, and therefore makes it a regular train. Ruling Sept. 24, 1900. FORM G. I beg to submit to the Committee on Train Rules the following inquiry, in regard to Form G, Extra Trains, under example (1) : Engine 99 will run extra, Berber to Gaza. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 333 Supposing Gaza to be a way station, to which point within the somewhat indefinite limits of Gaza, does the order give the extra the right to run? A definite ruling on this point seems important, espe- cially when we consider that it is perfectly competent for the train dispatcher to give an extra running in the oppo- site direction a similar order from some other point to Gaza, and that, so far as the rules provide, neither extra w r ould have any information as to the destination or ex- istence of the other. Answer. — Presuming that Gaza is an intermediate sta- tion on a division, the order gives the extra the right to run to the entrance switch of the siding and clear the main track. Ruling Sept. 24, 1900. FORM H, Under Form H, paragraph f, is a work train author- ized to flag against all regular trains? (The Form H. paragraph d, of the new rules.) Answer. — The form does not permit a work train to occupy the main line until the arrival of regular trains, but it does permit a work train to occupy the main track until the arrival of an extra- from either direction by properly protecting itself. ANNULLING A SECTION. After a section of a train has been run over one por- tion of a road, and that annulment of the section issued, would it be competent to run the same section of the same train over a different portion of the road? That is, if three sections of No. 23 are started out from A and at 334 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS C the order is issued 3d 23 is annulled from C, could there be a 3d No. 23 run from D to E ? An intermediate section can be annulled and following section take that section's number from where the change is made, but in that case the conductor or engine number is mentioned as being annulled as 3d section. Answer. — Assuming the points named are all in the same dispatching division, the answer is No. Under the last paragraph of Form K, which reads, "When a train has been annulled it must not be again restored under its original number by special order." I am in receipt of the report of the Committee on Train Rules of the American Railway Association, New York, October 6th. I find an inquiry submitted in regard to annulling a section of a train to which the committee re- plied, "No." While I admit that the inquiry was 1 prob- ably not put as it should have been, I do think that the committee should have made itself plain, as that ruling is going to confuse almost all roads which are -endeavoring to follow out the ruling of the Train Rule Committee. I would like to ask, for instance, if Engine 214 was '3d No. 23, and from some cause was disabled at B, what is to hin- der the dispatcher from annulling Engine 14 as 3d No. 23 at B, and when he gets a relief engine, 216, to that point, giving it an order to run as 3d No. 23 from B to the point to which signals are carried by the leading section? Of course the committee had in mind that if 3d No. 23 was annulled from B the train could not be represented, but as long as the signals were carried beyond that point and intermediate train not notified, I would like to ask, as information, why 3d No. 23 could not be represented by another engine? STATION AND TRAIN WORK 335 Answer. — There is nothing to hinder the dispatcher from annulling 3d No. 23, but the change of an engine does not necessarily involve such annulment. DOES NOT SUPERSEDE. Suppose an order is issued to No. 1 at A and No. 2 at C, reading: ''No. 1 will wait at B until 5 :oo p. m. for No. 2." No. 1 being the superior train. Subsequently an order is issued to No. 1 at B and No. 2 at C, reading : "No. 1 and No. 2 will meet at C." Does the latter order cancel the previous time order? Answer. — The committee refers to the first paragraph of Rule 473. (Now Rule 220.) "Train orders once in effect continue so until fulfilled, superseded or annulled." Therefore, if the train order had not expired at B. then that order must be annulled before the meeting order would be effective. Under the conditions named the sec- ond order should preferably read, "Order No. — is an- nulled. No. 1 and No. 2 will meet at C." RULE 210. An operator repeating a train order to the dispatcher. which was sent by him, and, while repeating it the con- ductor and engineman both sign the order, and after the order is repeated and without stopping to receive "O. K." from dispatcher, the operator sends in signature of con- ductor and engineman. Is such an action in accordance with the ruling of your committee or should the operator stop, after repeating the order, and wait for O. K. from dispatcher before sending the signatures of the conduc- tor and engineman? If there is no objection to the opera- 336 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OE TRAINS tor repeating the signatures, should the dispatcher give "O. K. and complete" at the same time? The point I wish to make clear is whether or not the blank on the bottom of standard "31" order, reading, "Time received," "O. K./" "given at" should be filled in each case. Answer. — The committee ruled that the conditions mentioned in the letter are plainly in violation of Rule 459 (this rule has been modified and is now rule 210), and the operator should wait for the O. K. from dis- patcher before sending the signatures of conductor and engineman. WORK TRAIN. "No. 40 and work extra 237 will meet at Rome." At 8 p. m. on the expiration of the work limits, work extra has not reached Romfc. How are both trains to be gov- erned after this hour ? Answer. — No. 40 could not pass Rome without orders, and if work extra 237 had orders to work only to 8 p. m., it has no right to the track after that hour. Under the circumstances, the Form E should have been used. REVERSE MOVEMENT. In running a train over opposite track it is necessary or customary to state the cause, as "northbound track ob- structed/' etc., or simply give 19 order to trains to use that track, and when they receive orders to use the oppo- site track do they understand that they are governed by single track rules? That is, they are superior to trains which, under the time table rules, they would be superior to on single track and inferior to trains which they STATION AND TRAIN WORK 337 would be inferior to under single track rules while run- ning on that track ? Answer. — The committee does not consider it neces- sary to state the cause. Ruling Sept. n, 1901. SIZE OF BLANK. Is there any objection to using form of train order book size 7^2 x 10^4 inches beyond perforated line at top, and 7^2 x nys inches over all? Answer. — The committee believes that the form rec- ommended in the Standard Code is best suited for the use of railroads generally. Larger blanks are permissi- ble, but in the opinion of the committee, are undesirable. RULE 92. It has been suggested to me that Rule 92, of the Code, is incomplete without the addition of an explanatory cause, such as follows: "Under this rule it will be under- stood that where the inferior train is shown to arrive on the leaving time of the superior train, or where a train is shown to arrive on the leaving time of a train of the same class, the inferior train has the right to arrive five minutes before the time shown." I should be glad to have the benefit of the expression of the opinion of the Committee on Train Rules on this matter. Answer: — Where the arriving time of a train is the same as the leaving time of an opposing superior train, the inferior train has not the right to arrive before the 338 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS arriving time shown. (See Rule 92.) The arriving time, when shown, should provide for tiie clearance re- quired by the rules. Ruling March 11, 1903. RULE 18. Our suggestion is that Rule 18 should read as follows : "Yard engines will display a reflecting light to the front and rear by night. When not provided with a reflecting light at the rear, two white lights must be displayed. Yard engines will not display markers." We think this suggestion is better than to say, "Display a head-light to the rear." At least, this is the way we propose to publish it in our new book of rules. Answer. — The term "head-light" as used in Rule 18 is simply employed in its technical sense and is intended to describe a pattern of lamps, and not the special direction in which the light may be displayed. Ruling March 19, 1902. FORM E. No. 2 is due at A 1 p. m., C 1:15 p. m., D 1 :30 p. m. No. 2 is given an order to run 30 min. late A to D. Can No. 2 arrive at C or D ahead of this time? Answer. — The train receiving this order will run with respect to this latter time, as before required to run with respect to the regular schedule. Ruling March 19, 1902. The interpretation of the definition of "yard" as set forth in the standard rules, and the matter of proper regulations concerning movements within defined yard STATION AND TRAIN WORK 339 limits are questions now being fiercely discussed and agitated on railroad lines of this vicinity. It is contended that the definition of "yard" provides, broadly speaking, that the Time-Table, Rules Governing Movement of Trains and Rules for Movement by Train Orders have no jurisdiction or authority in yards. In other words, a yard is a fenced-up baseball park, and all movements made within the same by trains, yard en- gines, light engines, etc., shall be made subject to the regulations governing this particular yard, and that the Time-Table, Rules Governing Movement of Trains, and Rules for Movement of Trains by Train Orders shall absolutely cease the instant a train arrives at the "base- ball park" fence — or rather, the "main line" ceases at this point. On the other hand, it is contended that the Time- Table. Rules for Movement of Trains, and Rules for Movement by Train Order govern in yards as well as at other stations, except to the extent that they might be modified, restricted, superseded or annulled by spe- cial instructions relating to all or individual yards. The circumstances in question are as follows : Our special instructions governing Movements in Yards pro- vide that all trains, yard engines, etc., must proceed un- der control within yards. Another special instruction defines "Under Control" as being able to stop within the distance the track is seen to be clear, Under these instructions yardmen maintain they have as much right within this Mystic Circle as a passenger train, or any other train or engine, and without flag protection, etc., notwithstanding the rules for Movement of Trains provide that inferior trains, etc., shall clear the time of superior trains, etc. 340 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS The yard crew also object to being referred to as a "train" in any shape, manner or form, and give this as another reason why rules for movement of trains and for movements by train orders are not applicable to yard engines — and for no other reason than that a yard engine is not a train. The crew state, however, that they expect to keep out of the way of all impor- tant trains as much as possible, and endeavor to give them a clear track at all times, avoiding delay, etc., on the other hand, they expect all these trains to be under control, thus avoiding the necessity of flag protection on the part of yard crews, and also as a matter of pro- tection to the trains themselves in case they should find their progress obstructed by switch engines, cars or otherwise in yards. Another question is put up about as follows : The Time-Table, Rules for Movement of Trains, and Rules for Movement by Train Orders, have authority in any yard, and in this particular yard we find the customary regulation, providing that all trains shall proceed un- der control within the 'same, etc. Now, we will as- sume that this yard is located in Buffalo, and we find a special train running from Chicago to New York, through Buffalo, and with it a train order giving it right over all trains. Does this order give it right to proceed through Buf- falo yard regardless of other trains, yard engines, etc.? If so, then it necessarily follows that the train dispatcher must receive an acknowledgment from all yard engines, etc., at Buffalo, before he can permit the special train to pass through that place. Of course you understand I am referring to single track yards, because we have practically no double track. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 341 Personally, I am decidedly of the opinion that a "yard** should be operated entirely independent of the "Main Track." and there should be rules for this independent operation in the same manner that we have independent rules for operating double track, block signals, etc. I am also of the opinion that under the definition "Yard" it is intended that the Time-Table, Rules for Movement of Trains and Rules for -Movement by Train Orders should not govern, and that each railroad company is to provide its own regulations for movements within yards, however, it is not exactly plain in this respect, and on this account there is room for much good argument pro and con. Of course you understand in this country it is not always possible to lay out yards to the best advantage in the way of obscured views, etc. On the other hand, nearly all our yards contain many curves, and view is often obstructed by rock bluffs, mountain sides, etc. Will you kindly set us right in the premises? Answer. — The Standard Code definition of a yard is : "Yard. A system of tracks within defined limits pro- vided for the making up of trains, storing of cars and other purposes, over which movements not authorized by time-table, or by train orders, may be made, subject to prescribed signals and regulations.'' Nothing in this definition contemplates the abrogation of the authority of trains to move on the main track. Special instructions authorized by or in force on any railroad are matters of detail for that railroad, and are not intended to be covered by Standard Code rules. The difficulty here appears to be caused by incomplete special instructions governing movement in yards. The 342 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS definition for a yard being interpreted to include a main track — A yard engine is not a train within the meaning of the Standard Code, it having no authority to move upon a main track unless specially authorized — The hypothetical case of a special train running from Chicago to New York passing through Buffalo yard and holding a train order giving it right over all trains, can best be answered by quoting a new rule which the com- mittee on train rules has recommended to the association for adoption as follows : "93- Within yard limits the main track may be used, protecting against class trains class and extra trains must move within yard limits prepared to stop unless the main track is seen or known to be clear. With this rule in force there can be no question about the movement of a special train through Buffalo yard. The adoption of new rule 93, in connection with defi- nition of a yard will answer the various questions and clear the situation. Ruling March 21, 1906. STANDARD CODE OF THE AMERICAN RAILWAY ASSOCIATION INTERLOCKING RULES Adopted October 24, 1900 DEFINITIONS. Interlocking. — An an angement of switch, lock and signal appliances so interconnected that their movements must succeed each other in a pre-determined order. Interlocking Plant. — An assemblage of switch, lock and signal appliances, interlocked. Interlocking Station. — A place from which an inter- locking plant is operated. Interlocking Signals. — The fixed signals of an inter- locking plant. Home Signal. — A fixed signal at the point at which trains are required to stop when the route is not clear. Distant Signal. — A fixed signal used in connection with a home signal to regulate the approach thereto. Dwarf Signal. — A low fixed signal. RULES. Signal Occasion for Use Indication Name Color The signal will be displayed when For enginemen and trainmen As used in rules (d) Red (b) Route is not clear Route is clear Stop Proceed Stop-signal Clear-signal 343 344 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS Where the semaphore is used, the governing arm is displayed to the right of the signal mast as seen from an approaching train, and the indications are given by positions : Horizontal as the equivalent of (a). Vertical or Diagonal * as the equivalent of (b). Note to Rule 601. — * Angle above or below the horizontal. 602. Interlocking signals, unless otherwise provided, do not affect the movements of trains under the time- table or train rules ; nor dispense with the use or the observance of other signals whenever and wherever they may be required. SIGNALMEN. 611. The normal indication of Home Signals is Stop. 612. Levers, or other operating appliances, must be used only by those charged with the duty and as directed by the rules. 613. Signal levers must be kept in the position giv- ing the normal indication, except when signals are to be cleared for an immediate train or engine movement. 614. When the route is clear the signals must be cleared sufficiently in advance of approaching trains to avoid delay. 615. Signals must be restored so as to give the nor- mal indication as soon as the train or engine for which they were clear has passed — . 616. If necessary to change any route for which the signals have been cleared for an approaching train or General Note. — The Committee has found it desirable to leave, blanks. ( ) in certain rules to be filled by each com- pany adopting them, as may best suit its own requirements. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 345 engine, switches must not be changed or signals cleared for any conflicting route until the train or engine, for which the signals were first cleared, has stopped. 617. A switch or facing point lock must not be moved when any portion of a train or an engine is .standing on, or closely approaching, the switch or detector bar. 618. Levers must be operated carefully and with a uniform movement. If any irregularity, indicating dis- arranged connections, is detected in their working, the signals must be restored so as to give the normal indica- tion and the connections examined. 619. During cold weather the levers must be moved as often as may be necessary to keep connections from freezing. 620. If a signal fails to work properly its operation must be discontinued and the signal secured so as to give the normal indication until repaired. 621. Signalmen must observe, as far as practicable, whether the indication of the signals corresponds with the position of the levers. 622. Signalmen must not make nor permit any un- authorized alterations or additions to the plant. 623. If there is a derailment or if a switch is run through, or if any damage occurs to the track or inter- locking plant, the signals must be restored so as to give the normal indication, and no train or switching move- ment permitted until all parts of the interlocking plant and track liable to consequent injury have been examined and are known to be in a safe condition. 624. If necessary to disconnect a switch from the in- terlocking apparatus the switch must be securely fas- tened. 625. During storms or drifting snow special care 346 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS must be used in operating switches. If the force whose duty it is to keep the switches clear is not on hand promptly when required, the fact must be reported to 626. If any electrical or 'mechanical appliance fails to work properly must be notified and only duly authorized persons permitted to make repairs. 627. When switches or signals are undergoing re- pairs, signals must not be given for any movements which may be affected by such repairs, until it has been ascertained from the repairmen that the switches .are properly set for such movements. 628. Signalmen must observe air passing trains and note whether they are complete and in' order ; should there be any indication of conditions endangering the train, or any other train, the signalmen must take such measures for the protection of trains as may be prac- ticable. 629. If a signalman has information that an ap- proaching train has parted he must, if possible, stop trains or engines on conflicting routes, clear the route for the parted train, and give the Train-parted signal to the engineman. 630. Signalmen must have the proper appliances for hand-sternal ing* ready for immediate use. Hand signals must not be used when the proper indication can be dis- played by the fixed signals. When hand signals are necessary they must be given from such a point and in such a way that there can be no misunderstanding on the part of enginemen or trainmen as to the signals, or as to the train or engine for which they are given. Note to Rule 630. — *Hand signaling includes the use of lamp, flag, torpedo and fusee signals. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 347 631. If necessary to discontinue the vise of any fixed signal, hand signals must be used and notified. 632. Signalmen will be held responsible for the care of the interlocking station, lamps and supplies ; and of the interlocking plant, unless provided for otherwise. 633. Lights in interlocking stations must be so placed that they cannot be seen ■ from approaching trains. 634. Lights must be used upon all fixed signals from sunset to sunrise, and whenever the signal indications cannot be clearly seen without them. 635. If a train or engine over runs a Stop-signal, the fact, with the number of train or engine, must be reported to . 636. Only those whose duties require it shall be per- mitted in the interlocking: station. ENGINEMEN AND TRAINMEN. 661. Trains or engines must be run to but not be- yond a signal indicating stop. 662. If a clear signal, after being accepted, is changed to a stop signal before it is reached, the stop must be made at once. Such occurrence must be reported to 663. Enginemen and trainmen must not accept clear hand signals as against fixed signals until they are fully informed of the situation and know that they are pro- tected. Where fixed signals are in operation trainmen must not give clear hand signals against them. 664. The engineman of a train which has parted must sound the whistle signal for Train-parted on ap- proaching an interlocking station. 348 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS 665. An engineman receiving a Train-parted signal from a signalman must answer by the whistle signal for Train-parted. 666. When a parted train has been re-coupled the signalman must be notified. 667. Sand must not be used over movable parts of an interlocking plant. 668. Conductors* must report to am unusual detention at interlocking plants. Xote to Rule 668. — *Or enginemen of yard engines. 669. Trains or engines stopped in making a move- ment through an interlocking plant, must not move in either direction until they have received the proper sig- nal from the signalman. REPAIRMEN. 68 J. Repairmen are responsible for the inspection, adjustment and proper maintenance of all the interlock- ing plants assigned to their care. 682. Where the condition of switches or track does not admit of the proper operation or maintenance of the interlocking plant, the fact must be reported to 683. When any part of an interlocking plant is to be repaired a thorough understanding must be had with the signalman, in order to secure the safe movement of trains and engines during repairs. The signalman must be notified when the repairs are completed. 684. If necessary to disconnect any switch it must be securely fastened before any train or engine is per- mitted to pass over it. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 349 685. Alterations or additions to an interlocking plant must not be made unless authorized by . 686. Repairmen when on duty, or subject to call, must keep advised as to where they can be found. and respond promptly when called. STANDARD CODE OF THE AMERICAN RAILWAY ASSOCIATION BLOCK SIGNAL RULES. DEFINITIONS. Block.— A length of track of defined limits, the use of which by trains is controlled by block signals. Block Station. — A place from which block signals are operated. Block Signal. — A fixed signal controlling the use of a block. Home Block Signal. — A fixed signal at the entrance of a block to control trains in entering and using said block. Distant Block Signal. — A fixed signal used in con- nection with a home block signal to regulate the ap- proach thereto. Advance Block Signal. — A fixed signal used in con- nection with a home block signal to sub-divide the block in advance. Block System. — A series of consecutive blocks. Telegraph Block System. — A block system in which the signals are operated manually, upon information by telegraph. Controlled Manual Block System. — A block system in which the signals are operated manually, and so con- structed as to require the co-operation of the signalmen at both ends of the block to display a clear signal. 350 STATION AND TRAIN WORK 351 Automatic Block System.— A block system in which the signals are operated by electric, pneumatic or other agency actuated by a train, or by certain conditions affecting the use of a block. 301. RULES. HOME SIGNALS. Signal Occasion for Use Indication Name Color The signal will be displayed when For enginemen and trainmen As used in rules (a) Red (*) Block is not clear Block is clear Block is not clear Stop Proceed Proceed with caution Stop-signal Clear-signal Caution-signal WHere the semaphore is used, the governing arm is displayed to the right of the signal mast as : seen from an approaching train, and the indication's are given by positions : Horizontal as the equivalent of (a). Vertical or Diagonal * as the equivalent of (b). Diagonal — * as the equivalent of .(c). Note to Rule 301. — * Angle above or below the horizontal. 302. Block signals control the use of the blocks, but, unless otherwise provided, do not affect the movements of trains under the time-table or train rules ; nor dis- pense with the use or the observance of other signals whenever and wherever they may be required. 352 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS SIGNALMEN. 311. The normal indication of Home Block Signals is Stop. 312. Signals must be operated carefully and with a uniform movement. If a signal fails to work properly its operation must be discontinued and the signal se- cured so as to give the normal indication until repaired. 313. Signalmen must observe, as far as practicable, whether the indication of the signals corresponds with the position of the levers. 314. Signalmen must not make nor permit any un- authorized alterations or additions to the apparatus. 315. A block record must be kept at each block sta- tion. Note to Rule 315. — The different times to be entered on the block record have not been prescribed in this rule, but it has been left to each road to complete the rule bv adding such items as may be necessary to meet the conditions governing its traffic. 316. The prescribed telegraph signals are as follows: 1 — Display Stop-signal. Answer by S D or 5. 2 — Block clear. Answer by 13. 3 — Block wanted. Answer by 2 or 5. 4 — Train has entered block. Answer by 13. 5 — Block is not clear. 7 — Train following. 8 — Opening block station. Answer by Nos. of trains in the extended block with time each train entered the block. General Note. — The Committee has found it desirable to leave blanks ( ) in certain rules to be rilled by each company adopting them, as may best suit its own requirements. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 353 9 — Closing block station. Answer by "13" after receiving transfer of the records of trains which are in the extended block. 13 — I understand. 71 — Train following display Stop-signal. Answer by S D. • Note to Rule 316. — Additional signals may be used if desired. The signals prescribed under the Controlled Manual Block Sig- nal System should be used for such additional signals wherever applicable. 317 (a). To admit a train to a block the signal is clear, will give "1 for " to the next block station in advance. The signalman receiving this signal, if the block is clear, must display the Stop-signal to opposing trains, and reply "S D for /' If the block is not clear, he must reply "5 of /' The signalman at the entrance -of the block must then display the proper signal indication of the train to be admitted. A train must not be admitted to a block unless it is clear, except as provided in Rule 331 or by special order. Note to Rule 317 (A).— 317 (A) is for absolute block for following and opposing movements on the same track. 317 (b). To admit a train to a block the signalman must examine the block record, and if the block is clear, will give "1 for " to the next block station in advance. The signalman receiving this signal, if the block is clear, must display the Stop-signal to opposing trains and reply "S D for ." If the block is not clear, he must reply "5 of .." The signalman at the entrance of the block must then display the proper signal indication to the train to be admitted. A train must not be admitted to a block which is 354 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS occupied by a passenger train, except as provided in Rule 331 or by special order. To permit a train to follow a freight train into a block, the signalman must give "71 for " to the next block station in advance, to which the reply "5 of S D for " must be made. The approach- ing train will then be admitted to the block .* Notes to Rule 317 (B).— '"Under . Caution-signal or with Caution Card. Rule 317 (B) is for absolute block for opposing movements and permissive block for following movements on the same track. 318 (a).. To admit a train to a block the signalman must examine the block record, and if the block is clear, will display the proper signal indication to the train to be admitted, reporting its movement as per Rule 319. A train must not be admitted to a block unless it is clear, except as provided in Rule 31 or by special order. 318 (b) To admit a train to a block the signalman must examine the block record, and if the block is clear, will display the proper signal indication to the train to be admitted, reporting its movement as per Rule 319. A train must not be admitted to a block which is occupied by a passenger train, except as provided in Rule 331 or by special order. A train may be permitted to follow a freight train into a block .* Notes to Rule 318 (B).— *Under Caution-signal or with Caution Card. Rule 318 (B) is for permissive block for following movements only. Note to Rule 317 (A), 317 (B), 318 (A) and 318 (B).— Where it is desired that train dispatchers shall control the dis- play of block signals, roads may modify Rules 317 (A), 317 (B), 318 (A) and 318 (B) so as to ; provide for such practice. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 355 319. When a train enters a block the signalman must give "4 " and the time, to the next block station in advance and when the train has passed the home block signal and the signalman has seen the markers he must display the Stop-signal, and when the rear of the train has passed feet beyond the home block signal he must give "2 of ? and the time to the next block station in the rear. This information must be entered on the block records. 320. Unless otherwise provided, signalmen must not give "1" or "3" until they have received "4" from the block station in the rear. 321. Signalmen must observe all passing trains and note whether they are complete and in order, and the markers properly displayed. Should there be any in- dication of conditions endangering the train, or a train on another track, the signalman must notify the sig- nalman at the next block station in advance. A signal- man having received this notice must display Stop-signals in both directions and answer "S D." Should a train going in the opposite direction be stopped it may be per- mitted to proceed when it is known that the track on which it is running is not obstructed. 322. Should a train pass a block station without markers, the signalman must notify the signalman at the next block station in each direction, and must not report that train clear of the block until he has ascer- tained that the train is complete. 323. Should a train pass a block station in two or /nore parts, the signalman must notify the signalman at the next block station in advance. A signalman having received this notice must stop any train running in the opposite direction. The Stop-signal must not be dis- 356 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS played to the engineman of the divided train if the block in advance is clear, but the Train-parted signal must be given. Should a train going in the opposite direction be stopped, it may be permitted to proceed when it is known that its track is not obstructed. 324. A signalman informed of any obstruction in a block must display the Stop-signal and notify the sig- nalman at the other end of the block. The signalman at the other end of the block must immediately display the Stop-signal. The Clear-signal for that block must not be displayed until the obstruction is removed. 325. When a train takes a siding the signalman must know that it is clear of the block before giving "2"' or displaying a Clear-signal for that block. The signalman must obtain control of the block before permitting a train on a siding to re-enter tjie block. 326. To permit a train to cross-over or return the signalman must examine the block record, and if all the blocks affected are clear of approaching trains he will arrange with the signalmen at the next block station on either side to protect the movement, and when the proper signals have been displayed permission may be given. Until the block is clear no train must be ad- mitted in the direction of the cross-over switches except under Caution-signal or with Caution Card. All cross- over movements must be entered on the block records. 327. When, as provided for in Rule 364, coupled trains have been separated, the signalman must regard each portion as an independent train. 328. If necessary to stop a train for which a Clear- signal (or a Caution-signal) has been displayed and ac- cepted, the signalman will give hand signals in addition to displaying the Stop-signal. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 357 329. A signalman having orders for a train must dis- play the block signal at "Stop." He may permit trains so stopped to proceed under block signal rules after com- plying with Rules for Movement by Train Orders. 330. If from the failure of block signal apparatus the block signal cannot be changed from the normal indication, a signalman having information from the sig- nalman at the next block station in advance, that the block is clear, may admit a train to the block by the use of Clearance Card. 331. If from the failure of telegraph line or other cause, a signalman be unable io communicate with the next block station in advance, he must stop every train approaching in that direction. Should no cause for de- taining the train be known, it may then be permitted to proceed, provided minutes have elapsed since the passage of the last preceding train, using Caution Card. 332. Signalmen must have the proper appliances for hand signaling* ready for immediate use. Hand signals must not be used when the proper indication can be dis- played by the fixed signals. When hand signals are necessary they must be given from such a point and in such a way that there can be no misunderstanding on the part of enginemen or trainmen as to the signals, or as to the train or engine for which they are given. Note to Rule 332. — *H'and signaling includes the use of lamp, flag, torpedo and fusee signals. 333. Signalmen will be held responsible for the care of the block ¥ station, lamps and supplies; and of the signal apparatus unless provided for otherwise. 334. Lights in block stations must be so placed that they cannot be seen from approaching trains. 335. Lights must be used upon all block signals from 358 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS sunset to sunrise and whenever the signal indications cannot be clearly seen without them. 336. If a train over runs a Stop-signal, the fact, with the number of train, must be reported to . 337. If a Stop-signal is disregarded, the fact with the number of train, must be reported to the next block station in advance and then to . 338. To open a block . station the signalman must give "8" to the next block station in each direction and record the trains that are in the extended block. He must then display the normal signal indication and no- tify the block station in each Erection that the station is open. When trains, which were in the extended block when the station was open and which had passed his station before it was opened, clear the block in advance he must repeat the record to the block station in the rear. He must not display the Clear-signal until all trains are clear of the block in advance. 339. A block station must not be closed except upon authority of ; nor when trains are approaching which are to meet or pass at that block station. 340. To close a block station the signalman must first obtain "2" for trains which he has admitted to the blocks in each direction. He must give "9" to the next block station in each direction and transfer the records of the trains in the extended block. He must then enter on his block record "13" with the time it is received from each* block station. The block signals must then be , all lights ex- tinguished and the block wires arranged to work through the closed station. Note to Rule 340: — The arrangement of the block signal un- der the third paragraph of Rule 340 is left for each road to de- termine in accordance with its local requirements. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 359 ENGINEMEN AND TRAINMEN. 361. Block signals apply only to trains running in the established direction. 362. Trains must not pass a Stop-signal without re- ceiving a Caution Card, a Clearance Card or a special order. 363. An engineman holding a Caution Card must deliver it to the signalman at the next block station and personally ascertain from him that the block in advance is clear before proceeding. 364. Unless directed by special instructions, when two or more trains have been coupled and so run past any block station, they must be uncoupled only at a block station and the signalman notified. 365. When a train takes a siding it must not again enter the block without the permission of the signalman. 366. When it is necessary for a train to cross-over, the conductor before crossing or returning, must notify the signalman and obtain permission to do so. 367. Enginemen and trainmen must not accept clear hand signals as against block signals, 368. The engineman of a train which has parted must sound the whistle signal for Train-parted on ap- proaching a block station. 369. An engineman receiving a Train-parted signal from, a signalman must-answer by the whistle signal for Train-parted. 370. When a parted train has been recoupled the signalman must be notified. 371. At a block station where the signalman is ab- sent or incapacitated, so that instructions cannot be 6b- 360 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS tained, trains must wait minutes and then proceed with caution to the next block station, where the conduc- tor must report accordingly to the . y]2. If the H track is obstructed between block stations notice must be given to the nearest block signalman. 373. If a train is held by a block signal to exceed minutes, the conductor must ascertain^ the cause. 374. Conductors must report to any unusual detention at block stations. 375. A block station must not be considered as closed, except as provided on time-table or by special instruc- tions. Note. — Rules 301 to 375, inclusive, apply to this system with- out any of the "adjuncts." CONTROLLED MANUAL BLOCK SYSTEM. A series of consecutive blocks controlled by block sig- nals operated manually, and so constructed as to require the co-operation of the signalmen at both ends of the block to display a clear signal. CONSISTING OF: 1. Signals of prescribed form, the indications given by two positions ; and, in addition, at night, by lights of prescribed color. 2. The apparatus so constructed that the failure of any part directly controlling a signal will cause it to give the normal indication. 3. Signals, if practicable, either over or upon the right of and adjoining the track upon which trains are governed by them. For less than three tracks signals STATION AND TRAIN WORK 361 for trains in each direction may be on the same signal mast." *The word "mast" refers to the upright to which the signals are directly attached. 4. Semaphore arms that govern, displayed to the right of the signal mast as seen from an approaching train. 5. The normal indication of Home Block Signals — Stop. 6. The apparatus so constructed that the failure of the block signal instruments or electric circuits will pre- vent the display of the clear signal. 7." The relative position of the home signal, and track instrument or releasing circuit, such as to make it neces- sary that the rear of a train shall have passed feet beyond the Home Block Signal before the signal at the preceding block station can be released. * ADJUNCTS. The following may be used: (A) Distant Block Signals* interlocked with Home Block Signals ; normal indication — Caution. (B) Advance Block Signalsf interlocked with Home Block Signals, and with Distant Block Signals, if used; normal indication — Stop. (C) Track circuits. (D) Repeaters or audible signals to indicate the posi- tion of signals to the signalman operating them. (E) The automatic release of signals to give the normal indication. (F) The interlocking of switches with block signals. 362 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS (G) Bell circuits" for signaling between a block sta- tion and outlying switches. (H) Unlocking circuits between a block station and outlying switches. "When Distant Block Signals are used the following should be added to Rule 40.1 ; Signal Occasion for Use Indication Name (0— — {d) Home (or advance) signal at (a) Home (and advance) signal at (/>) Proceed with caution to the home (or ad- vance signal) Proceed Caution-sig- nal Clear-signal Where the semaphore is used, the governing arm is displayed to the right, of the signal mast as seen from an approaching train, and the indications are given by positions : Horizontal as the equivalent of .(c). Vertical or diagonal (angle above or below the hori- zontal) as the equivalent of (d). tWhen Advance Block Signals are used that name should be added to the caption of Rule 401 so as to read "Home and Ad- vance Signals/' and Rule 411 should be changed to read ''The normal indication of Home and Advance Block Signals is Stop." RULES. 401. HOME SIGNALS. Signal Occasion for Use Indication Name Color The signal will be displayed when For enginemen and trainmen As used in rules {b) Red Block is not clear Block is clear Stop Proceed Stop signal Clear signal *See note on following page. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 363 Where the semaphore is used, the governing arm is displayed to the right of the signal mast as seen from an approaching train, and the indications are given by positions : Horizontal as the equivalent of (a). Vertical or Diagonal — * as the equivalent of (b). Note to Rule 401. — * Angle above or below the horizontal. 402. Block signals control the use of the blocks, but, unless otherwise provided, do not affect the movements of trains under the time-table or train rules ; nor dis- pense with the use or the observance of other signals whenever and wherever they may be required. SIGNALMEN. 411. The normal indication of Home Block Signals is Stop. 412. y Signals must be operated carefully and with a uniform movement. If a signal fails to work properly its operation must be discontinued and the signal secured so as to give the normal indication until repaired. 413. Signalmen must observe, as far as practicable, whether the indication of the signals corresponds with the position of the levers. 414. Signalmen must not make nor permit any un- authorized alterations or additions to the apparatus. 415. If any electrical or mechanical appliance fails to work properly must be notified, and only duly authorized persons permitted to make repairs. General Note. — The Committee has found it desirable to leave blanks ( ) in certain rules to be filled'b}- each com- pany adopting them, as may best suit its own requirements. 364 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS * When bell circuits for signaling between a block station and outlying switches are used, Rule 420 will be amended to include the following signals, which will be given and observed by sig- nalmen and conductors : 1-2-3 — Train has gone on siding. All clear. Switch closed. Answer by 1-2-3. 3-4 — Train is ready to leave siding. Answer by 3-4 or 5. Con- ductor when ready to go will give 3-4, and will not start his train until 3-4 has been given in reply, and this must not be given by the signalman unless the block is clear. 416. A block record must be kept at each block sta- tion. Note to Rule 416. — The different items to be entered on the block record have not been prescribed in this rule, but it has been left to each road to complete the rule by adding such items as may be necessary to meet the conditions governing its traffic. 417. Block signal instruments and bells must be used only by signalmen and as directed by the rules. 418. Bells must not be used for any purpose other than to give the prescribed signals. 419. Bell signals must be given deliberately and dis- tinctly, and answered promptly. All signals must be re- peated until answered. 420. The prescribed Bell Signals are as follows : 1 — (Long stroke.) Answer telegraph call. 2 — All right. Yes. 3 — Unlock my lever. Answer by unlocking, or 5, or 4 — Train has entered block. 5 — Block is not clear. 6 — Has a train entered this block? Answer by 2, or 2-1. 1-2 — Clear. Train has cleared block. 1-4 — 1-4 — Stop train approaching and have it exam- ined. Answer by 1-4 — 1-4. 2-1 — No. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 365 2-2-2 — Previous signals given in error. Answer by 2. 2-3-2 — Train has passed without markers. This sig- nal to be given to station in advance. Answer by 2-3-2. 2-4 — Has train cleared block? Answer by 1-2, or 5. 2-4-2 — Repeat previous signal. 3-1 — Have unlocked. If levers are not released, in- strument must be out of order. Block is clear. This signal must be answered by 3-1 and the answer acknowl- edged by 2. It must not be used unless the block is known to be clear. A signalman having received 3-1 and answered it by a 3-1 and received 2 in acknowledgment, may allow train to proceed under Rule 434, announcing it by 4. 3-3 — Train in block will take intermediate aiding. Answer by 3-3. 3-3-3 — 3-3-3 — Train in block has broken apart. An- swer by 3-3-3—3-3-3- 4-3-4 — Train from intermediate siding is proceeding toward you. Answer by 4-3-4. 4-4-4 — Cars running away in the wrong direction and proceeding toward you. Answer by 4-4-4. 4-6-4 — Cars running away in the right direction and proceeding toward you. Answer by 4-6-4. 5-2-5 — Train has passed without markers. This sig- . nal to be given to station in rear. Answer by 5-2-5. 5-5-5 — Obstruction in block. Stop all trains approach- ing this station. Answer by 5-5-5. 6-6-6 — Testing. Answer by 6-6-6. Notes to Rule 420. — (-) signifies pause between beats. Additional bell signal may be used if desired. The telegraph or other equivalent may be used instead of the bell for transmit- ting signals. 366 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS 421. To receive and forward a train, the block being clear, and signals giving the normal indication: In answer to 3 from the next block station in the rear, the signalman must unlock by closing the circuit, and unless otherwise provided hold it closed until acknowl- edged. In answer to 4 from the next block station in the rear, he must give 2, then give the block station in advance 3. If released, he must give 2 in acknowledgment, then clear the signals. When the train enters the block in advance, he must give 4 to the next block station in ad- vance. When the rear of the train has passed feet beyond the home block signal and he has seen the markers he must give 1-2 to the station in the rear. 422. Block signals must be restored to the normal indication as soon as the train for which they were cleared has passed . 423. Unless otherwise provided, signalmen must not give 3 until they have received 4 from the next block station in the rear, nor unlock the next block station in the rear before receiving 3. 424. Signalmen must observe all passing trains and note whether they are complete and in order and the markers properly displayed. Should there be any indi- cation of conditions endangering the train, or a train on another track, the signal 1-4 — 1-4 must be given to the next block station in advance and the signalman must display Stop-signals, in both directions, and then answer 1-4 — 1-4. Should a train going in the opposite direction be stopped, it may be permitted to proceed when it is known that the track on which it is running is not ob- structed. When practicable, the signalman giving 1-4 — STATION AND TRAIN WORK 367 1-4 must inform the signalman at the other end of the block why the signal was given. 425. Should a train pass a block station without markers, the signalman must give 2-3-2 to the next block station in advance and 5-2-5 to the next block station in the rear, and must not report the block clear nor unlock the next block station in the rear until he life ascer- tained that the train is complete. 426. Should a train pass a block station in two or more parts, the signalman must give 3-3-3 — 3-3-3 ' to the signalman at the next block station in advance. A signalman having received this signal must stop any train running in the opposite direction. The Stop-signal must not be displayed to the engineman of the divided train if the' block in advance is clear, but the Train- parted signal must be given. Should a train going in the opposite direction be stopped, it may be permitted to proceed when it is known that its track is not ob- structed. 427. Should cars run away in the wrong direction, the signal 4-4-4 must be given to the next block station in the rear. Should cars run away in the right direction, the signal 4-6-4 must be given to the next block station in advance. Signalmen receiving either 'of these signals must take such measures for the protection of trains as may be practicable 428. A signalman informed of any obstruction in a block must display the Stop-signal and give 5-5-5 to the signalman at the other end of that block. A signalman receiving 5-5-5 must immediately display the Stop-signal and then answer by 5-5-5. The Clear-signal- for that block must not be displayed until the obstruction is re- moved. 368 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS 429. When a train takes a siding the signalman must know that it is clear of the block before giving 1-2 or displaying a Clear-signal for that block. A signalman, after having unlocked the next block station in the rear or given 3-1, must not permit train or switching movements that will endanger an approach- ing train. 430. A train must not be admitted to a block unless it is clear, except as provided in Rule 436, or by special order. 431. When, as provided for in Rule 464, coupled trains have been separated, the signalman must regard each portion as an independent train. 432. If necessary to stop a train for which a Clear- signal has been displayed and accepted the signalman must give hand signals in addition to displaying the Stop- signal. 433. A signalman having orders for a train must dis- play the block signal at "Stop/' He may permit trains so stopped to proceed under block signal rules after complying with Rules for Movement by Train Orders. 434. If from the failure of block signal apparatus the block signal cannot be changed from the normal indication, a signalman having information from the signalman at the next block station in advance, that the block is clear, may admit a train to the block by the use of Clearance Card. 435. When a train is admitted to a block as provided in Rule 436, both signalmen must use every precaution to prevent a second train from entering the block until it is clear. 436. If from the failure of bell circuits, telegraph line or other cause a signalman be unable to communi- STATION AND TRAIN WORK 369 cate with the next block station in advance he must stop every train approaching in that direction. Should no cause for detaining the train be known, it may then be permitted to proceed, provided minutes have elapsed since the passage of the last preceding train, using Caution Card. 437. Signalmen must have the proper appliances for hand signaling* ready for immediate use. Hand signals must not be used when the proper indication can be dis- played by the fixed signals. When hand signals are necessary they must be given from such a point and in such a way that there can be no misunderstanding on the part of enginemen or trainmen as to the signals, or as to the train or engine for which they are given. Note to Rule 437. — *Hand signaling includes the use of lamp, flag, torpedo and fusee signals. 438. Signalmen will be held responsible for the care of the block station, lamps and supplies ; and of the signal apparatus unless provided for otherwise. 439. Lights in block stations must be so placed that they cannot be seen from approaching trains. 440. Lights must be used upon all block signals from sunset to sunrise and whenever the signal indica- tions cannot be clearly seen without them. 441. If a train over runs a Stop-signal, the fact, with the number of train, must be reported to . 442. If a Stop-signal is disregarded, the fact, with the number of train, must be reported to the block sta- tion in advance and then to . ENGINEMEN AND TRAINMEN. 461. Block signals apply only to trains running in the established direction. 370 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS 462. Trains must not pass a Stop-signal without re- ceiving a Caution Card, a Clearance Card or a special order. 463. An engineman holding a Caution Card must deliver it to the signalman at the next block station and personally ascertain from him that the block in advance is clear before proceeding. 464. Unless directed by special instructions, when two or more trains have been coupled and so run past any block station, they must be uncoupled only at a block station and the signalman notified. 465. 1 When a train takes a siding it must not again enter the block without the permission of. the. signalman. 466. When it is necessary for a train to cross-over, the conductor before crossing or returning, must notify the signalman and obtain permission to do so. 467. Enginemen and trainmen must not accept clear hand signals as against block signals. 468. The engineman of a train which has parted must sound the whistle signal for Train-parted oil ap- proaching a block station. 469. An engineman receiving a Train-parted signal from a signalman must answer by the whistle signal for Train-parted. 470. When a parted train has been recoupled the signalman must be notified. 471. At a block station where the signalman is ab- sent or incapacitated, so that instructions cannot be ob- tained, trains must wait minutes and then pro- ceed with caution to the next block station, where the conductor must report accordingly to the . 472. If the track is obstructed between block stations notice must be given to the nearest block signalman. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 371 473. If a train is held by a block signal to exceed minutes, the conductor must ascertain the cause. 474. Conductors must report to — any unusual detention at block stations. 475. A block station must not be considered as closed, except as provided on time-table or by special instruc- tions. Note. — Rules 401 to 475, inclusive,, apply to this system with- out any of the "adjuncts.'' AUTOMATIC BLOCK SYSTEM. A series of consecutive blocks controlled by block sig- nals operated by electric, pneumatic or other agency, actuated by a train or by certain conditions affecting the use of a block. CONSISTS OF: 1. Signals of prescribed form, the indications given by not more than three positions ; and, in addition, at night by lights of prescribed color. 2. An apparatus so constructed that the failure of any part controlling the Home Block Signal will cause it to indicate — Stop. 3. Signals, if practicable, either over or upon the right of and adjoining the track upon which trains are governed by them. For less than three tracks, signals for trains in each direction may be on the same signal mast.* *The word "mast" refers to the upright to which the signals are directly attached. 4. Semaphore arms that govern, displayed to the right of the signal mast as seen from an approaching train. 372 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS 5. Switches in the main track so connected with the block signals that the Home Block Signal in the direction of approaching trains will indicate Stop when the switch is not set for the main track. 6. Signal connections and operating mechanism so arranged that a Home Block Signal will indicate Stop after the f of a train shall have passed it. fThe head, or rear. ADJUNCTS. The following may be used: (A) Distant Block Signals* connected with corre- sponding Home Block Signals and so constructed . that the failure of any part controlling the signal shall cause it to indicate — Caution. (B) Track Circuits. (C) Indicators at main track switches. *When Distant Block Signals are used the following should be added to Rule 501 : DISTANT SIGNALS. Signal Occasion for Use Indication Name Color The signal will ap- pear when For enginemen and trainmen As used in rules id) (e) Home signal is at (a) or track obstructed between distant and home signal Home signal is at (6) Proceed with caution to the home signal Proceed Caution-signal Clear-signal Where the semaphore is used, the governing arm is displayed STATION AND TRAIN WORK 373 to the right of the signal mast as seen from an approaching train, and the indications are given by positions : Horizontal as the equivalent of (d). Vertical or Diagonal (angle above or below the hori- zontal) as the equivalent of (e). Where a single disc is used for two indications these are given by position of a — — — (color) disc as seen from an approaching train : Disc displayed as the equivalent of (d). Disc withdrawn as the equivalent of (c). 501 RULES. HOME SIGNALS Signal Occasion for Use Indication Name Color The signal will appear when For emmiemeni . , . . & . As used in rules and trainmen j (a) Red 14— Block is not clear Block is clear Block is clear Second block in advance is not clear Stop Procede Approach next home signal prepared to stop. Stop-signal Clear-signal Caution-signal "Where the semaphore is used the governing- arm is displayed to the right of the signal mast as seen from an approaching train, and the indications are given by positions : Horizontal as the equivalent of (a). Vertical or Diagonal ■* as the equivalent of (b) . Diagonal * as the equivalent of (c). Where a single disc is used for two indications these are given by position of a — approaching train: Notes to Rule 501: — * Angle above or below the horizontal. tColor. -f disc as seen from an 374 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS Disc displayed as the equivalent of (a). Disc withdrawn as the equivalent of (b). 502. Block signals control the use of the blocks, but, unless otherwise provided, do not affect the movements of trains under the time-table or train rules ; nor dis- pense with the use or the observance of other signals whenever and wherever they may be required. 503. Block signals apply only to trains running in the established direction. 504. When a train is stopped by a block signal it may proceed when the signal is cleared. Or it may proceed — (A) After waiting minutes and then running under caution ; Or— (B) Preceded by a flagman to the next clear signal. Note to Rile 504. — The Committee has provided for alter- natives in Rule 504, considering either to be safe practice. 505. When a signal is out of service the fact will be indicated by . Trains finding a signal out of service must, unless otherwise directed, proceed with caution to the next signal. 506. When a train is stopped by a signal which is evidently out of order, and not so indicated, the fact must be reported to . Note. — Rules 501 to 506, inclusive, apply to this system with- out any of the "adjuncts." General Note. — The Committee has found it desirable to leave blanks ( ) in certain rules to be filled by each company adopting them, as may best suit its own requirements. TRAIN ORDER SIGNALS. The Telegraph plays an important part in governing the movement of trains, and the train order signal is no less important. At every station from which train or- ders are given out it is a permanent fixed signal, and its position, together with the rules which govern its use, will either hold a train or permit it to proceed without hindrance. Train order signals are of several forms. Different forms of the well-known target signal are shown in Figure 99. This signal is painted either green or red, but it is most generally painted red. The illustration shows it in the "stop'' or "danger" position. When the track is clear and it is desired to show the "clear" signal the target is turned parallel with the track, and -is, there- fore, not visible to approaching trains. The colors used on this signal at night are usually red for "stop" and either green or white for "proceed." These signals cannot, as a rule, be seen for any great distance by the engineers of approaching trains because they are usually attached to the side of a station building or else under wide spreading eaves. The great speed at which many trains are now run makes it necessary that all signals are of such form and position as will ensure that they may be plainly seen, in order that ap- ■ proaching trains not required to stop for orders or any other reason may not lose any time provided the signal be at "clear" and yet give sufficient time in which to 375 376 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS bring the train to a standstill in case the "stop" or * 'danger'' signal is shown. ^JSH PIG. 99. TARGET SIGNALS. This imperative need led to the introduction of the signal known as the semaphore, which has been very generally adopted, and which for train orders and gen- eral signalling is very satisfactory. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 377 There are various forms of semaphore signals, the two in most general use are shown in Figures ioo and 101, the difference between them being the angle to which the arm is allowed to drop when at the "clear" position. One it will be observed is oblique, and the other is almost, if not quite, vertical. The horizontal position in any semaphore is the "stop" signal. FIG. ioo. FIG. 101. SEMAPHORES, COMMON TYPES. When a semaphore is used to signal trains proceeding in one direction only, the arm pointing to the right of the post is the one from which the indication is given, the arm to the left of the post has, in that instance, no significance whatever. See Figure 102. If, how- ever, a single, or one arm semaphore, is used for train order signals, it governs trains proceeding in either di- 378 fcULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS rectioil. On a single track a one arm semaphore is often used, but on a double track never. (See Figure 103.^, As a rule, on single track the double arm is generally used, one for trains proceeding in either direction. FIG. 102. A TWO-POSITION TRAIN-ORDER SIGNAL. Only two indications are necessary for train order signals. But if the block system is in operation it is advisable to have a third for indicating "caution'' when it is used for blocking. This signal may be and in some instances is used for train orders and block work also, STATION AND TRAIN WORK 379 yet the only positions which come under the rules gov- erning the train order signal are those already men- tioned, "step" and "proceed." m wk mm i FIG. 103. A TRAIN-ORDER SIGNAL. Two forms of signals are shown in Figures 104 and 105 which are capable of three positions. The upward inclination of the arm which is shown in Figure 104 indicates "caution," whereas the downward inclination shown in Figure 105 indicates the same signal, but it 380 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS cannot be confused with "clear" because that signal is indicated by the vertical position. FIG. 104. A THREE-POSITION SIGNAL. "STOP'-HORIZONTAL ; "CAUTION"-UP ; "PROCEED"-DOWN. FIG. 105. DIFFERENT TYPE G* THREE-POSITION SIGNAL. "STOP"-HORIZONTAL ■ CAUTION'-INCLINED ; "PROC^^"-^OWN. Red is the color employed when semaphores are used for train order signals, that is to say, it is the prevailing color; some few lines,, however, use yellow. The stand- STATION AND TRAIN WORK 381 ard color for use at night has, until recently, been for "stop" or "danger," red; for "proceed," white; and when necessary for "caution," green. There has been of late considerable discussion regarding a suitable stand- ard color for the caution and proceed signals, and as green is by many considered better than white for many reasons, that color is used on some roads for the "pro- vellow have ceed" signal. For "caution" orange or YA FIG. 107. A RIGHT-ANGLE SEMA- FIG - 106 - PHORE FOR BLOCK SIGNALS WHEN USED ON A DOUBLE TRACK, FOR TRAIN- ORDER SIGNALS ON SINGLE TRACK. (See also Figures 108 and 3 09.) been mostly favored, although a few roads have adopted a combined green and red light. But it should be borne in mind that for train order work there are but two indications, "stop" and "proceed." A unique form of signal has been adopted by one great railroad, although it is peculiar to that particular line. It can be used either for train orders or blocking 382 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS and either on double or single track lines. It is known as the "Right-Angle Semaphore/' it revolves about its axis, and thus makes a number of indications. The pole is hollow and a lamp is suspended therein which is raised or lowered as the signal revolves. By means of colored glass inserted where the lamp stops, any night signal can be shown to correspond to any position of FIG. 108. FIG. 109. (Same as Figures 106 and 107.) .he arms. On single track the position shown in Figure 106 denotes a train order signal "stop" and the position shown in Figure 107 is the signal to "proceed." The other indications (Figures 108 and 109) are used for any special signals on single track and they may be used block signals on douole track. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 383 Standard Code, Rule 221, which follows, authorizes the adoption of two forms : "221. (A). A fixed signal must be used at each train- order office, which shall indicate "stop" when there is an operator on duty, except when changed to "proceed" to allow a train to pass after getting train orders, or for which there are no orders. A train must not pass the signal while "stop" is indicated. The signal must be re- turned to "stop" as soon as a train has passed. It must be fastened at "proceed" only when no operator is on duty. Operators must have the proper appliances for hand signaling ready for immediate use if the fixed signal should fail to work properly. If a signal is not displayed at a night office, trains which have not been notified must stop and ascertain the cause and report the facts to the from the next open telegraph office. Where the semaphore is used, the arm indicates "stop" when horizontal, and "proceed" when in an inclined position. NOTE to Rule 221 A. — The conditions which affect trains at stations vary so much that it is recommended each road adopt such regulations supplementary to this rule as may best suit its own requirements. 221. (B). A fixed signal must be used at each train- order office, which shall indicate "stop" when trains are to be stopped for train orders. When there are no orders the signal must indicate "proceed." When an operator receives the signal "3T or "19," fol- lowed by the direction, he must immediately display the "stop signal" for (the direction indicated and then reply "stop displayed," adding the direction ; and until the orders have been delivered or annulled the signal must not be re- stored to "proceed." • While stop is indicated, trains must not proceed without a clearance card (From — "A"). Operators must have the proper appliances for hand signaling ready for immediate use if the fixed signal should fail to work properly. If a signal is not displayed at a night office, trains which have not been notified must stop and ascertain the cause, and report the facts to the from the next open telegraph office. Where the semaphore 384 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS is used, the arm indicates "stop" when horizontal, and "proceed'' when in an inclined position. NOTE to Rules 221 A and 221 B.— The Committee has recommended two forms of Rule 221, leaving it discretion- ary to adopt one or hotli of these forms according to the circumstances of the traffic." FIG. 110. SEMAPHORE, (DOUBLE ARM) FOR USE ON SINGLE TRACK. (The small arm is for train-order signals.) It will be seen that one form provides that the nor- mal position of the signal shall be "stop" except where it is changed to "proceed" in order to permit a train to pass. The other form provides that the signal shall stand in the "proceed" position unless there are orders for a train, when the signal must indicate "stop." STATION AND TRAIN WORK 385 Sometimes on single track lines the train order signal is used for blocking also. In that event the conductor and engineer are unable to know whether the train is being stopped for an order or is merely being held in the block. If for orders the conductor should go to the telegraph office to obtain them, whereas if for a block only the signal may be changed to ''proceed'' or "clear" 1 before the conductor has had time to reach the office. A small semaphore is used on some roads, which is be- low the double arm semaphore used for block signalling, and located on the same post. This is used for train order signals and so provides a separate indication. (See Figure no.) Of course, it may not be so clearly visible at a distance, but whenever it is used, the double arm semaphore may also be shown at "stop" until both have been observed by the engineer and conductor of an approaching train. The Universal Semaphore. — The American Railway Engineering and Maintenance of Way Association has recommended a standard casting which it thinks should be used for semaphore arms which are capable of being used in either two or three positions : Two positions, — horizontal and vertical. Three positions, — horizontal, inclined downward, ver- tical. By merely changing the glass in the spectacles it may be used to indicate any color desired for any position at night. If the lamp is placed upon the top of the post it will answer for two arms, one in either direction. If only two indications are necessary, viz., horizontal and vertical, the color which is to indicate "stop" can be inserted in the two upper spectacles, and thus it will 38f3 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS be shown until the arm has quite reached the position indicating ''proceed," and in this way a false night in- dication is prevented. Figures in to 115, inclusive, il- lustrate this form of semaphore. Red FIG. Ill FIG. 112. TYPE OF SEMAPHORE ARM, CONSIDERED STANDARD. Means Employed for Identifying Trains. — The great importance of being able to positively identify trains cannot . be too strongly impressed upon all who STATION AND TRAIN WORK 387 have anything to do with their movement on the road. Operators ought to keep an accurate record, for by so doing he not only contributes to the expeditious move- ment of trains and the safety of lives and property, but White FIG. 11 FIG. 114. TYPES OF STANDARD SEMAPHORE ARMS. also makes the duties of the Train Dispatcher less arduous/ and his own connection with the Dispatcher's office more satislactory, ii not pieasam. 388 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS Almost all roads have provision made for describing, regular trains in train orders, although it is not in the Standard Code. It is generally the custom x to give the number of the engine ; some roads give the conductor's name; and in a few instances the engine number and also the name of the conductor is given. Extra trains are almost universally described by the number of the locomotive, and sometimes with the name of the con- ductor added. Sometimes the cupola of the caboose is provided with a transparency, trainmen being required FIG. 115. SEMAPHORE ARM. to exhibit at all times the prescribed characters, numbers or letters for the purpose of enabling their train being readily identified. See illustration, Figure 116. Each road has its own particular form of indication for the use of identifying its trains, although the common prac- tice is to use a number (preferably the train's number) STATION AND TRAIN WORK 389 in the case of regular trains, and also which section it is. If another section is not following, the letter "L," mean- ing "last," usually indicates that fact. If regular train No. 45, for instance, has a second section following the indication would show: "1-45/' but if another section is not following it would show: "L-45." If an extra train it would be designated by "X/ ? and the number of the engine. FIG. 116. CUPOLA IDENTIFICATION METHOD. Train Movement on Double Track. — The move- ment of trains on double track, or on three tracks or on four tracks is quite different from the movement of trains on single track. Of course there are no '"meeting points" for trains to make, but moving trains with the least delay possible is equally as serious a problem as that of making "meeting points." The reason for this is that the Standard Code of Double Track Rules formu- lated by the American Railway Association are, it is claimed, a modification of single track rules, and thus they are often inadequate to meet the rapidly changing conditions incident to the tremendous growth of traffic. Consequently the subject has been given considerable attention of late years ; and as there are only a few rules 390 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS and forms of train orders prescribed particularly to meet the existing conditions, the need of a more uniform sys- tem for governing the movement of trains on double track is apparent, and more effort toward that end is being made. On American roads the right-hand track is, as a rule, used by trains. There are a very few cases, however, where the English custom of using the left-hand track is followed. Cross-overs are sometimes used for pass- ing, although passing tracks are provided at suitable intervals. As a general thing trains do not use cross- overs without express permission, and when using cross- overs they must be protected by a flag against trains on the opposite track. Passing tracks are generally located outside the main tracks, but the "middle track," which is a "siding" between the main tracks, and is accessible from either, is sometimes used. The one great thing which dispatchers aim to do is to keep slow trains on the move so they will not interfere with fast trains ; and "keeping a train out of the way" is often a hard prob- lem for the train dispatcher directing train movement on double track. There is but one order prescribed by the Standard Code by which an inferior train may be moved ahead of a delayed regular train. It is D-Form E, an order which when used on double track is as unsatisfactory as when it is used on single track. There are one or two roads where no distinction of "class" in trains is made, a train being allowed to run until ordered to permit another train to pass it. On some lines trains are run on the opposite track for a little distance, if they can be kept moving thereby, instead of having to wait on a siding STATION AND TRAIN WORK 391 for a superior class train to pass. And on some other roads, unless in case of accident, the established direction of the current of traffic is always maintained. The practice varies concerning its use, on roads pro- vided with a third track. One track is sometimes oper- ated as a single track line, being used by trains in both directions under the rules governing single track. That still leaves two for double track use. In some cases, where that is done, the third track is used solely for trains in one direction during certain hours of the day when the amount of traffic necessitates it, the direction being reversed at other hours of the day. But the roads having thr§e tracks are but few, because generally when the traffic becomes too great in volume to be handled on double track it is converted into a four-track road. Nearly all, ff not all, roads having a double track have some form of block signaling in operation. More ex- pensive and efficient system than the telegraph block signal system have been widely introduced of late years, although the telegraph system is still in use to some ex- tent. It embodies the use of station train order signals, the telegraph operators, of course, communicating by means of the telegraph with each other. What is known as the Right-Angle Semaphore (already referred to as being in use on one great railway system) is used in con- nection with the Telegraph Block System. This particu- lar form of semaphore is illustrated and its different in- dications shown in Figs. 106 to J09 inclusive. The Manual Controlled System. — These are sig- nals that are so interlocked that a signal cannot indicate "clear" if there is a train in the block. They are usually of the semaphore form, and are operated by a signalman. 392 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS FIG. 117A. FIG. 117B. THE *DISC TYPE OF SEMAPHORE. Automatic Signals.— This form of signal is in use on some of the large railroads. Figs. 117A and 117B illustrate the disc type, and Figs. 118 and 119 show the semaphore type. These are provided to serve for both STATION AND TRAIN WORK 393 FIG. IIS. "HOME" AND "DISTANT" SIGNALS. "home" and "distant" signals. Sometimes at the en- trance to each block there is a home and distant signal as illustrated in Fig. 118, the next block ahead being given by the distant signal. Thus an engineer* may know there are two clear blocks ahead of him if both signals 394 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS show "clear." Should the home signal show "proceed" and the distant signal show "caution" he wpuld know that the block immediately ahead is clear, but would be FIG. 119. "CLEAR" INDICATED BY GREEN LIGHT. prepared to find "stop" shown at the ne;xt home signal, and would accordingly run with the train under full con- trol. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 395 The construction of automatic signals is such as to permit of either "stop" or "proceed" being the normal position shown. The "normally clear'' position is the one most in favor. Signals stand in the "stop" position with the "nor- mally at danger" method, until a train approaches the entrance to a block, when, if the block is clear it will automatically change to "proceed/' the change taking place in view of the engineer, with his train far enough away from the signal to avoid delay, then just as the locomotive reaches the signal it automatically returns to "stop," remaining in that position until that train is out of the block and another train is ready to enter it. En- gineers are expected to see to it that the proper changes do take place, because failing so to do, it would indicate that they were not in order, and the fact should be im- mediately reported to the proper official. Xight Colors. — The tendency to change from green to white as a night color indication for "proceed" has already been mentioned. Where this is done there is difficulty in finding a suitable color for "caution." When a single color is substituted for green, for use as the "caution" signal, the color mostly chosen is yellow. But on one or two lines a combined green and red light indi- cates caution ; the red light is concealed when the sema- phore is dropped to the "clear" position, the green only showing. But as one lamp serves to show both colors in this combination, no light would be shown should the light be accidentally extinguished. See Figure 119. The Electric Train Staff System. — Where this system is installed it has the effect of a mechanical oper- ator issuing metal train orders, such orders being issued 396 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS only under the general direction of the train dispatcher, and such orders when issued give a train the right only over a certain section of track. This "mechanical oper- ator" can issue but one such order at a time for any sec- tion, with the exception of following trains, in which case the permissive system is used ; thus the risk of "lap or- ders" is entirely obviated. This system does not eliminate the train dispatcher, but it does relieve his mind from the constant strain, be- cause the train staff system is claimed to remove all dan- ger of collision, and it does away with the telegraph train orders entirely. Thus it gives him more time to issue orders for the proper movement of trains on the division under his control. In its operation the track to be protected is divided into blocks or sections of such length as will best accom- modate local and traffic conditions. These blocks usually terminate at existing stations or telegraph offices, though occasionally, as in the telegraph block system, additional block stations have to be installed, when the distance be- tween any two existing stations is too great for the ex- peditious handling of traffic. Each section is controlled by two instruments (Figure 120), one at each end, "X" and "Y." Each instrument is equipped with a sufficient number of staffs (varying from ten to twenty-five per section) to take care of the traffic conditions. No train is permitted to proceed between "X" and "Y" in either direction unless the conductor or engineer has in his possession one of these staffs, which, as has been already stated, serves as a "metal train order/' The instruments at "X" and "Y" are electrically connected and synchron- ized so that the withdrawal of a staff from either can STATION AND TRAIN WORK 897 PIG. 120. ABSOLUTE STAFF INSTRUMENT WITH PEDESTAL. Front View Showing Door of Pedestal Open. 398 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OE TRAINS only be effected by the joint action of the operators at "X" and "Y," and but one staff can be put out of both instruments at any one time. To move a train from "X" to "Y" the manipulation of the instrument is as follows : The operator at "X" presses bell key (Figure 120-A) the number of times prescribed in the bell code, which rings bell (Figure 121-L) at "Y," The operator at "Y" first acknowledges receipt on his bell key, ringing bell at "X" (Figure 121-L), through the circuit shown on Plate 8, and then holds it closed, thereby deflecting the "current indicating needle" (Figure 122-F) at "X," to the right. This informs k 'X" that "Y" has furnished current and he proceeds to remove the staff by turning the prelimi- nary spindle handle (Figure 120-B) to the right as far as it will go, which raises the armature (Figure 123-J) up to the magnets (Figure 123-K), transferring the cur- rent from the bell k 'L" to the magnet (Plate 9, K-88), closing the circuit as shown in red on Plate 9, and at the same time closing the circuit on 360-K, shown in green on Plate 9, after which the preliminary spindle handle (Figure 120-B) is permitted to automatically return to its normal position. This unlocks the revolving drum ( Figure 123-C) and indicates the fact by displaying a white instead of a red disc in the indicator at Figure 122-H. The operator now moves the end staff (Figure 120-E) up the vertical slot into engagement with the drum (Figure 123-C), the outer guard (Figure 122-N) having first been turned to the right position, revolves the latter through a half turn, using the staff as a handle, and finally withdraws the staff' through the opening at Figures 120 and 124-M. In making the half turn the drum (Figure 123-C) has reversed the polarity of the STATION AND TRAIN WORK FIG. 121. ABSOLUTE STAFF INSTRUMENT. Rear View with Cover Removed Showing Armature Dropped. 400 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS -F •FIG. 122. ABSOLUTE STAFF INSTRUMENT. Front View of Instrument in Condition for Removal of a Staff. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 401 M •>.. % FIG. 123. ABSOLUTE STAFF INSTRUMENT WITH PEDESTAL. Rear View with Cover Removed Showing Armature Raised. 402 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS operating current, thereby throwing" the instruments at "X" and "Y" out of synchrony with each other and moving the "staff indicating needle'' at "X" (Figure 124-G) from "Staff In" to "Staff Out." Immediately on withdrawing the staff, the operator at "X" once more presses the bell key "A/' which indicates to the operator at "Y" by moving his needle from "Staff In" to "Staff Out" that the operation is completed. The staff with- drawn is now delivered to the train by hand if the train is at rest, or passing at a speed of less than twenty-five miles per hour. For higher speeds the staff is placed in a special holder and delivered by methods similar to those followed in the Railway Mail Service, the locomotive being fitted with a catching and delivering device. The illustrations will serve to make this perfectly clear. As before mentioned, in taking out a staff the polarity of the operating current is reversed. This prevents a second staff from being taken out of either instrument, as follows : The polarity of the current flowing through magnet K-360, Plate 9, is never changed, the current for the same being local. The polarity of the current flowing through K-88, Plate 9, is changed each time its staff is put in or taken out of either instrument. This puts the instruments either in or out of synchrony. The magnet (Figure 123-K) is formed of two separate coils, one energized by the local and one by the line battery. The construction of this magnet is such that when the cur- rents in both coils flow in the same direction, the lines of force flow round the cores and connecting straps, thus forming no point of attraction for the armature. When the current is reversed in one coil, the lines of force op- STATION AND TRAIN WORK 403 FIG. 124. ABSOLUTE STAFF INSTRUMENT. Front View of Instrument when a Staff is Released or about to be Replaced. 404 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS FIG. 125. ABSOLUTE STAFF INSTRUMENT WITH PEDESTAL. Rear View with Cover Removed Showing- Armature Dropped. FIG. 126. ABSOLUTE STAFF INSTRUMENT. Side View with Cover Removed. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 405 pose each other and the armature being brought to the point of attraction is held there. With the staff out, if an attempt be made to release another staff, the circuit closed will be as shown on Plate 10, with the polarity of the current following through magnet K-88 reversed. By comparing this circuit with the one shown on Plate 9 for releasing a staff, it will be seen that in the former the currents flowing through magnets K-360 and K-88 oppose each other, and in the latter they do not, thus pre- venting the release of a second staff. On arrival of the train at "Y" the staff is delivered either by hand or de- livered to the operator who, having seen that the train is complete by observing the rear end markers,, places the staff in the opening (Figures 120 and 124-X) of his in- strument, having first turned the outer guard (Figure 122-X) to place, moves the staff into engagement with and revolves drum (Figure 123-D) through one half turn, using the staff as a handle (see Figure 127) and allows it to roll down the spiral. He then presses his bell key the prescribed number gf times, thus notifying "X" that the train is out of the section, which operation also moves the "staff indicating needle'' at "X" from "Staff Out" to "Staff In." The^operator at "X" presses his bell key in acknowledgment and by doing so moves "staff indicating needle" at "Y" from "Staff Out" to "Staff In" (see Figure 127). The machines are now synchronized and another staff can be obtained from either in the manner above described. The staff being put in the instrument at "Y," the cir- cuits for releasing a staff at "X" or "Y" would be as shown on Plates 11 and 12 respectively. While it takes some little time to describe the method of operating the staff instruments, yet, as a matter of fact, 406 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS FIG. 127. ABSOLUTE STAFF INSTRUMENT. Front View of Instrument when a Staff has been Replaced. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 407 the removal of a staff actually takes less than five seconds, and the operation of putting one in an instrument less than two seconds, under ordinary conditions. The same methods are followed at each succeeding staff station, but no two adjacent sections use the same design of staff ; that is to say, the staff used between "X" and "Y" will not fit the instruments which control the section between "Y" and "Z." Usually four different designs of staffs are employed in actual practice, to avoid any possibility of their being im- properly used. The Permissive Feature. — While the absolute train staff system, where but one train is allowed in any sec- tion, is the ideal arrangement, yet cases occur where it is desirable to allow several trains to follow each other a block at short intervals. This may be done by the use of the "permissive system/' which consists of an attach- ment to the absolute machine at each end of the section with one permissive staff ; this instrument is shown in Figure 128. To use it, an absolute staff is withdrawn from the in- strument at "X" and is used as a key with which to un- lock the base containing the permissive staff to be re- moved, which action locks the absolute staff in the per- missive attachment until the permissive staff is returned. The permissive staff is a steel rod and eleven removable rings, any of which will authorize a train to pass through the section to Y. If less than twelve trains are to fol- low each other, the last one takes the remaining rings and the rod. When all the rings are received at "Y" the operator returns them to the permissive staff, places it in the permissive attachment or base, and locks it by 408 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS o \ll w z Hi > o STATION AND TRAIN WORK 409 the*absolute staff already in the lock. This releases the absolute staff,, which put in the absolute instrument in the regular manner. That synchronizes the machines so that a movement can be made with an absolute staff in either direction and from "Y" to "X" with the permissive staff. When next it becomes necessary to move a number of trains in rapid succession from "X" to "Y" under the permissive system, the permissive staff must be obtained by "Y" as before described and forwarded to "X" as a whole by the first train moving in that direction. The entire permissive staff confers the same rights as does an absolute staff. Control of Signals. — In its capacity as a key the ab- solute staff has a number of uses in addition to those al- ready described. Where signals are used to indicate to an approaching train whether or not it will receive a staff, an instrument known as the staff and lever lock is attached to each lever operating such signals (see Figure 129). To clear a signal, the staff after being withdrawn is first used to unlock the lever lock, the signal is then cleared, the staff removed from the lock and delivered to the train. To insure the signal being placed at danger behind a train the act of unlocking the signal lever opens the staff circuit, and no communication can be made between the two staff stations until the signal is at danger and the lever locked in that position. This does not indicate, however, that the operator will have the staff ready for delivery by hand, or in the mechanical deliverer. To cover that point an electric slot is attached to the signal governing train movements into the staff section, which slot is controlled by the staff and lever lock and the me- chanical deliverer, so that before the signal can be cleared no RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS BACK VIEW WITH COVER REMOVED SIDE VIEW SHOWING COVER IN SECTION FRONT VIEW FIG. 129. STAFF LEVER LOCK. the staff must be released, used to unlock the signal lever and put in the staff deliverer, which closes the circuit on the electric slot. The signal can then be cleared. With this arrangement, therefore, a clear signal cannot be given until the staff is actually in the deliverer. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 411 When the train picks up the staff; the circuit on the slot is opened, automatically setting the signal to danger, and it cannot again be cleared until the operation is re- peated. Switch Locking. — The staff is also used as a key to unlock siding switches which may occur between staff stations, the switch locks being so designed that the staff cannot be removed from the lock until the switch is set and locked for the main line, thus providing absolute pro- tection against misplaced switches. Intermediate Siding and Junction Instruments. — In some sections there is a siding of sufficient length to hold a train, but traffic would not warrant placing a staff station there. That the usefulness of this siding may not be lost, a special instrument is placed at the siding which enables it to be used for meeting or passing trains. A junction or diverging line may be situated between two points most suitable for staff stations, but, on account of the small amount of traffic over the diverging line, it would not be desirable to make it a staff station. Such a point can be controlled in a similar manner. The cir- cuits and operation of both the siding and junction instru- ments are the same. To move trains between "X" and "Y" the manipula- tion of the instruments is the same as that previously de- scribed in connection with the absolute instruments. To move a train from "X" to the siding or junction, a staff is released at "X" by "Y" in the regular manner (see Plate 13). The operator at "X" gives the staff to the train with instructions to proceed to the siding or junction. Unlocking the switch with the staff, the train takes the siding or junction, closes and locks the switch, 412 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS places the staff in the siding or junction instrument, and turns the drum to the right. The staff is now locked in the instrument and the staff instruments at "X," "Y" and junction or siding are synchronized. (See Plates 14 and 15.) When a movement is to be made from the siding or junction to "X" or "Y" (all staffs being in the instru- ments), "X" and "Y," acting in conjunction, can release a staff at the siding or junction (see Plate 16), which on being removed changes the circuits so that no other staff can be released either at "X," "Y," siding or junction until this staff is replaced in one of the instruments. The train then unlocks the switch, passes out on the main track, locks switch and proceeds to ''X'' or "Y." Pusher Engine Attachment. — Another adjunct to the staff system is known as the pusher engine attach- ment and staff, which is used on heavy grades where pusher engines are required, and is intended to both obviate the necessity of the pusher engine proceeding through the entire staff section, and to better equalize the traffic. It can readily be seen from the foregoing descrip- tion of the staff system, that under ordinary rules every train having a pusher engine attached would receive one staff to proceed up grade, as from "Y" to "X." On ar- rival at "X" pusher engine would necessarily have to re- ceive a staff to return to "Y." Supposing the traffic up and down grade to be equal, and that each train going up grade requires a pusher, it is apparent that twice as many staffs would go down hill as came up, resulting eventually in all the staffs arriving at the foot of the grade "Y," from whence they could only be returned to "X" by some special person authorized to unlock the in- struments and remove the staffs bv hand. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 413 © Z O H fc H as o 2 1 as o «/> «! at H DC H <* § ti i< 3g 02 o P «/> h g: Ul >> O Itl CO Q tH «o o h o o ^ * 414 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS Furthermore, the summit of the grade may be half way between "Y" and "X," but under the rules a pusher could not cut off at the summit and return to "Y," but would have to continue on to "X" and receive a staff to return. To overcome these tw T o objections the pusher attach- ment (see Figure 130) is employed. It consists (like the permissive attachment) of a separate device which may be attached to any absolute instrument, and contains a staff of special design which can only be released by an absolute staff, though, unlike the permissive staff, it can be out of its receptacle at the same time as the absolute staff. The operation is as follows : A train with a pusher en- gine wishes to proceed from "Y" to "X." "X" releases staff at "Y" (Plate 17) and "Y" uses this staff to re- lease pusher staff. This operation opens the controlling circuits of the system and closes the circuits on the pusher bells (Plate 18). "Y" then hands the absolute staff to the train and the pusher staff to the pusher engine. The train passes through the section and delivers the absolute staff at "X." This is placed in the instrument there, the pusher engine retaining the pusher staff and returning to "Y." Until this latter staff is put into the pusher attach- ment at "Y" and locked, the staff circuits are not re-es- tablished and no other staff can be released. Circuit Controller Attachment. — Another attach- ment called the circuit controller attachment (see Figure 131) is used where electric signals are operated in place of mechanical. This attachment is arranged to control the staff and signal circuits. The signal circuits controll- ing the signals for a through movement cannot be closed until the staff has been used to release same, which staff can be taken out when said release is made. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 415 O < o — 2; E 41 s rules for movement of trains Staff System on the Southern Pacific Railway. — There is a long continuous staff blocking on the South- ern Pacific Railway between Truckee and Colfax, Califor- nia, a distance of 98 miles, divided into 37 blocks. This portion of the Southern Pacific is in the Sierra Nevada Mountains, and 14 of the staff stations are located in the snow sheds. Here the staff station is at the center of a passing siding. The staff system is worked in conjunc- tion with electric signals so that trains may pass with fa- cility and safety. Through the snow sheds it was found that neither the modern electric semaphore signal nor the ancient types of banner and banjo signals could be installed, so Mr. W. W. Slater, Signal Engineer of the Southern Pacific, de- signed a neat and compact disc signal suitable for this particular condition. The general arrangement of tracks and signals at each of the staff stations is shown on Plate 19. All signals in the horizontal position indicates "take siding." Upper blade of two-arm signal clear and independent distant clear indicates "stop at staff station," "staff not ready." All signals clear indicates "proceed, staff ready and in crane." The circuits controlling the signals in the above de- scribed movements are clearly shown on Plates Nos. 20, 21 and 22. On Plate 20 "B" has staff circuits closed, re- leasing a staff at both "A" and "C." Upon the arrival of these trains at "B " the one from "A" will take the siding and the one from "C" the main track, the latter stopping at the staff station (see Plate 21). If the train from "A" should get into siding at "B" in time to enable operator to put the staff into the instrument and get an- other released and put in the crane, the signals for the STATION AND TRAIN WORK 417 t ^ SECTION OF HEAD SHOWING CIRCUIT CONTROLLER FIG. 132. CRANE STAFF DELIVERER. 418 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS train from "C" could be cleared as shown on Plate 22, thus preventing its stopping. The home and independent distant signals can be cleared at any time by moving the handle of the circuit controller attachment from the normal or first position to the middle or second position, allowing trains to approach the staff station, but the staff distant signal on the two arm post cannot be cleared until the circuit controller attachment has been released by a staff, when the han- dle can be removed from the middle or second position to the reverse or third position, thereby closing one point in the circuit of the aforesaid staff distant signal, the other point in the circuit being closed by putting the staff in the crane ready for the train to take as it passes. Two opposing signals cannot be given at the same time, circuits of each being controlled by the other, making it "necessary for one of the two to be in the norma! or first position, as will be seen by referring to Plate 22. The crane in use in this installation is shown in Fig- ure 132. The A. B. C. System. "The A. B. C. Rules on the Northern Pacific have passed the experimental stage. Their value is no longer a mat- ter of speculation. Apparently they have come to stay. From every viewpoint they are, without doubt, superior to any single track system of rules and orders that have vet been devised. They are now used on sixty-three miles of track, from Spokane to Ritzville. On this territory there are fifteen telegraph offices and three blind sidings. It is all main line and handles a traffic so heavy that with the ordinary system of train orders it was found impossi- ble to keep trains moving. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 419 128 OHMS — *j640HMS -320HMS- 16 OHMS'— 102 OHMS The distance between two staff instruments depends upon traffic conditions and therefore the resistance of the line wire in series with the line coil of the lock magnet varies considerably. The local coil of the lock magnet should have a variable resistance in series with it in order that it may balance perfectly with the line coil. This is ac- complished by using the adjustable resistance tube shown diagram- matically on the opposite page. The table gives the required information for connecting up the adjustable resistance tube for any ordinary condition. Column 1 represents the total resistance of the two line wires con- necting a pair of instruments. Column 2 shows the normal voltage reouired to operate. (This is 50% above the minimum voltage required and gives a large work- ing margin.) Column 3 shows the corresponding number of dry cells required to secure the voltages shown in Column 2. Column 4 shows the ohms resistance to be inserted in series with the local coil to balance the line resistances as given in Column 1. Column 5 shows the proper terminal to which one wire leading from the local coil of the lock magnet should be connected to get the resistance shown in Column 4. THE OTHER SHOULD ALWAYS BE CONNECTED TO TERMINAL 1. Column 6 shows the additional connections to be made in order to get the resistances shown in Column 4. Example. Two staff instruments are 5% miles apart. No. 12 B. & S. copper line wire is used. Total length of line wire will be 11 V2 miles. Total resistance of line will be 96 ohms. Consulting the table we see that 30 cells of dry battery should be used to operate and that 262 ohms should be put in series with the local coil. Columns 5 and 6 show that to get this resistance we connect ter- minals 2 and 3 together and also terminals 4 and 5 together. We then connect terminals 1 and 6 into the local circuit. RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS 1 , 2 3 4 5 6 ' & ^ 0) £« -i ° a i <3) o Pk u o o 3 C°0 s 3 o «* o **-* 3 :Oh5 T3-M o3 ^3^ ,o p e3 +3 u o H a CO ^ ^ o a °Q2 ° 3_ 0) O) x£ Bfj 2% e -» w £ •" P a> s a; o3fc-l 3 O r* A O H Eh 16 30.2 22 102 2 None 24 31.4 22 118 3 None 32 32.5 23 134 4 2 &3 40 33.6 24 150 4 None 48 34.8 25 166 5 2&4 56 35.9 26 182 5 3 &4 64 37. 26 198 5 2 &3 72 38.2 27 - 214 5 None 80 39.3 28 230 6 2 &5 88 40.5 29 246 6 3 &5 96 41.6 30 262 6 2 &"3— 4 &5 104 42.7 30 278 6 4&5 112 43.9 31 294 6 2 &4 120 45. 32 310 6 3 &4 128 46.1 33 326 6 2 &3 FIG. 134. TABLE OF RESISTANCES FOR ELECTRIC TRAIN STAFF SYSTEM. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 421 "No train orders are issued and there are no time-table schedules except for information to the public that pas- senger trains may be expected at certain times. A train obtaining a clear signal at a telegraph office and obtain- ing a clearance card from the operator has absolute right to the next telegraph station. There it receives further instructions by means of a three-position semaphore either to stop and wait, to take siding or to proceed to the next station. Clearance cards are delivered to conductor and engineman by means of hoops and no reduction of speed U necessary. ''Experience has shown surprisingly satisfactory re- sults. It has long been realized that an important ele- ment in the cost of handling traffic is the length of time consumed by 'trains in passing over the road. Delays are very expensive. They consume coal, produce wear and tear on the engine and necessitate overtime to employes. With the A. B. C. Rules all these items of expense are reduced to the lowest possible figure. Receipts for freight charges are the same no matter whether the movement is speedy or otherwise, so that the saving in expense is clear gain. "It is difficult to arrive at an exact statement of in- crease of efficiency, but a comparison of statistics for one month with that of the corresponding period a year previous shows that the average speed of all freight trains in passing over this portion of the track was eleven miles per hour, as compared with 8.6 miles per hour the pre> vious year. This includes all delays of whatever kird and also includes the movement of two way freights do- ing work and a goodly amount of switching. Omitting the locals the record of the through freight trains shows 422 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS STATION AND TRAIN WORK 423 H OS H B £ r - < fc tf < b- H 72 c & r -^ rr £ if. < < 04 PU o < fc > ^ Kp fc fc .< w E- 1 W >ji < H O fc H * c^ c o j3d F- en JH s < H > Pi RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS an average speed of fourteen miles per hour, which is an excellent showing tor a single track road. The aver- age increase of speed is 30 per cent, and the average de- crease of time spent on the road is almost 22 per cent. The earning capacity of engines and cars shows an in- crease of over 20 per cent. "All this is accomplished with practically the same number of men and the same equipment of signals, etc., as was required for the old method, which involved the use of train orders. The great success of the venture is attributed in some measure to the hearty co-operation of the dispatchers, trainmen and operators concerned in handling the trains. All contribute toward attaining the desired results. Not the least important feature of the plan is that it may be termed absolutely safe. In handling trains according to the Standard Code there is the ever-present element of danger. The best and most careful man is liable to error. Dispatchers, operators, conductors and enginemen are all in positions where oversight and forgetfulness are always possible. Experience has proven this so true that further comment is unnecessary. With the A. B. C. System three men must act simultaneously with each other. No move can be authorized and no signal can be cleared unless they three give their consent. The oper- ator who is to clear the train first examines his own block record, and if the track is clear asks the dispatcher for a clearance. The dispatcher looks at his train sheet and if found proper issues the necessary authority. The operator then asks permission of the operator at the next station to admit the train to the block. If the latter is satisfied that the track is clear he gives his consent. All STATION AND TRAIN WORK 425 FIG. 137 EIGHT SEMAPHORE SIGNAL BRIDGE EQUIPPED WITH THE SAFETY STORAGE SYSTEM. (Cylinder indicated by arrow.) Owing to the great penetrating power of Acetylene and the absence of the yellow rays, it is of great value for Signal Lighting. All colors hold their true value under this marvelous illuminant, which makes it possible to use a wider range of colors for signals. Through heavy storms and fogs that ob- scure other lights and make it necessary for the engineer to slowdown, and sometimes almost stop, to make the signal, the Acetylene signal shines clearly and the signal can be seen without any trouble. The illustration shows an eight semaphore light signal bridge equipped with the Safety Storage System. The cylinder seen at the foot of the right- hand end of the bridge is one of our old style 20 1-4 inches by 124 inches, con- taining 2,200 cu. ft. of gas at 150 lbs. pressure. One such cylinder will supply the eight light bridge for five months, lights burning night and day, requiring no attention except to clean lamps every thirty days. 426 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS three must make a mistake if the wrong authority is granted, and it would seem impossible that an error could be thus made. The record of four months shows that nothing approaching such an error has been experienced. The duties of each man are so simple, compared with the handling of a hundred or more train orders every day, and he has practically but one thing to do at a time, while a dispatcher on an ordinary district has sometimes a dozen matters requiring attention, and operators and trainmen have numerous orders, each -of which must be delivered and executed .without failure or oversight." — From Locomotive -Vjrcmcn and Engineers' Magazine, May. 1908. >• BLOCK SIGNAL EXAMINATION. QUESTIONS WITH ANSWERS. O. What is a block signal? A. A telegraph station with all the necessary signals for blocking trains. O. What is a block. A. The distance between the outer approaching switches of two block stations. O. What is a positive block? A. A Block where there is only one train allowed at a time. O. What is a cautionary or permissive block? A. A block where two trains are allowed by the use of a cautionary card or signal. O. Are block signals used for any other purpose than blocking trains? A. They may be used for stopping trains for telegraphic orders. 0. What rules besides block signal rules apply to them? A. Train order rules. O. What is a block signal? A. A semaphore where arms govern by day, and red, green and white lights by night. 0. Which arm and light of the block signal govern trains approaching such signal? A. The right arm and the light facing the train. Q. What does the horizontal position of the arm or red light signify ? A. Danger. Q. What does the diagonal position of the arm or green light signify? A. Caution; another train is in the block. O. What does the vertical position of the arm or the white light signify? A. Clear; no train in the block. 427 428 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS O. When a clear signal is given how far does it indi- cate that block is clear? A. To outer approaching switch of the block station ahead. Q. What switch is meant by the outer approaching switch of the block station ahead? A. The one farth- est out from that station. Q. At what position must signals always be kept ex- cept when changed to permit a train to pass ? A. Hori- zontal or danger. Q. While you have train orders on hand, at what position must block signals be left? A. Horizontal or danger. Q. What must be done before issuing clearance cards to trains to which you haxe delivered orders? A. As- certain that there are no more orders and that the block is clear. Q. If you have no orders for a train, which is ap- proaching, and block ahead is -clear, when should you give clear signal to that train? A, As early as possible in order that they will not reduce speed. Q. When is the proper time to report a train clear of a block? A. One hundred yards past the block station. Q. When is a proper time to replace danger signals after a train has passed? A. Immediately after the markers have passed the block station. O. , How are you to know when an entire train has passed your station ? A. By the markers. Q. What are the markers? A. Red and green lights by night and green flags by day. 0. If a train passes with no markers displayed what would you infer, and w T hat action would you take? A. Notify block stations on each side and report to train dis- patcher that train has parted. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 429 Q. If you are notified by next block station in either direction that a train which had entered block has parted what would you do? A. Give ''train parted" signal to engineer as front portion approached. O. What is a "train parted" signal ? A. A lamp or flag swung vertically at arm's length across the track. O. For what purpose is a cautionary block signal or card used? A. To allow a train to enter a block which is not clear. Q. Suppose that two or more sections of a train were to meet an opposing train at your station ; would you give the opposing train a clear signal before all the sections had passed and all others had been completed and de- livered or cancelled or while there was another train in the block? A. No. O. What record of movements of train is to be kept and at what time must the record commence? A. A record of train movements should be kept on a train reg- ister sheet and should be commenced at midnight daily. 0. How are trains to be reported? A. To offices both in advance and rear. O. What does signal B signify? A. Block. O. What must be done with regard to an approach- ing train if a train from an opposite direction upon single track has entered the block? A. Leave danger signal displayed to hold the approaching train. 0. What should be done upon the approach of a train ? A. If block is clear, and if you hold no orders for the train, display white or clear signal allowing it to proceed. Q. What would be done in case you could not raise the next block station to get him to block trains and you could not raise train dispatcher for instructions? A. Issue a caution card stating the facts of the case. The 430 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS train could then proceed only as in accordance with the time schedule. O. Under what conditions may a train be permitted to enter a block before a preceding train has cleared that block? A. Under a cautionary signal or card. O. How must your signals be displayed when trains are to meet at your station? A. They should be held at danger until one train is clear on the side track. O. What must be done in case a train is to use a cross-over switch or enter the opposite or wrong-going track? A. The conductor must notify the operator, at the block station to be last passed, of his intentions, who will notify the operator in the block station in advance, to use the danger or cautionary signals for all opposing trains until informed that the train which crossed over has reached his or another block. Station on the right track. O. If a train enters a siding at your station to be met and passed by another train what must you know before reporting the block clear? A. That the markers on the rear of the train are clear on siding and that the switch is closed. O. If it should be necessary to stop a train while it is passing your station for which you have given a clear or caution which signal would you use? A. The danger signal, also hand signal. O. After an engine or train has passed your office and you are offered an order for that train, or you are ordered to block it, what would you do ? A. Refuse by stating the circumstances and then endeavor to stop the train. Q. What must be done before closing a block signal STATION AND TRAIN WORK 431 station? A. Get relief from the train dispatcher and notify the offices on each side. 0. When block offices are closed -what must be done with the signals ? A. Leave them at white. 0. What must be done when an office is reopened? A. Report to the train dispatcher for duty and notify the stations on each side. O. What must be done before allowing the first train to pass? A. Ascertain if block is clear. O. When should hand signals be used? A. At any time when the proper indications cannot he given by the fixed signal. SIGNALLING CATECHISM. Q. What do block signals control? A. The use of certain blocks. O. Do they affect the movement of trains under time table or train rules? A. No. O. Do you consider that a block signal relieves you in any way from protecting your train by flagman? A. No' O. Explain the position of block signal when "Clear" and at "Stop." A. When at "Clear" they will show a diagonal arm by day and a green light at night. When at "Danger" a horizontal arm or a red light at night. O. When signal is clear to what point does it give you a clear track? A. To the outer approaching switch at the next sta- tion. Q. What is meant by the outer approaching switch at station? A. The first switch reached. O. Do block signals control trains standing on side track ? A. No. Q. What authority is necessary before train on side track can proceed? A. Authority from the signal man. O. Of what does such authority consist? A. A caution card and release, a release stamped 432 STATION AND TRAIN WORK 433 "Block is Clear/' a train order stamped "Block is Clear" or train orders and a caution card. Q. How must trains moving under caution card ex- pect to find main track? A. Occupied in that block. O. When two or more trains coupled together enter a block when can they be uncoupled and what is your duty ? A. Only at a block station and signalman to be no- tified. Q. What is necessary before train crosses from one main track to another? A. A cross-over permit. O. After clearing a block what are instructions rela- tive to re-entering or backing into same? A. Must not back within 300 feet of the block with- out authority from the signalman. Q. How long are •trainmen required to watch block signal to see that position does not change? A. Until the entire train has passed. 0. If you came to a block signal where a signalman is regularly employed and found no signalman there what would you do ? A. Would wait ten minutes, then proceed to the next block station, and report the fact to the train dispatcher. This applies to an intermediate station where there are no sidings. O. When parted train has been recoupled who must conductor notify? A. The signalman. 0. Will hand signals be accepted against block sig- nals? A. No. 434 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS O. What is required of conductor when track is ob- structed between block stations? A. Conductor should notify the nearest block signal 1 man. O. Upon entering a siding at a block station what notice is required of conductor to signalman when train is clear of main track and switch is locked ? A. He must personally notify the signalman that train is clear of main track. 0. What is an intermediate siding? A. A side track between two open block stations. O. What is required of an inferior train accepting a clear signal, intending to proceed to next block station on its right, but which through delay cannot reach such station, and an intermediate siding is located between blocks? What is required of a superior train? A. They must take the intermediate siding, or if un- able to reach same they should protect themselves with flagman. The superior train would proceed by authority of caution card. 0. What form of release is required where two trains are scheduled to meet at an intermediate siding? A. A release showing that train order signal is dis- played for these two trains to meet at the intermediate siding. O. If the inferior train fails to make the meeting- point how 7 will the superior train be governed. A. It will proceed on its time table rights and the same as on caution card. O. When two trains meet by special order at an in- termediate siding what is necessary besides the order be- fore entering the block? STATION AND TRAIN WORK 435 A. A release stating that signal is displayed for such trains to meet at the intermediate siding. TEX MINUTE BLOCK. Q. In districts not controlled by telegraph block how far apart must trains in the same direction keep? A. Ten minutes. Q. If you are passed by any train at an intermediate siding how long would you wait before proceeding? A. Ten minutes. DEFINITIONS. Q. Define a block? A. A length of track of stated limits, controlled by a block signal. O. A positive block? A. One in which only one train is allowed at a time. O. A permissive block? A. One in which two or more trains are allowed. O. A block station? A. A place from which block signals are operated. O. A block signal? A. A fixed signal controlling the use of a block. ^ Q. A home block signal? A. A fixed signal at the entrance of a block to con- trol trains entering same. O. A distant signal? A. A fixed signal used in connection with the Home signal to indicate that the Home signal may be at "Stop" when the distant signal is at "Caution" or that the Home signal is clear when the distant signal is clear. 436 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS Q. An advance block signal? A. A fixed signal used in connection with a Home block signal to subdivide the block in advance. Q. What is a block system? A. A series of consecutive blocks. Q. A telegraph block system ? A. A block system in which the signals are operated manually upon information by telegraph. 0. A controlled manual block system? A. A block system in which the signals are operated manually and so constructed as to require the co-opera- tion of the signalman at both ends of the block to display a clear signal. O. What is an automatic block system? A. A block system in which the signals are operated by electric, pneumatic or other agency actuated by a train or by certain conditions affecting the use of the block. SIGNALS USED IN AUTOMATIC BLOCK. O. What signals are used in connection with the auto- matic block system? A. Either the semaphore or the enclosed disc. O. How are the signal indications given by day and by night? A. By not more than two positions of an arm or disc, and at night by light of prescribed colors. O. Explain where you would look for these signals on single, double and three tracks? A. Over or upon the right of the track to which they refer, and on double track to the left of the track to which they refer, for one or two tracks the signals may STATION AND TRAIN WORK 437 be attached to the same mast. For three tracks, usually over the running track. Q. When these signals are located on bracket posts what signal would you read for the track on which you are running ? A. The signal on the right hand mast refers to the track furthest to the right, the next signal to the left re- fers to the next track to the left and so on. O. To what side of the signal mast are semaphore arms displayed as seen from an approaching train? A. To the right of the mast. O. What would a distant block signal set at caution indicate ? A. A distant block signal indicates the position of the Home signal ahead. Q. When the indicator disc is visible at a main track switch what would it indicate? A. It would indicate that the head of an approaching train had reached a point within 1,000 feet in advance of the block signal protecting the switch. Q. By what signal are the indications for the main running track given? A. By a high Home signal. Q. In what direction do even numbered signals gov- ern? A. South or East. Q. Odd numbered signals? A. North or West. Q. Where a semaphore signal is used where are the arms displayed and how many positions are there? A. To the right of the mast. There are two posi- tions. RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS O. How at night? £> x A. It will show a green light when at clear and a red light when at danger. Q. Where signal disc is used how are the indications given ? A. By a position of a red or clear disc. O. How at night ? A. By the light of the same color. O. What is the "Stop" and "Proceed" signal on a Home Semaphore by day and by night? A. When at stop it will show a horizontal arm to the right of the mast and at night a red light. When "Clear" it will show a diagonal arm by day and a green light by night. O. Where two signals are displayed from the same mast what does the upper arm indicate? A. The upper one is the Home block signal for the block in advance. Q. What does the lower arm indicate? A. It is the distant signal for the second block, in ad- vance. O. What is a caution signal on a Distant Semaphore signal? A. The arm displayed in a horizontal position and at night a green and red light. O. What is a Clear signal on a distant Semaphore signal ? A. The arm displayed diagonally and at night a green light. 0. What is a Stop signal on a Home Disc signal by clay and by night? A. A red disc and at night a red light. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 439 0. What is a Clear signal on a Home Disc signal by day and by night? A. The red disc withdrawn from view and at night a green light. O. What is the Caution signal on a Distant Disc sig- nal by day and by night? A. A green disc with a white cross on its face or a red and green light at night. O. What does such Caution signal mean? A. To proceed with caution to the Home signal. Q. What is a "Clear" signal on a Distant Disc signal ? A. The disc withdrawn from view and at night a green light. 0. When a train is stopped by an automatic block signal when may it proceed and how will it run ? A. When the signal is cleared, or after waiting one minute for signal to clear. It should run with caution to the next clear signal. O. What is the indication when a signal is out of service and how will you proceed? A. It will be covered with a white shield. Would proceed with caution to the next signal. Q. What is necessary when you find a signal out of order? A. Would notify superintendent. Q. When a Home signal indicates "Stop" what does it mean? A. It indicates that the block is occupied, that a switch is wrong in the block, that a car is foul of the main track or that the signal apparatus is out of order. 0. If you desire to pass from a side track to the main track and you find a red disc visible in the indicator box, what would you do? 440 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS A. Would not open switch until red disc disappeared from view. Q. Can a switch be opened to permit a train to move from the main to a side track when the red disc is visi- ble in the indicator box at the switch? A. Yes. SIGNALS OF INTERLOCKING PLANTS. Q. What is a high signal ? A. A signal supported on a mast 20 feet or more high. Q. A mast? A. An upright to which signals are attached. Q. A Home signal ? A. A fixed signal at which trains are required to stop when the route is not clear. Q. A distant signal? A. A fixed signal used in connection with the Home signal to indicate that the Home signal may be at "Stop" when the Distant signal is at "Caution" or that the Home signal is at "Clear'' when the Distant signal is "Clear." Q. A Dwarf signal? A. A low Home signal. Q. What signal is used at interlocking plants? A. The Semaphore signal. Q. How are the indications given by day and by night ? A. By semaphore arms by day and lights of pre- scribed color by night. O. Where are these signals located on single, double and three tracks? A. On single track they are either over or to the rigH' STATION AND TRAIN WORK 441 of the track to which they refer, on double track they are located to the left of the track to which they refer, on three tracks usually over the running track. O. To what side of the mast are the arms displayed as seen from an approaching train? A. To the right. Q. Explain the position of signal on bracket posts and what track they control ? A. The signals on the right hand mast refer to the track furthest to the right ; the signals on the next mast to the left refer to the next track to the left, and so on. Q. When the train service on one main track is su- perior to that of another how will the signals be dis- played ? A. The signals for the superior track will be placed six feet higher than those for the inferior track. 0. By what will the indication for main running track in the established direction be given? A. Home signal. O. At junction points where two signals are located on the same mast what route will the top signal govern ? A. The superior route. Q. What is the indication for a diverging movement from the main running track in the established direction to a secondary or side track? A. By a Dwarf signal. Q. Where will the Dwarf signal be located? A. To the right of the track to which it refers, and either at the foot of or opposite the high Home signal. O. How will the light on the Dwarf signal show to indicate a diverging movement? A. It will show either a diagonal arm or a green light. 442 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS Q. How will the high Home signal show? A. It will indicate "Stop." Q. By what signal will the indication for a reverse movement from the established direction on or from a main running track, or for a movement to or from a side track in either direction be given? A. By a Dwarf signal. Q. What does a Home signal in a horizontal position or a red light by night denote? A. Stop. Q. What does it mean when the arm is inclined diag- onally downward or a green light is shown ? A. Proceed. O. What does it mean when the Distant signal is in a horizontal position or a red and green light is shown? A. It would indicate that the Home signal may be at danger and train should proceed with caution prepared to stop before Home signal is reached. O. What does it indicate when Distant signal is in a diagonal position or a green light is shown? A. It means that the Home signal is at clear. O. When a signal indicates "Stop" where must en- gine be stopped? A. Before signal is passed. O. If after receiving a "Clear" signal the semaphore is placed in the "Stop" position what should be done? A. Train should stop at once. Q. What report should be made of same ? A. It should be reported to the Superintendent. O. In case you experience an unusual delay at an in- terlocking plant what report should be made of same; A. Report should be made to the Superintendent. s , 3 STATION AXD TRAIX WORK 443 SIGNALS OF INTERLOCKING PLANTS. Q. What is a high signal ? A. A signal supported on a mast 20 feet or more high. Q. A mast? A. An upright to which signals are attached. O. A Home signal? A. A fixed signal at which trains are required to stop when the route is not clear. O. A Distant signal ? A. A fixed signal used in connection with the Home signal to indicate that the Home signal may be at stop when the Distant signal is at caution or that the Home signal is at clear when the Distant signal is at clear. 0. A Dwarf signal? A. A low Home signal. O. What signal is used at interlocking plants ? A. The Semaphore signal. Q. How are the indications given by day and bv night ? A. By semaphore arm by day and light of prescribed colors at night. O. Where are these signals located on single, double and three tracks? A. On single track they are either over or to the right of the track to which they refer ; on double track they are located to the left of the track to which they refer (or as the case may be). O. To what side of the mast are the arms that govern displayed as seen from an approaching train? A. To the right of the mast. 444 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS O. Explain the position of signals on bracket posts and what tracks they control ? A. The signals on the right hand mast refer to the track furthest to the right ; the signals on the next mast to the left refer to the next track to the left, and so on. O. When the train service on the main track is su- perior to that of another how will the signals be dis- played ? A. The signals for the superior track will be placed six feet higher than those for the inferior track. O. By what will the indication for main running track in the established direction be given? A. A Home signal. O. At junction points where two signals are located on the same mast what route does the top signal govern ? A. The superior route. Q. What is the indication for a diverging movement from the main running track in the established direction to a secondary or side track? A. By a Dwarf signal. Q. Where will the Dwarf signal be located? ' A. To the right of the track to which it refers and either at the foot of or opposite the high Home signal. Q. How will the light on the Dwarf signal show to indicate a diverging movement? A. It will show either a diagonal arm or a green light. O. How will the high Home signal show? A. It will indicate stop. O. By what signal will the indication for a reverse movement from the established direction on or from a main running track or for a movement to or from a side track in either direction be given? STATION AXD TRAIN WORK 415 A. By Dwarf signals. O. What does a Home signal in a horizontal position or a red light by night denote and how would you be gov- erned ? A. It indicates stop and I would not pass it while in that position. O. What does it mean when the arm is inclined diag- onally downward or a green light is shown? A. Proceed. 0. What does it mean when the Distant signal is in a horizontal position or a red and green light is shown and how would you be governed? A. It indicates that the Home signal may be at dan- ger and train should proceed with caution. O. What does it indicate when distant signal is in a diagonal position or a' green light is shown? A. It means that the Home signal is at clear. Q. When a signal indicates stop, where must engine be stopped? A. Before signal is passed. O. If after receiving a "dear" signal the semaphore is placed in a stop position what should be done ? A. Train should stop at once. Q. What report should be made of same? A. It should be reported to the Superintendent. Q. What is your duty when approaching interlocking stations when train is parted? A. To sound the train parted signal. O. What is your understanding about allowing sand to be dropped and overflow from ejector to run down on track in the vicinity of interlocking plants? A. It should not be done. 446 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS O. In case you experience an unusual delay at an in- terlocking plant what report must be made of same? A. Report should be made to the Superintendent. SIGNALMEN AT INTERLOCKING PLANTS. Q. Have you received a copy of the Rules and Regu- lations of the Railway Company, effective , 19 — , and do you understand that they supersede all previous rules and regulations? A. Yes. Q. Have you read the Rules and Regulations ; are you conversant with them and will you obey the instruc- tions contained therein? A. Yes. O. Do you understand that in accepting employment vou assume its risks, and that each employe is responsible for his own safety, and must exercise care to avoid in- jury to others? A. Yes. Q. What is the rule in regard to the use of liquor, the frequenting of places where liquor is sold and the use of tobacco? A. The use of liquor and the frequenting of places where sold is prohibited, and the use of tobacco in and rtbout passenger stations and on passenger cars is not allowed. O. When are night signals displayed? A. From sunset to sunrise, except in heavy weather, when they should be displayed to suit conditions. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 447 DEFINITIONS. O. What is a high signal? A. A signal supported on a mast at least 20 feet above the track. O. A mast? A. An upright to which the signals are attached. O. A Home signal? A. A fixed signal at a point at which trains are re- quired to stop when the route is not clear. O. A Distant signal? A. A fixed signal used in connection with the Home signal to indicate that the Home signal may be at stop when the Distant signal is at caution ; or that the Home signal is at clear when the Distant signal is clear. Q. A Dwarf signal? A. A signal indicating a diverging movement from the main track. Q. What is the normal position of Home and Distant signals ? A. The normal indication of Home signal is at stop and of Distant signal at caution. 0. On what side of mast are arms displayed for trains in a particular direction ? A. To the right of the mast. O. When the train service on one main running track is superior to that of another- how are the signals ar- ranged for each track? . A. The signals for the superior tracks are located 6y 2 feet higher than those for inferior tracks. O. How is the signal for a main running track move- ment eiven? 448 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS A. By a high Home signal. O. At junction points where two signals are located on the same mast what route does the top signal govern? A. A superior route. O. What is the indication for a diverging movement from the main running track in the established direction to a secondary or side track ? A. A Dwarf signal with a diagonal arm or a green light. O. Where w r ill the Dwarf signal be located? A. On the right of and adjoining the track to Which it refers and either at the foot of or opposite the high Home signal. Q. How will the light on the Dwarf signal show to indicate a diverging movement? A. Green. O. How will the high Home signal show when the Dwarf signal indicates diverging movement? A. Stop. O. By what signal will the indication for a reverse movement from the established direction, on or from the main running track, or for a movement to or from a side track, in either direction be given? A. By a Dwarf signal. O. When the route is not clear how does the Home signal show by day and by night? A. A horizontal arm by day and in addition a red light by night. O. How does it show when clear by day and by night? A. The arm in diagonal position and in addition at night a green light. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 449 Q. How does the Distant signal show when at caution by day and by night ? A. The arm in a horizontal position and in addition a red and green light at night. Q. How does the Distant signal show when the route is clear by day and by night? A. The arm in a diagonal position and in addition a green light at night. Q. What persons are allowed to operate levers and other appliances at interlocking towers? A. Only those whose duties require them to operate them. , O. Except when signals are cleared for the passage of trains how should they be left? A. In the normal position. 0. When should signals be cleared for approaching trains ? A. In sufficient time to avoid delay to the train. Q. After a train has passed when should signals be restored to normal position? A. As soon as the train has passed to Home signal limits. Q. If, after having given a train clear track it is necessary to change the route, what must be done before switches are changed? A. The train must be stopped. O. What about moving a switch when a train is standing close to same? A. It should not be done. O. If any indication of derangement of the signal ap- paratus, what must be done before operating same? A. They should be examined. 450 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS Q. What is necessary in cold weather to prevent con- nections from freezing? A. Signal should be operated frequently to prevent freezing. O. What is necessarv when a signal fails to work properly ? A. It should not be used and should be secured to give the normal indication until repaired. O. What about allowing alterations or additions to in- terlocking plants? A. It should not be done without proper authority. O. If there is a derailment or switch run through at an interlocking plant, or if any damage occurs to, same, what is required? A. The signal should be placed to give the normal indication and no train allowed to use the same until they have been put in order. Q. What is necessary when a switch is disconnected from interlocking apparatus? A. It must be securely fastened. O. What is necessarv during snow storms? A. To know that switches are properly cleaned. O. If any electrical or mechanical appliance fails to work properly what is required of signalman? A. Notice should be sent to the Division Superin- tendent and the repairman. O. When switches or signals are being repaired what is required of signalman? A. He should have an understanding with repairman before operating such signals. O. What is your duty in regard to observing passing trains and what would you do in case you found any- thing wrong with same ? STATION AND TRAIN WORK 451 A. I would do everything possible to prevent damage or injury. O. If you have information that an approaching train has broken in two what is your duty? A. I would use every effort to give the train a clear route and give train parted signals to enginemen. O. What danger signal should be kept on hand at interlocking towers? A. Red lamps and flags, torpedoes and fusees. O. If necessary to discontinue the use of any signal how will signalman handle trains? A. By hand signal. O. Who is held responsible for the care of an inter- locking station and its appliances? A. The signalman. O. How should lights in an interlocking station be placed? A. So they ■ cannot be seen from the approaching train. 0. What should be done when a train runs by a stop signal ? A. The Division Superintendent should be notified. Q. What persons are allowed in an interlocking sta- tion? A. Only those whose duties require them to be there. REPAIRMEN. O. Who is responsible for the proper inspection and adjustment of interlocking plants? A. The repairman. O. What report must be made when track or switches do not permit of proper operation? 452 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS A. A report should be sent to the Superintendent. Q. Wh5n repairing interlocking- plants with whom must you have an understanding and whom must you notify when such repairs are completed? A. The signalman. O. What is necessary when any switch is discon- nected ? A. It should be securely fastened before any train is permitted to pass over it. O. By whom are alterations or additions to interlock- ing plants authorized? A. The Chief Engineer. O. To whom must you report your whereabouts? A. The Division Superintendent. POINTERS FOR CONDUCTORS. Conductors should remember that they were once brakemen themselves, and should bear in mind that a kind word and genial manner often secures better re- sults than a sullen demeanor and gruff manner; besides it makes friends of their worthy fellow 7 employes and the public generally, in addition to elevating them in the estimation of their immediate superior officers. Conductors should be at their trains at terminal sta- tions at least thirty minutes in advance of the schedule leaving time, or the time at which they were called to leave, and so far as their personal attention will permit should insure leaving promptly on time. They are responsible for the safe management of their train, and for the strict performance of duty on the part of the men engaged with them. In order to secure ef- fective work, conductors should be familiar with the du- ties required of train employes. They should require their brakemen to assist ladies, children and infirm persons off and on the cars, and should render such assistance themselves when neces- sary. They are clothed by law with the power of sheriffs in order to quell disturbances or to protect property or per- sons upon their trains. Should it ever become necessary to make arrests upon such occasions, the offenders should be secured and delivered to the sheriff or police at the first station where such officers may be found. When a conductor discovers anything wrong with the 453 454 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS track, bridges or culverts, likely to cause an accident to a following train, he should not wholly depend upon the telegraph in order to notify other trains, but should leave a flagman and in addition notify the nearest section fore- man. When notified of a defect in the telegraph line they should instruct their brakemen to watch for it, and when it is found its character and location should be reported to the telegraph operator at the next office. When an accident occurs which involves loss of life, serious injury of persons, damage to property or the obstruction of the track, or when the track is impassable because of snow or damage by flood or any other cause, conductors should report the fact to the proper official by telegraph as soon as possible, giving all the informa- tion necessary to a clear understanding of the case, such as the location, nature, cause and extent of the injury, damage or obstruction, and they should state what relief or assistance is required. In the train register book at all terminal stations, or wherever such books are kept, they should enter imme- diately before departing and upon arrival, the time of departure or arrival of their trains, the number of the en- gine, name of the engineer, and whether or not signals are carried and also other entries required by their com- pany. The signal for starting passenger trains from division terminals should always be given by conductors with the air signal cord from the rear of the train. Particular attention should be given to the safety and comfort of passengers. Careful attention should also be given to the heating, lighting and ventilating of cars, and the supply of drinking water in the tanks. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 455 Shortly before reaching a station at which the train stops, brakemen or porters should pass through it, ex- cept the sleeping and dining cars, and announce distinctly twice in each car (with the doors closed) the name of the station the train is approaching, and if, for any rea- son, the train is thereafter stopped before reaching the station so announced, the passengers should be apprised thereof to prevent them from leaving the train at the wrong place. At junction stations and crossings, where trains leave in different directions, conductors should cause to be an- nounced before starting distinctly in each coach the di- rection in which their trains are to go, and the names of the principal stations on the route. Conductors should also notify passengers of the departure of their train in time before leaving meal stations. Conductors should see that passengers are seated and should not permit them to ride on coach platforms. Freight conductors should allow none but the train crew to ride on their trains without a special permit. Conductors of passenger trains are generally required to wear the uniform adopted by the company in whose employ they are. When from any cause conductors leave cars at a sta- tion without having received orders to do so they should notify the proper official by telegraph, giving the initials, numbers and kind of cars, the siding where left, the rea- sons for having left them. They should also examine the train equipment and see that necessary tools and sup- plies are on hand and in their proper places. Conductors should comply with the directions of agents in placing cars and doing other station work ; when it is 456 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS necessary to move cars that are placed for loading or unloading, they should be replaced. In case an agent's orders appear to be unreasonable the fact should be reported to the proper officials. Conductors, or trainmen should part their trains to the full width of the highway in order to clear all cross- ings while standing at stations. In no case should cars be switched or the train backed over a public crossing, or highway, unless a man is on the forward end of the first approaching car to see that the crossing is clear ; if at night he should display a light. When cars leave the track they should not be turned over, thrown down embankments, or broken up, merely to get them out of the way. Every effort should be made by trainmen to set them on the track, and they should take the damaged cars to the nearest available siding; the conductor should, when necessary, call on section men or any other available force for assistance, which should be rendered promptly. Conductors of trains carrying live stock should consult the stockmen in matters pertaining to the care and com- fort of the stock and in warm weather hogs should be watered as often as necessary. The doors of empty cars hauled in a train should be kept closed. Conductors should carefully examine the seals and locks and keep a record of their condition in order to be in a position to give definite and clear answejs to inquiries. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 457 POINTERS TO BRAKEMEN. Brakemen as a rule aspire to become conductors. They should bear in mind that in addition to the faithful dis- charge of their duties the deportment has much to do with their promotion. Brakemen are usually under the orders of the conductor and should be at the terminal sta- tion not later than thirty minutes before the departure of their train. Neatness in personal appearance and civility towards passengers and fellow workmen cut quite a figure. They should have their lamps trimmed and ready for lighting. If in passenger service they should see that the heating and ventilation of the coaches are properly regulated. When on duty passenger brakemen are usually re- quired to wear the regulation uniform and badges adopted by the company in whose service they are. On steep grades the rear brakeman should remain on the caboose to take care of the rear end and stop it in case the train should break in two. Brakemen should familiarize themselves with the du- ties of a conductor in order to be able to take charge of their train in case of accident or sickness. When a brakeman goes out as a flagman he is equally responsible with the conductor for the faithful discharge of his duties. When it can be done tail lights or markers should be taken to the rear of passenger trains without passing through the sleeping or dining cars. Head end brakemen when riding on the engine should comply with the orders of the engineer in all matters per- taining to the safety of the train. GENERAL RULES COVERING THE OPERATION OF TRAINS AND HANDLING OF FREIGHT AND PASSENGERS. Not to go to Meals Without Permission. Conductors and enginemen should not go to meals nor delay their trains from any cause after receiving an order allowing them to proceed without asking for and obtaining special permission to do so from the train dispatcher. In case a train has work to do they should immediately notify the train dispatcher of the probable length of time before they would be ready to leave. After receiving permission, the conductor should report when he is ready to go, and ask if there are any further orders. All communications from conductors, enginemen and others concerning train or- ders should be addressed to the train dispatcher in writ- ing- Changing Off. When enginemen or conductors change off before the completion of their trips, they should care- fully change any orders they may have and should see that they are perfectly understood by those to w T hom transferred. Changes of this kind should not be made without the consent of the train dispatcher. Train Baggage-men and Freight Men. Train baggage men and freight men are under the immediate charge of the conductor of the train and when not in conflict with the Company's rules must obey his orders. Train bag- gage men ought to provide themselves with a copy of the rules and regulations issued by the Company's gen- eral baggage agent and observe them. 458 STATION AND TRAIN WORK 459 Riding Cars and Switching. None but train men or switch men should be allowed to ride cars, or in any way assist in switching trains on the road or at terminals. Riding on Locomotive Pilots. No person should be allowed to ride upon the pilot of a locomotive either in dispatch of duty or otherwise. Track Scales. Switches should be set for dead rails over track scales when they are not being used for weigh- ing purposes. Turn-tables Locked. Turn-tables should be locked with a switch lock, by enginemen immediately after use unless in charge of employees. When turn-tables are found unlocked or locks are discovered to be out of order the fact should be immediately reported to the Superin- tendent by wire. Taking Coal and Water. When it is necessary to take coal or water, freight trains of more than 20 cars in length should be stopped 100 feet from coal or water stations and engine uncoupled. Before starting again the engineman should know that the aprons and spouts have been properly placed to clear passing trains. Engines Standing in Highway Crossings. Engines should not be permitted to stand nearer than 100 feet to street or highway crossings, nor under a bridge if it can be avoided, neither in the vicinity of waiting rooms, offices or cars occupied by passengers where the noise or smoke is likely to disturb the occupants. Dead Engines in Transit. When more than one en- gine is to be hauled as freight in a train at least three box or stock cars should be placed between them unless otherwise instructed. Dead engines should not be hauled without side-rods unless by permission of the superin- 460 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS tendent and then their speed should not exceed that pre- scribed under such circumstances. Closed Doors. The door of freight cars ought to be kept closed when not in use. Flagging. The utmost care should be observed by brakemen in watching train to see it does not part. In case a train should part in two they are required to pro- tect their train with the utmost promptness. As required by the rules they should not wait for instructions from the conductor to protect train by .flagging and to this end brakemen should be fully acquainted with the Stand- ard Code of Rules on this point and the rules of the com- pany by which they are employed. Trains Parting. Should trains part from any cause, the facts should be reported to the Superintendent on the prescribed form. Full information should also be given by the conductor in. person to the car inspector or his representative at the first terminal. Use of Cars. Economy in the use of cars should be practiced as much as possible. Cars ought never to be forwarded with less than 2,000 pounds, small lots being loaded into passing trains. At junction points if cars con- tain less than 2,000 pounds they should be unloaded and consolidated with other lots and forwarded without un- reasonable delay. Transportation of a Corpse. A corpse should not be received for transportation unless accompanied by a phy- sician's certificate or certificate of inquest from the cor- oner or by a permit for transportation from the clerk of the Board of Health of the county or city through which trains happen to be passing. There should likewise be a certificate from the undertaker, showing that the person did not die of a contagious disease. In no case should STATION AND TRAIN WORK 461 it be received for transportation if perceptibly offensive, no matter whether accompanied by a physician's certifi- cate or not. Unchecked Baggage, Etc. Unchecked articles or bag- gage should not be received for transportation unless au- thorized by the general baggage agent, general superin- tendent or superintendent. The Company's business al- ways excepted. Money Packages. Letters or packages containing money whether registered or not should not be forwarded in the baggage xars, train baggage men should refuse to receive from any employee packages of this description marked "Railway Business." If a baggage-man should discover after leaving a station that a money-letter or package has been given him with other mail for transpor- tation, he should retain it in his possession until his re- turn trip and then deliver it at the station from which he received it, sending a full report of the transaction to the general baggage agent of the Company by whom he is employed. Mail Matter. Under no circumstances ought mail to be received for transportation (as Railway business) un- less it is known to actually pertain to the service of the Railway Company. All other mail matter must be sent by United States mail. Freight to and From Prepaid Stations. Agents re- ceiving freight for shipment to stations at which there is no agent should require pre-payment of the charges and should note on the receipt given that it is received upon conditions that the Company is not to be held re- sponsible for it after it has been unloaded at destination. Freight so received should be way-billed by the Forward- ing Agent to the first station at which there is an agent 462 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS beyond its destination, but at rates current to the station to which consigned. Instructions to the conductor should be noted in ink on the face of the way-bill to unload the shipment at its proper destination. Conductors when unloading consignments of this sort, should, when practi- cable, take receipt for it on the way-bill from the con- signee, leaving the way-bill at the first station at which there is an agent beyond the point of delivery. Should the consignee not be on hand to receive the shipment, and in case it is of much value or likely to suffer from ex- posure to the weather, conductors should take it and de- liver it, together with the way-bill, at the first station at which there is an agent beyond the designated point. Handling Special Shipments. Shipments consigned "to order' or "to notify" or "to be delivered only on surrender of bill of lading" should be taken by the con- ductor to the first station at which there is an agent. When shipments are offered to conductors for transpor- tation at stations where there is no agent they should refuse to accept it unless accompanied by full shipping directions in writing, giving name of consignor and con- signee, destination, and number and mark on packages. Conductors should hand such shipping directions to the agent at the first regular station beyond the point where he received the shipment and that agent should imme- diately make a way-bill covering the shipment from his station but at rates current from the station at which the shipment w r as received, noting on the face of the way-bill the name of station, from which the shipment was loaded. Cars Unsafely Loaded. Conductors should refuse to accept cars which in their judgment appear to be unsafely loaded and should report the facts to the train dispatcher. Refrigerator Cars. When refrigerator cars are not STATION AND TRAIN WORK 463 in a train for its regular run in accordance with the schedule the train dispatcher should be immediately noti- fied by telegraph. Conductors ought to examine the bunk- ers in refrigerator cars to ascertain whether sufficient ice has been provided to carry car to its destination. Should the car have any need of re-icing, the conductor should notify the train dispatcher and agent at the first terminal. Loading Merchandise. Merchandise such as flour, sugar, butter or commodities of a similar nature or class should not be loaded in cars formerly used for oil, lime, coal and other freight of the same class. . Agents should be careful to see that floors of cars are clean for such merchandise. When cars are not loaded with bulk grain, agents should see that grain doors are properly raised. Load in Station Order. Goods should not be mixed in loading. Whenever practicable each lot should be kept separate. If goods are loaded into a car from more than one station, the freight to be unloaded first, ought to be loaded into the car last. Goods for each station should be kept together and each lot of goods by itself. Con- ductors should report to the superintendent any neglect of agents in this matter. Agents and conductors should see that all goods in their charge are carefully handled and loaded in such a manner that no damage will result in transit by leakage of liquids, chafing of bales, etc. After freight has been unloaded from a car which contains other freight for other stations, conductors ought to see that the merchandise left in the car is properly secured by leveling down the piles of goods and blocking them with other freight so damage may be prevented. Casks, barrels, and other packages containing oil, turpentine, fish, tar, molasses and other goods of similar character 464 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS should be safely blocked, and not loaded in cars contain- ing merchandise liable to damage by leakage or by being scented by odors. Checking Freight. Way freight loaded into passing trains should be checked into the car by the conductor and any discrepancy or damage should be noted upon the way-bill. Loads Extending Over and Off Cars. It is exceed- ingly important that all cars loaded with lumber, timber, iron pipk, posts, etc., or other freight liable to project beyond the ends of a car should be carefully examined before being moved. Agents should exercise the utmost care in examining all such goods before forwarding, they should see that no part of the load extends beyond the end of the car, should see that it does not interfere in any way with free access to and working of the brakes, except in cases of very long timber requiring two cars, in which case the brakehead and stem may be removed if necessary, but it should be carefully attached to the car and for- warded with a notification to that effect on outside of way-bill. Whenever possible, flat cars to be loaded double should be switched with brakes on the outer end. Con- ductors should examine all cars before placing them in their trains and should refuse to accept any not prop- erly and safely loaded, reporting the same by wire with number of car to the superintendent or any other proper official. Hozv to Load. (a). "Telegraph poles and piles should be loaded with tips and butts alternating." On One Car. (b). "When telegraph poles are loaded on one car, six good hardwood stakes may be placed on each side of same as shown in Fig. 6 and four strands of new telegraph wire Standard size (8) to each pair STATION AND TRAIN WORK 465 of stakes should be tied across the car when one-third loaded and four strands tied over top of the load when the loading is completed, the stakes being notched to prevent the wire from slipping." On Tzvo Cars. (c). "Telegraph poles, etc., which require the use of two cars for loading, should be kept clear of car floors throughout by placing one good sound bearing piece of saddle ( 10" x 10") of sufficient length to reach' across the car, on each car, as shown in Fig. I and six bearing pieces or saddles may be brought to any point between and sufficiently near each other to prevent the shortest timber from working out from between the stakes. In addition to this there should be fixed to each side of the car over all, two good hardwood stakes, tied across with new telegraph wire of Standard size (8)." Loading Long and Short Poles, Etc. (d). "When necessary to load a few long poles or timber, on top of two cars containing short ones, in order to keep the long- timber clear from the short ones, beneath, as shown in Fig. 2, a bearing piece must be securely fastened on the top of each car, on the short timbers in order to allow the car to curve freely, and two stakes on each side of both cars near the end where the cars are coupled together must be run to the top of the long timbers and securely fastened with wire as already explained." On Three Cars. (e). "When the timber or poles are too long to be safely carried on two cars and three cars must be used/ bearing pieces are placed on each of the end cars, so as to keep the load entirely free from the center car (see Fig. 3)/' Two Shipments, (f). "When two shipments simi- lar to that referred to in the preceding clause are to be handled, each having timbers to be safely carried on two 466 ' RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS cars but not requiring more than one-half the length of another car, they ought to be placed so that the project- ing ends rest on the additional car, placed in the center with bearine pieces of sufficient thickness to keep the load clear from the car floor throughout, at a point be- tween the trucks of each car and near to those next to the end of load, the load to be placed, tied and staked as described above. (See Fig. 4)." Stakes, (g). "Stakes ought to be placed in a per- pendicular position and in no case should it exceed the width of the car (see Fig. 5). Poles and timber must not extend beyond the end of the car." Overloading, (h). "In order to prevent overloading (when load necessitates the use of more than one car) the weight to be carried should not exceed the capacity of one car provided the load rests on only one pair of trucks of each car. If the load is distributed between both pairs of trucks of each car, the combined capacity of both cars, may be allowed as a maximum weight/' Inspection, (i). At stations where telegraph poles, ties, etc., are to be loaded, agents should note personally that the cars are loaded in accordance with the foregoing instructions. In case there is no agent, conductor should see that the cars are loaded in accordance with the fore- going, before accepting them for their trains. Inspectors at division points should carefully examine all such freight and if cars are improperly loaded the fact should be im- mediately reported to the agent. Bonded Merchandise. Agents and conductors should refuse to accept cars loaded with bonded merchandise unless the following rules regulating the transportation of the same have been fully complied with: STATION AND TRAIN WORK 467 (i). Cars containing bonded goods should always be secured with custom seals and tags which should be re- moved by none but the customs officer. Any unauthorized person removing or tampering with these seals and tags renders himself liable to imprison- ment for not less than six months. U. S. CUSTOMS. U. S. CUSTOMS Unapprised Merchandise. IN BOND BONDED MERCHANDISE From Forwarded 190__ To Arrived 190_ (Departure.) Date UK) To (Arrival) Date V.)0 NOTICE Seals attached to this car NOTICE Seals attached to this car are to be removed by Cus- are to be removed by Cus- toms Officers only. Unauthorized toms Officers only. Unauthorized persons who wilfully break, cut or persons who wilfully break, cut or remove Customs Seals are liable to a remove Customs Seals are liable to a tine of $1,000, or imprisonment not fine of SI. 000. or imprisonment not exceeding Five years, or both. exceeding Five years, or both. Cards on Side of Car. (2). Every car which con- tains appraised bonded goods must have on its side a red card 3J/2" x 4^" in size, and every car containing unap- prised bonded goods must have on its side a yellow card 6" x 6" in size with the words in black letters as shown in figures. These cards to be furnished and pasted on the car by the agent at the time of shipment. Conductors to Examine Seals, Etc. (3). When re- ceiving cars and manifests, conductors should carefully examine custom seals to determine whether or not such seals are intact. If they find them broken or that they show signs of having been tampered with en route, the 468 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS matter should be immediately reported to the superintend- ent. Trans-SIiipmait. (4). In case of accident necessi- tating the trans-shipment of the contents of the car or in case of trans-shipment for any cause it must be made under the supervision of a customs officer. Packages Corded and Sealed. (5). Bales and pack- ages "corded and sealed" need not be transported in cars sealed with customs seals and may be transferred with- out the supervision of the customs officer. Such ship- ments-must in all cases be accompanied by a manifest. Freight Goods ivith Bonded. (6). Freight goods may. be conveyed in the same car with bonded goods but in that case the car must be sealed, etc., as indicated in the fore- going sections 1 and 2. Care should be taken not to ac- company bonded goods with freight goods destined for intermediate stations where there is no customs officer to open and re-seal the car. Sealing Cars. Agents should securely fasten the end doors and seal the side doors of all cars loaded by them immediately upon completion of the loading, except in those which contain rough stone, common bricks, sand, railroad ties, poles, posts, firewood, iron ore, iron or steel rails for railroad tracks and coal. When a shipper has especially requested it and is willing to have a notation made on the contract, bill of lading or shipping receipt and also on the way-bill that it is done at his risk car doors may be left open. Breaking Seals. Agents should keep a complete seal record in their seal book (when one has been provided) showing all cars left at and taken from their stations, or which were sealed or unsealed by them, including seals removed from or placed on passing way freight cars at STATION AND TRAIN WORK 469 their station. They should invariably note on the face of each way-bill receipted by them over their own signa- ture, the number of all seals broken by them on car* mentioned in the way-bill. In the case of cars containing freight for stations at which there are no Agents, con- ductors may break the seal, recording the number of same and reason for breaking them on the face of the way- bill and should have the car resealed upon its arrival at the first regular station. Seals Placed so Doors Cannot be Opened. Seals should be so placed on car doors by agents, to prevent doors being opened without seals being broken. They should be so placed that the numbers can be readily taken. Agents and conductors should report to the su- perintendent or other proper official the initials and num- bers of cars which they discover to have been improperly sealed. Sealing Material. Seals and seal presses ought to be under lock and key when not in use. Xone but the station agent or his authorized employee should be allowed to seal and unseal cars. Foreign Seals. Agents at junction stations who re- ceive loaded cars from connecting lines (which the rules of the Company by which they are employed do not re- quire to be sealed) need not attach seals providing those of connecting lines are found on car and in good order in every respect. Otherwise it is good practice to attach the Company's seal and notify the proper agent of the connecting line in writing. Where foreign seals are in- tact they are usually treated the same as if they were the Company's seals with the exception that any initials or other peculiarities should be observed and recorded in addition to the numbers shown. 470 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS Examining Seals. Conductors should carefully ex- amine seals before leaving their trains at end of rijn, when cars are set out en route and at all points where their train remains a sufficient time to permit an examination and they should ascertain whether the seals have been broken and in case any are found to have been broken' the facts should be noted in the train book and if it can- not be accounted for by the conductor, an immediate re- port should be made to the train dispatcher, superintend- ent or other official. Responsibility of Conductors. Conductors are deemed responsible for all freight in their charge. They are ex- pected to see to the loading and unloading of way freight and to note that all freight billed that is loaded or un- loaded by them as the case may be and also required to see that all way-bills are properly checked and that no discrepancy or damage which they may discover to any property whether loaded or unloaded by them or other- wise, is noted on the way-bill. They are required to cause the marks and contents of the packages to be called out as they are taken from the car. When they find freight in a car for which they have no freight-bill they should un- load it at the station marked on package, if they discover it in time, otherwise they should unload it at the next regular station, and call the attention of the agent at that station to the package. Agents are expected to tally freight as it is unloaded from cars and advise the con- ductor at the time of unloading of any "short," "over" or "damaged freight." Delivering Freight at Stations. When unloading way freight at stations, conductors are usually expected to place it in the ware-house or such other place as the agent may designate. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 471 Care in Handling Freight. Conductors ought to see that trainmen are careful in handling freight. Work Trains Carrying Laborers. Cars in which work- men are riding ought never to be pushed in front of an engine. They should be handled at the rear end of a train following the engine regardless of the direction in which the engine may be moving. Perishable Property. Cars containing perishable prop- erty should have precedent over other freight and ought never to be left at any station short of its destination un- less for repairs. If repairs cannot be made within twelve hours, attention ought to be called to the fact and in- structions obtained. Property Wrecked. In case property is wrecked in transit, but is afterward forwarded to its destination, the original way-bill should accompany it, bearing notation therein, showing where damage occurred. When prop- erty is not forwarded to its original destination, the way- bill should be turned over to the superintendent or other proper official in charge of clearing up the wreck. Disabled Cars. When a car disabled is left at a sta- tion at which there is no agent, or is left at such station for any other cause the conductor should deliver the bill to the agent at the next regular station, and endorse on way-bill when, where, and why the car was left, and re- port the same to the train dispatcher or other proper official. The same action should be taken by the conduc- tor in case he leaves a disabled car at a regular station except that way-bills may be delivered to the agent at the station where the car is left. When it becomes necessary to transfer freight from one car to another, while en route, the fact should be noted on the way-bill and the numbers and initials of the cars into which the property was trans- 472 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS ferred, together with the date and station where the transfer was made, should be shown thereon. The goods should be carefully checked from the way-bill and the condition of same at time of such transfer noted thereon at the same time, and a record of the transaction made in the conductor's train book. Leaving Cars on Sidings. Cars should not be left on sidings unless by authority of a train dispatcher. Station Grounds and Sidings. Station and track em- ployees should see that material stored along the track and at stations is neatly piled and that the "right-of- way" and station grounds are kept in an orderly condi- tion, the material should not be piled within six feet of the nearest rail of any main track, siding or yard track. Duties of Agents, Operators and Watchmen. Sta- tion agents, telegraph operators and watchmen, should immediately report to the superintendent or other offi- cial any severe rainstorm, high wind, or sudden rise of streams in their vicinity and in case of emergency should see that the section foreman and his men are on hand to protect the track from damage. They should see that cars have not been moved by the wind so as to endanger the passage of trains, and in such circumstances should re- main on duty unless excused. If for any cause the super- intendent's office cannot be reached by wire, the road- master should be notified, if possible, and all- trains in the vicinity of the storm should be provided with notices. Caution During Storms, Etc. When overtaken be- tween stations by severe storms or indications of high water which threaten danger, conductors and enginemen should proceed with the utmost caution, keeping the train under complete control, and proceeding at a speed which will permit it to be stopped any time to prevent accident. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 473 They ought always to examine bridges and culverts or other places liable to be damaged by high water, and if they find any indications of danger should, on arrival at the first telegraph station notify the agent or operator and report the fact by wire to the superintendent, asking if necessary for instructions and ought not to proceed until instructions have been received. Caution. Trains running upon or near the "time of a train" in the same direction, scheduled to carry pas- sengers should exercise extreme caution in approaching or passing through stations where such trains are sched- uled to stop, expecting to find persons crossing the tracks. TRAIN-MEN HANDLING BRAKES. When making up trains always begin at the rear end of train ; closing angle cocks and hanging the hose prop- erly in the dummies at rear end of last car ; coupling hose and opening all angle -cocks wide open and seeing that brakes are cut in until arriving at the engine ; after coupling hose between tender and train, always open the angle cocks on the tender first. In coupling to cars after cutting crossings, always open the angle cock nearest the engine first. Always give the engineer time to charge the train pipe and auxiliaries before signalling to test brakes ; al- ways give the signal to apply them from the front end of first car and signal to release from rear end of last car, examining on your return to the front end to see that all brakes are off. If any defect is discovered it must be remedied and the brakes tested again — the operation being repeated until it is ascertained that everything is right. The con- ductor and engineer must then be notified that the brakes are all right. This examination must be made every time any change is made in the make-up of the train. Read Rule for Testing Brakes. At points where there are- no inspectors, trainmen must carry out these instructions. No passenger train must be started out from an inspection point with the brakes upon any car out or in a defective condition without special orders from the proper officers. In freight trains, when hand brakes are used in conjunc- tion with the air brake, they must be applied upon those, cars next behind the air braked cars. 474 STATION AND TRAIN WORK 475 DETACHING ENGINE OR CARS. First close the cocks in the train pipes at the point of separation, and then part the couplings, always by hand. If the brakes have been applied do not close the cocks until the engineer has released the brakes upon the whole train. COUPLINGS FROZEN. If the couplings are found to be frozen together or covered with an accumulation of ice, the ice must first be removed and then the couplings thawed out by a torch to prevent injury to the gaskets. TRAIN BREAKING INTO TWO OR MORE PARTS. First close the cock in the train pipe at the rear of the first section and signal the engineer to release the brakes. Having coupled to the second section, observe the rule for making up trains — first being sure that the cock in the train pipe at the rear of the second section has been closed, if the train has broken into more than two sec- tions. When the engineer has released the brakes on the second section the same method must be employed with reference to the third section, and so on. When the train has been once more entirely united the brakes must be inspected on each car to see that each is released be- fore proceeding. CUTTING OUT THE' BRAKE ON A CAR. If, through any defect of the brake apparatus while on the road, it becomes necessary to cut out the brake upon any car, it may be done by closing the cock in the cross- over pipe near the center of the car where the quick 476 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS acting brake is used, or by turning the handle of the cock in the triple valve to a position midway between a horizon- tal and vertical where the plain automatic brake is used. When the brake has been thus cut out, the cock in the auxiliary reservoir must be opened and left open upon passenger cars, or held open until all the air has escaped from the reservoir upon freight cars. The brake must never be cut out upon any ear unless the apparatus is defective, and when it is necessary to cut out a brake the conductor must notify the engineer and also send in a report stating the reasons for so doing. CONDUCTOR'S VALVE. Should it become necessary to apply the brakes from the train, it may be done by opening the conductor's valve, placed in each passenger equipment car. The valve must be held open until the train comes to a full stop, and then must be closed again. This method of stopping the train must not be used ex- cept in case of absolute emergency. BURST HOSE. In the event of the bursting of a brake hose, it must fee replaced and the brakes tested before proceeding, pro- vided the train be in a safe place. If it is not, the train pipe cock immediately in front of the burst hose must be closed, and the engineer signaled to release. All the brakes to the rear of the burst hose must then be released by hand, and the train must then proceed to a safe place where the burst hose must be replaced and the brakes again connected and tested as in making up a train. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 477 BRAKES NOT IN USE. When the air brakes are not in use, either upon the road or in switching, the hose must be kept coupled be- tween the cars or properly hung up in the dummies. RETAINING VALVE. The retaining valve is used for keeping brakes partially set on trains on heavy down grades equal to good hand brakes, controlling the speed of the train while auxiliaries are being recharged, and for no other purpose. At top of grades designated by special rules, the train- men will turn the handles horizontal on as many valves as will be required to control the train, and at the foot of the grade will turn the handle downward again. This valve must be tested before leaving terminals at same time brakes are tested. TRAIN AIR SIGNAL. In making up trains, all couplings and car discharge valves on the cars must be examined to see if they are tight. Should the car discharge valve upon any car be found to be defective while on the road, it may be cut out of use upon that car by closing the cock in the branch pipe leading to the valve. The conductor must always be immediately notified when the signal has been cut out upon any car, and he must report the same for repairs. In using the signal, pull directly down upon the cord during one full second, for each intended blast of the signal whistle, and allow two seconds to elapse between the pulls. 478 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS REPORTING DEFECTS TO INSPECTORS. Any defects in either the air brake or air signal appar- atus discovered upon the road must be reported to the in- spector at the end of the run ; or, if the defect be a serious one in passenger service, it must be reported to the near- est inspector, and it must be remedied before the car is again placed in service. STARTING TRAINS. When ready to start, the starting signal must be given to the engineer by the air signal whistle. Trains equipped with the air signal must not be started by hand or lantern signal when air signal is in working order. The division time card or special rules of different com- panies specify the smallest proportion of freight cars, with the air brakes in good condition, which may be used in operating the train as an air brake train. THE AIR BRAKE ASSOCIATION'S QUESTIONS AND ANSWERS FOR TRAINMEN. Question. How should the conductor's valve be oper- ated when necessary ? Answer. It should be pulled wide open and held open until the train stops, and then before leaving it, the valve should be closed. Question. Why is it necessary to hold the conductor's valve open until the train is stopped ? Answer. Because if it is closed and the engineer has not placed the brake valve on lap position, the brakes will release. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 479 Question. What does this valve do when it is opened ? Answer. It simply makes an opening from the train pipe to the atmosphere, very much the same as would be done if an angle cock is opened, or a hose coupling parted. Question. Can brakes be released by the conductor's valve ? Answer. Xo ; it must be remembered that to release brakes it is necessary to either put air into the train pipe or take it out of the auxiliary reservoirs. The conductor's valve will not do either of these. BURSTED HOSE AND BROKEN TRAIN PIPES. Question. Should the brakes apply suddenly, without the aid of the engineer or train crew, what should be looked tor? Answer. Either a bursted hose or the train parted. Question. In the event of a bursted hose on a passen- ger train, and there was no extra hose in the supply box, what could be done ? Answer. Remove the hose from the rear end of the last car and use it. Question. Should the cross-over pipe be broken, is it necessary to shift this car to the rear of the train? Answer. No ; if the break is between the stop cock and the triple valve, the stop cock should be closed and the release valve opened. If the pipe is broken between the stop cock and the main train pipe, it may be plugged. Question. In passenger service, if the train pipe should burst or be broken, should the car be shifted to the rear of the train? Answer. Not necessarily ; a section of freight hose can be telescoped over the broken pipe and wrapped with 480 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS a cord. Again, air may be made to pass to the rear through the signal pipe on the disabled car by the use of combination signal and train pipe couplings, which will allow of the signal pipe of the disabled car being attached to the train pipe of its adjoining cars. It is the general practice, however, to switch such cars to the rear on ac- count of the lack of the material to make the changes mentioned. Question. When such a car is put on the rear end of a passenger train, what precautions should be taken ? Answer. The hose should be coupled between it and the car ahead of it, and the angle cock opened on the car ahead, but the angle cock on the disabled car closed. This keeps air pressure in the hose couplings, and if the train should part there, the brakes would apply on the head section. It is also good practice to have a man remain on the disabled car all the time if practicable. BREAK-IN-TWOS. Question. In case of a train parting between air- braked cars on the head end, the train being partially equipped, say 5 air-braked and 25 non-air-braked cars, what should the engineer do ? Answer. Close the engine throttle immediately and place the brake valve handle on lap position. Question. Why not try to pull away from the rear end of the train? Answer. He could not get away a safe distance, and a short distance would only increase the violence of run- ning together. By shutting off steam immediately the distance of separation would be short and the shock of running together would be proportionately slight, both sections of the train being in motion at the time. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 481 Question. Upon coupling up after parting a train of air-braked cars, should the rear brakes refuse to release in any number, would it be advisable to "bleed" them off? Answer. No ; by so doing we have no assurance that the engine is cut into the rear end of the train. They should in all cases be released by the engineer. Question. What should he do to release them? Answer. Place the brake valve handle on lap position and secure excess pressure. By throwing this into the train pipe quickly it should release them if they are all cut in. Question. Why is it not advisable to pump brakes off ? Answer. Because the train pipe pressure would be raised so slowly it might cause brakes to stick on the rear end of the train. Question. Is it necessary to make a test of the brakes after the train has been parted? Answer. . Yes ; in all cases, to ascertain if the train pipe is open throughout the train. USE OF HAND BRAKES. Question. In assisting the engineer with hand brakes, where the train is only partially equipped with air brakes, where should the hand brakes be set? Answer. Immediately behind the air-braked cars. Question. Why not near the rear of the train ? Answer. Because of the liability of breaking in two if the engineer releases when going slowly. Question. Do the hand brakes work in unison with the air brake on passenger equipment cars? Answer. Not on all cars, although it is now becoming the general practice to have them do so. Question. In setting off cars what should be done? 482 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS Answer. The stop cocks, or arigle cocks, should be closed first and the hose parted by hand and hung up properly, the car set on the side track, the air brake re- leased if applied, and the hand brake set before leaving it. Question. Why not set the hand brake before releas- ing the air brake? Answer. On some cars it would be set too tight and be liable to break the chain when the pressure on the piston of the brake cylinder was released; on others it would not be set at all. Question. Where cars are to be left alone for any length of time on a grade and have the air brakes ap- plied, what should be done ? Answer. The air brakes should be released and hand brakes set. BLEEDING OFF BRAKES. Question. In cutting out a brake, why is it necessary to always bleed the auxiliary reservoir? Answer. This is to insure that the brake will not creep on and give trouble, which it might do if leakage exists around the triple valve or branch pipe. Question. What is the proper way to release a brake with the release valve ? Answer. The release valve should be held open only until the air commences to escape from the triple valve. It should then be closed, as, if it is held open longer, it has a tendency to set the other brakes. Question. In picking up cars, if they are found cut out, is it an assurance that the brakes are in bad order on those cars? Answer. No : they should be cut in and tested, un- less it is plainly seen that they are in bad order. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 483 Question. When is it permissible to cut out cars ? Answer. Only when they are in such condition as to render it impossible to operate them. Question. Are small leaks sufficient cause for cutting out cars? Answer. No ; only when they are of such size that the air pump cannot supply them. Question. Which is preferable, a few cars cut in and working at full pressure, or all cars cut in and operated at a comparatively low pressure? Answer. All cars at a lower pressure. The train will brake smoother, and in a case of a break-in-two there would be less likelihood of damage. Question. If the train line leaks, would it be best to cut out cars ? Answer. No ; fix the leak and keep all cars cut in. Question. If there are numerous small leaks through- out the train, and combined they make sufficient leakage to prevent the pump from making the required amount of air pressure, which cars should be cut out first ? Answer. The worst leaks ; if that is not sufficient or all leaks about the ssme size, then the poorest brakes, not more than three or four consecutive cars being cut out, however. If possible, the cut out cars should be distrib- uted throughout the train. 484 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS RULES FOR GIVING FIRST AID TO THE IN- JURED. When an accident happens there is usually not much time to decide what is best to be done. Help, to be ef- fectual, must be prompt, and often delay implies farther injury or loss of life. It is well to fix in the mind a few general principles of treatment in the more common accidents. When the emergency arises these are recalled instinctively and form the basis of action. The means by which they are to be carried into effect follow naturally and the necessity is met. Shock. A person who has sustained a railroad or machinery accident, a* bad burn, or even a sudden fright, is liable to suffer from shock. He lies breathing feebly, the face pale, pinched and anxious, the pulse feeble and often ab- sent at the wrist, the skin is cold and there may be shiv- ering. In most cases reaction will take place in a few hours ; in others no reaction takes place, and the person dies. A great deal may be done to relieve a person suffering from shock. If there is severe bleeding it must be stopped, but no attempt to do more than this to the injury should be made until after attending to the shock. Place the patient in a horizontal position, the head slightly raised; give a teaspoonful of whiskey or other alcoholic liquor in a tablespoonful of hot water every ten minutes until five or six doses have been taken. Wring out flannels in hot water and lay them on the chest and abdomen, then cover the patient with a blanket to keep STATION AND TRAIN WORK 485 in the heat. To warm and stimulate the patient in every way is the object of the treatment. If the injury is to the head follow out the above treat- ment as regards warmth but do not give any alcoholic stimulant. Crushed Limbs. If a foot, or hand, or any other part is crushed, any displaced tissue is to be put back and the injured member made to assume as nearly as possible its original shape, by carefully molding it with the hands, without using much force or causing much pain. Then, unless bleeding is profuse, when cold cloths must be used, wrap the part in cloths dipped in warm w r ater, and cover the whole up warmly with cotton wool or a blanket. If a long bone is fractured in a crushed wound, a splint may be applied before moving the patient. In all such wounds be careful to watch for symptoms of shock, as they require as careful attention as the wound itself. Broken Limbs. A broken bone need not be set immediately. This knowledge saves much unnecessary anxiety when the doc- tor cannot be procured at once. The parts must be put in as comfortable a position as possible and most nearly corresponding to the natural one. It is necessary to give support above and below- the break. Handle the injured part very carefully not to force the rough ends of bone through the skin. Improvise splints of some kind — two strips of wood, a 486 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS. couple of stout book covers, or pieces of pasteboard. Place one on each side when it is a limb that is injured, and bind them in place with handkerchiefs. A long pil- low firmly tied will answer the purpose, or in case of in- jury to a leg it may he fastened to its fellow if nothing- better can be done, remembering to tie it above and below the injury. Broken bones are easily recognized by the grating of the ends on each other, by the unusual bending of the limb, and by the pain caused by motion at this point. A fracture is called compound when the end of the bone protrudes through the skin. Whenever such protrusion is seen the part should be cleansed and at once covered with adhesive plaster or a piece of linen saturated with white of an egg. All fractures should be attended to by a surgeon ; consequently the dressings suggested here are only temporary, and intended to protect the parts from further injury. In fracture of the arm above the elbow, bandage the upper arm to the side of the chest, and place the hand in a sling. In fracture of the arm below the elbow, bend the arm at the elbow at a right angle, place the thumb uppermost, and bandage the limb between two padded splints, reach- ing from elbow to ends of the fingers, one being placed on the back of the arm and the other on the front, and place the hand in a sling. In fracture of the leg below the knee, extend the leg beside the sound one, giving it the same position, place a pillow beneath from the knee down, fold the sides of the pillow over the leg, and secure it in that position by bandages. In fracture of the thigh bone, place the patient on the STATION AND TRAIN WORK 487 back in bed, relax the muscles of the leg by drawing the feet up toward the body sufficiently, bind splints to the outer arid inner side of the broken thigh, then bind both legs together, and turn patient on the side with the in- jured limb uppermost. In fracture of the knee-cap bind the whole limb to a splint on the back of it, being careful to place a suffi- ciently large pad beneath the bend of the knee. In fracture of the collar bone, place the patient on his back on a hard bed without any pillow. In fracture of the lower jaw, close the mouth and bandage so as to keep the two rows of teeth together. In fracture of the skull, lay the patient down and apply cold, wet cloths to the head. When the shoulder bone is broken place the arm on the injured side across the chest, the hand touching the opposite shoulder, and fasten it in place by passing a broad bandage around the body. In fracture of the ribs pin a towel around the body until the doctor comes. In other fractures, place the patient in the most com- fortable position possible, keep him quiet and apply cold water to prevent swelling. In a dislocation the bone is forced out of its socket at the joint. There is more or less deformity, and it is difficult to move the limb. The last point helps to distin- guish it from a fracture. Time is of importance, as the swelling which supervenes increases the difficulty of re- ducing it or returning the bone to its proper place. Hot applications may be made if the surgeon cannot be had immediately. A sprain occurs when a joint is twisted but not dislo- cated. The ligaments which hold the bones together are \ 488 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS stretched and sometimes torn. Immersing the part in very- hot water for a time, and then keeping it surrounded with hot water bags, usually gives relief. The joint should be firmly, but not too tightly, bandaged from the fingers to toes upward. After a time gentle rubbing is useful. Transportation of the Injured. Make a soft and even bed for the injured part, and if possible obtain a stretcher, a door, shutter, settee or some firm support ; lift steadily and don't keep step. Bruises. Lay over the bruise a cloth saturated with hot water, or with half water and half alcohol, or Pond's Extract, or any household remedy that contains alcohol. Wounds or Cuts. If the wound opens a vein the blood flows evenly and steadily and is dark red or purple. If an artery is di- vided the blood flows in jets or in an interrupted stream and is bright red. Owing to the fact that as a rule the arteries and veins run side by side, it generally happens that when an artery is divided a vein is also opened. The blood from the two vessels becoming mixed makes it im- possible to determine whether both vessels have been opened or only an artery or a vein. For this reason it is better to learn the methods of controlling bleeding that will answer for every case. Stop the hemorrhage by means of pressure, position, heat or cold, and, if necessary, styptics. STATION AND TRAIN WORK 48& When a large vein or an artery has been severed it is sometimes a difficult matter to stop the flow of blood. If the cut is on a limb tie a hard knot in a towel, place the knot inside the arm or leg as high as possible and twist the towel firmly round the limb. A stick can be thrust through it and used as a handle to twist by if nec- essary. This is called a tourniquet. This stops the circu- lation and cuts off the supply of blood. It should not be kept up more than one hour on the arm and rather longer on the leg. Ice, or very hot water applied with a sponge, or cloth, will check the bleeding when it comes from a number of small points. When possible the wounded part should be raised so the blood will flow away from it toward the heart. Binding a bunch of cobwebs or a handful of flour on the wound, or bathing it in strong vinegar is sometimes effectual. Bleeding stops from the blood coagulating or clotting. All our efforts should be directed toward helping it to ac- complish this by every available means. If the blood is bright and comes in jets, apply firm pressure upon the artery above the cut, nearer the heart. If bleeding is from the leg, the artery in the groin must be compressed very forcibly with three fingers,, aided by the weight of the body. If the blood comes in a steady stream, apply pressure just below the out. If ignorant of the location of vessels, press with the fingers or a wad of cloth directly into the wound. After the bleeding is controlled^ improvise a tourni- quet as above directed, excepting for the artery in the -±90 RULES FOR MOVEMENT. OF TRAINS For a slight cut let the blood flow for half a minute ; then dip in cold water, or apply ice. Draw the edges to- gether with sticking plaster, or unglazed paper. Paint collodion over the paper. Bandage if necessary, and keep the part quiet and not dependent for a few days. Burns and Scalds. The pain from slight burns is very great. An excellent application is a thick paste of common baking soda moist- ened with water, spread on a piece of linen or cotton, and bound on the part. This can be kept wet by squeezing water on it from a sponge or cloth until the smarting is soothed. A thick coating of starch can be used instead of the soda, or wheat flour if nothing better can be had, but neither should be applied if the skin is broken. In this case it is better to use vaseline, olite or linseed oil. The doctor w T ill apply some preparation containing carbolic acid. If the air can be effectually excluded from a burn the pain is, relieved. Blisters should be pricked and the fluid absorbed with a soft cloth before applying a dressing. If the clothing adheres to the skin the loose part should be cut away and the patches of material soaked off with oil or warm water. When the injury is extensive the sufferer will be pros- trated and may die from the shock. Heat should be ap- plied to the extremities and over the heart, and hot drinks given until the doctor comes. In burns from a strong acid the part should be covered with drv baking soda or lime, as the alkali will neutralize STATION AND TRAIN WORK 491 the acid. No water should be used, but a dressing of cos- moline or oil applied after the alkali has been brushed off. When the burn has been caused by an alkali an acid must be used. A person recovering from the effects of a burn requires very nourishing food. Electric Shock Accidents are liable to occur now that electric machinery is being introduced in many shops. In cases where a man has received a serious shock and life appears to be extinct, efforts similar to those employed in cases of drowning should be made to restore animation. Lay the patient on his back in the open air. Remove his neck-cloth and unfasten his shirt. Make a roll of clothes, or anything at hand, and place it under his shoul- ders so as to support the spine and allow the head to fall downwards and backwards. Open his mouth, and tak- ing hold of the front part of the tongue with your fingers — either bare or covered by a handkerchief — very slowly draw the tongue forward and as gently let it go back again 16 times to a minute. Be sure that the root of the tongue is acted upon and drawn forward. Continue this action until signs of re-animation are observable, which should be the case in from ten to twenty minutes. The motion thus imparted to the tongue should be regular and rythmical in both its tractions and relaxations. Another treatment is as follows : Kneel behind the patient and grasp the elbows and draw them over his head so as to bring them together above it, and hold them so for some two seconds. Then carry them down to the sides and front of the chest, firmly compressing it. Af- ter two seconds repeat the action and continue it at the 492 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS rate of 16 times per minute. This action expands the chest walls, causes air to rush into the lungs and finally expels it. The action must be regular and persisted in until respiration has become normal. It is possible that this may not be assured in less than an hour. If an as- sistant is at hand both systems may be employed, one man working the arms, the other the tongue, and both operating in unison. APPENDICES CLEARANCE CARDS AND OTHER BLANKS 493 RECEIPT GIVEN TO PASSENGERS FOR CASH FARES PAID TO CONDUCTORS g i 00 ofe t*(0 *** So £* ^w <5 z5 S 6, S «5 s NOTE 120 Passengers who pay fare on the train instead of purchasing tickets will receive this receipt from Conductors, which is good for TWENTY-FIVE CENTS, and will be re- deemed at any ticket office of the Company. Gen'lTkt. Agent. -NCiCO •* *0 O t* 00 O O »-«COOO * w RECORD TO BE DETACHED BY THE CONDUCTOR AND SENT TO THE TICKET AUDITOR- RECORD OF CASH FARE COLLECTED BY CONDUCTOR. Train No.. Date From To -189 Amount CO o -Conductor, RECORD TO BE RETAINED BY THE CONDUCTOR* NoTB.-*When a passenger pays fare on a train he is charged say twenty five cents extra. The total amount paid is entered on tbe above receipt J>y the conductor (by cancellation of the proper amount.) and is then given to the passenger. Upon lis presentation at any office of the company, the agent refunds tbe amount and remits this receipt to headquarters in lieu of cash. : ' . - m '. w. B.—There are several other forms used i>y conductors to giving receipts. • 494 STATION AND TRAIN WORK 495 RETURN OP CASH FARES COLLECTED. punch I hereby certify that the. following is a true statement of all money collected by me on the trips designated hereon, and that the rates, extensions and footings as stated are correct. .Conductor. STATEMENT OF AMOUNT COLLECTED. From To No. Fares. Rate. Amount. Remarks. Statement of Receipts Issued For Fares Collected. CoiameiTg No. Closing No. tLowett No. on hiad.) No. issuea Amount Collected Nocth or West, al, Dollars. Cents. Amount Collected South or East, To! Train run between No. Going North or West No Going South or East and- -189 — . -189— Note.— If no fares are collected, a blank form muut be returned*. _e2cc^pjjn_tbe_caje_gl_jreight .con doctors* ^A 496 J 6 c o .a 8 I, H « a CO 6 as •J m V> o RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS i m ai <* 4' la" i O i i 1 & a . 11 4 1 1 « v 5 § fee P 11 t s ** 5 &o 5 - *J i l 1* Q 1 *i 6 2 o 88 8 S2 u 5 s i Balan Differ ment 111' K X £* s « tt 5Q 2 * ft •*> .«* . • i 8 ff S a < «ft> L~* 8 fl« 5 § e a 1* §£ - - * - *E *» • CO 3"* o * < ice of last rence to n t received, 0» ii *3 : : z z i Balai Diffe men *E S3 tt 1. il STATION AND TRAIN WORK 497 Standard Train Order Blank for 19. Order, FORM 19 FORM 19 em COMPANY. TRAIN ORDER No 1* March 2T /£ 0* To At. QWTiALsj Qpr.; .. IJH..AM Conductor and Enginoman must each have a copy of this order. Made com P i«u timeout* * Bi M k 0pr. 498 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS Standard Train Order Blank for 31 Order. FORM 31 FORM 31 <»*m - — .-.,-. COMPANY. TRAIN ORDER No.....*!....... March VI 19 o* To At _ „ }$AM ■■—•'•■'" ■ • Conductor and Engineman must each have a copy of this order. Repeated at 220 a M, Conductor Engineman Train 45 Made Time Opr. Jones Brown CoctidI' 16 2 20a.m. Black (Omit this column where Engineman is not required to sign.) STATION AND TRAIN WORK 499 Form 620. CHICAGO, ST. PAUL, MINNEAPOLIS & OMAHA R'Y CO, CROSS-OVER PERMIT. Block Station 190 To Conductor and Engineman Train No I have complied with the Rules. You may use bound track at ; by protecting your train as provided in the Gen* eral Rules. Signalman. This permit does not relieve the train crew from any respon- sibility in connection with the Time-Table or Rules and Regu- lations. CHICAGO, ST. PAUL, MINNEAPOLIS & OMAHA R'Y CO. TRAIN ORDER NO. 19 .... To / At Station. Nou. 27, 1902. INITIALS Qpr. 1.45 500 KULlis FOR MOVEMENT 01" TRAINS 12 Chief Train Dlpatcher Repeated at .?-.30_A M. Conductor Train Made Time Otspr. Opr. 13 JONES 45 O.K. 2.20 AM ABC BLACK 13 13 13 13 13 13 Conductor and Engine man must each have a copy of thisorder. Train ahead left at ia : 30 AM, STATION AND TRAIN WORK 501 Form 547. CHICA60, ST. PAUL, MINNEAPOLIS & OMAHA R'Y CO. CLEARANCE. There are NO ORDERS at Station for Train No. due at said station at M^ 190 Stop signal is displayed for :._. Last train ahead, No left here at M* Remarks This does not interfere with or countermand nn.v orders you ihhv hate received. Time issued M. Signed Operator, Note. — Should any train have orders not to pass any station "without orders," the reception of this blank does not release it, but in such cases regular orders must be obtained. In case "stop signal" is not displayed, operators will write "not displayed" after the words "Stop signal is displayed for " Operators are required to fill in blank in duplicate for trains for which they have no orders. Fill in exact time clear- ance is given. Conductor must see that the number of his train is entered u* above form corr'cctlv. 502 RULES FOR MOVEMENT OF TRAINS IX o * (8 01 K 0) o ~< k» O 53 o Ph > CO k> k. o a 1 u M o p 1 > 1 i CO E 3 O G *3 kt kt < c any orders John Jones see that th < t B C 1 1 id *<0 k_ 4-^ c CO E k. •a c a a o n PS o 15 * k. 3 O CO c 3 o o > fr < i k. -* £ S M o k. o JZ 2 2 «< £ fi £ C4 o I k. CD "S JZ < C o 3 8 B CO E 0) c 1 k. o a a E 4) a • h c a fi -»- o c o c UJ o 3 C O W «2 O c cO c CD . . — . o k. > ( > # 1 > Inst. No. i on Xo. i E. to Xo. 2 W., Ground on No. I W. Inst. No. 2 on N T o. 2 E. to Ground. TELEGRAPHY 37 Ground. * Inst. No. 1 £ lust. No. 2 * a o o o o .o. -o. -o. No. i W. to No. 2 E., Xo. i E. to Xo. 2 W. Insts. on both circuits. Ground. £ Inst. No. 1 £ Inst. No. 2 a 1 > ( l < ,1 > c c a > i ) < > > ( 4 i .0 -o -o -o -o o Spare O Both Insts. on Line No. I. No. 2 open at the bottom. 3» TELEGRAPHY -1-. n CD Inst. No. 1 w CZD Inst. No. 2 — o o o o u o o n :;; • Inst. No. i on Line No. 2, Ground on No. 2 E. Inst. No. 2 on Line No. I. Study the preceding diagrams carefully and thoroughly understand them and you will have no trouble with the ordinary station board. GENERAL INSTRUCTIONS FOR CIRCUIT. Contention for circuit is strictly forbidden by all rail- way and telegraph companies. Each office has a call consisting of not more than two letters, and in calling an office, call continually and sign your own office call after every third call. In answer- ing your office call, say I I and your office call. Ex- ample of CH calling BN: BN BN BN CH BN BN BN CH. Example of BN answering call: I I BN. When asked to sign always give your office call. TELEGRAPHY 39 Each operator will have a personal sign which may consist of one or two letters. Whenever you are asked "wo" always give your PERSONAL SIGN. Upon hearing the call "OS" sent continually over the wire you will answer giving your office call ; it will usually be a message addressed to all Agents, all Operators or some particular class of employees. If you are receiving at the wire and your instru- ment fails to work properly you should ask the send- ing operator to "dot" which he will continue to do until you get adjusted, when you will break in and say ''OK" and give the last word received. If your instrument which is connected with a wire re- mains quiet for any great length of time, never open your key without first turning your relay adjusting spring high enough to break the local circuit in order to make sure no one else is working your line. If the circuit is found open apply the ground wire to ascertain in which direction from your office the trouble lies, if after careful adjustment no circuit be found, cut in the instrument on another line which is known to be working and if it also opens that line it would indicate the trouble was in your instrument and it should not be cut in on any line until repaired. If it be found necessary when working on a wire to leave the circuit open for a moment, it is necessary that you make explanation of the matter ; if to answer the telephone, say, "ex me fone," if to deliver orders say "ex me trn." The circuit should never be left open longer than a minute in cases of this kind. If you are busy on another wire, or otherwise, and for any reason you cannot answer a call which is given you, you should, if possible, take the time to answer the office 4 o TELEGRAPHY by giving the signal "25" and your office call; it is necessary that you first find out what office is calling you, in order that when you get time you may call it and find out what was wanted, using the signal "5" and your office call. Whenever you are repeating a message or a train- order and you are told by the sender that a word is an error, you should first open your key, then change your copy and repeat the copy as corrected. If for any reason when you have copied a message you wish to read it over and count the check before giving the OK, you should first open your key and keep it open until you are satisfied it is correct so no one will think you are through and take the circuit from you. Whenever you are receiving a message and are in- terrupted by someone breaking in on you who is inclined to be meddlesome or is not adjusted, take the circuit and say "tts nt me" or "tts nt hr ga," adding the last word received, if the trouble continues the sender should make the signal "8" until he believes the person in- terrupting is adjusted or knows that he is "breaking'" someone. If you are in doubt whether the receiving operator is copying what is being sent him, at the conclusion of some sentence say, "bk u tr?" or "u tr?" If he is receiving what you are sending he will answer by say- ing "I" and sometimes adding his office call. In taking the circuit from others you should do so as far as possible between their messages; this will avoid much confusion and error. Offices using the wire when interrupted have the next right to the circuit k TELEGRAPHY 41 WIRE SIGNALS USED IN TAKING THE CIRCUIT FROM OTHERS. The word "wire" is used by the wire chief or by operators when given permission by the wire chief or lineman for locating wire trouble, and has preference over all other business on any circuit. The signal "gnr '' and a stx" may be used for speculative messages. The signal "corn" may be used to make a correction in any message which has already been sent out. The signal "govt" may be used for sending government messages which pertain strictly to the official business of the government. The signal "cable" will be used for send- ing messages. The last five signals have preference over all other business on any circuit exclusive or train- orders. NUMERAL WIRE SIGNALS. There are . a few simple sentences which are used so often that figures have been substituted for them and they are used to abbreviate and save time. Some impart special information while others serve to furn- ish an answer. There is a difference to some extent in their meaning on different lines, but the following are more or less in common use. Wait a minute. Very important. Train reports. . Where shall I go ahead ? * Have you any business for me? Are you ready for business? 42 TELEGRAPHY 8. Close your key; you are breaking. 9. To clear the line for orders and for operators to ask for orders. 12. Do you understand? 13. I ? or we, understand. 18. What is the trouble? 19. Train-order. 23. Accident or death message. 25. Busy on another wire. 29. Train dispatcher. Train orders. 30. The end. 31 : Train order. ^^. Answer paid for. 34. Message for all offices. 55. Important business. 73. Accept my compliments. 92. Deliver quick. 134. Who is at the key? ABBREVIATIONS. Abbreviations are used chiefly for wire conversation and are generally made by leaving out the vowels. Some are entirely arbitrary wmile others are spelled simply by sound. One should not use too many of the arbi- trary ones together. The following list will be found quite complete, the student should commit them to memory and practice them upon the wire as soon as possible as they are very important and no good j operator can afford to be without them. The conversa- tion on railroads especially is nearly all abbreviated. TELEGRAPHY 43 abandoned, abnded about, abt abbreviations, abbn acknowledge, "x" (used train orders only.) account, acct action, actn address, ads afternoon, P. M. agent, agt all right, art always, alwas amount, amt and others, "et al" annulled, annld. another, ahr (or) anr A. answer, ans any, ay anything, aytng (or) 5 in April, Apl (or) Apr are, r arrive (or) arrived, "a" ascertain, ascrtn assist (or) assistant, asst Assistant General Freight Agent, A G F A Assistant General Passen- ger Agent, A G P A attention, attn ' attorney, atty August, Aug Avenue, ave __B. "B" Block (used in system only) back, bk baggage, bage barrel, brl (or) bbl battery, baty be, b become (or) became, been, bn before, b4 better, btr between, betwn bill-lading, "BL" black, blk block blanks, blnx block, blk board, bd body, bdy book, bk (or) buk bought, bot boulevard, blvd becm bound, bnd break, brk brakeman, brkmn building, bldg bushel, bu business, biz but, bt by, bi 44 TELEGRAPHY C. can, en cancel former order, C F O cannot, cnt cashier, cashr cent, ct charge, ckg check, ck chief, chf circuit, ckt clear, clr coal and water, C & \Y collect, coll collect on deliver}', C Q D combination, combn come (or) came, cm coming', cmg commercial, coml Commercial News Depart- ment, CND commission, comsn company, co complete, comp (or) "cm" compliments, 7$ conductor, condr conductor and engineer, C &E connection, conctn copy, cy correct, (.). K. correction, "corn" (used only as a wire signal). cost, insurance and freight, - "c if" could, eld creditor, cr crossing, xng D. day, da day press rate, d p r dead head, D H debtor, dr December, Dec decrease, dec democrat, dem deliver, 92 delivery, dely delivery charges guaran- teed, dely chgs gtd difference, dif dinner, dinr disregard former service, D F S district, dist division, div (or) divn don't, dnt TELEGRAPHY 45 depart (or) departed, ""d ,! Dispatcher, despr destroy, bust did, dd double deck, DD doubt, dbt down, dwn dozen, doz draft, dft duplicate, dup E. east, e election, electn empty, em (or) mt engine, eng engineer, engr enough, enuf errors excepted, ee errors and omissions ex- cepted, "e & o e" every, evy excursion, excn excuse, ex express, ex extra, exa (or) xtra favor,, fvr February, Feb few, fu for, r foreign, forgn forward, fwd free on board, F O B freight, frt from, fm (or) fr foreman, 4 man G. Agent, General Baggage G B A General Freight Agent, G F A General Passenger Agent, G P A get, gt give better address, G B A give some address, G S A go ahead, G A go ahead arrival, G A A go ahead departure, GAD 46 TELEGRAPHY going, gg got, gt gone, gn government, govt good, gd grain, grn good afternoon, P M great, grt good evening, G E ground, gnd good morning, G M ground wire, g w good night, G N guaranteed, gtd gossip, "guff" guess, gs EL half, hf has, hs have, hv hear, (or) here, hr high, hi how, hw hogshead, H H D how is, hws . hundred, hnd hundred weight, cwt immediately, immy instrument, instmnt important, impt (or) 55 invoice, inv increase, inc January, Jan junction, jet (or) junc. J. junior, jr K. knew, nu know, no knows, nos TELEGRAPHY L. 47 last month, ult laugh, ha ha learn, lrn leave, lv letter, ltr light, lite loads, Ids local, loc look, luk loop, lup low, lo limited, ltd M. made, md main, mn majority, maj make, mk manager, mgr manifold, mfld manifest, mfst manufacturer, mfr manufacturing, mfg many, mny March. Mar marked, mkd market, mkt matter, mtr May, Ma merchandise, mdse message, msg messenger, msgr might, mite mile, mi (mill) typewriter million, mln (or) rriyn minute, min mistake, msk (or) bull mistaken, mskn Misses, Mrs Mister, Mr months, mos more, mo (or) mr morning, mng (or) A M much, mch namely, viz near, nr necessary, necy N. never, nvr new, nu next month, prox 48 TELEGRAPHY night, nite — (red) night press rate, n p r none between, n b north, n not, nt nothing, ritg November, Nov now, nw no more, nm no such number, N S N number, no O. obedient, obt opening, opg obtain, obtn operator, opr o'clock, k opinion, opn October, Oct order, ord of, o O S, All offices take notice office, ofs other, otr one hundred, I hnd our, r one thousand, i tnd "out" (of no account) O K, correct out, ot on time, ot owners risk, "O R" P. package, pkg paid, pd pair, pr passenger, pasgr pay, pa payment, payt people, peo pecks, pks pink, (rush) pint, pt please, pis pounds, lb Post Office, P O precinct, prct preferred, pfd present month, inst president, prest (or) pt principal, prin prohibition, pro quick, qk TELEGRAPHY quotation, qtn (or) tick 49 R. railroad, R R railway, Ry ready, rdy rebate, reb receipts, rects received, reed receiving, recg red, (nite) refrigerator, refr release, "rel" relay, rela relief, rj repeat, rept report, rept report delivery charges, rept dely chgs republican, repn right, rite roast, (a great number) round, rnd rush, (pink) said, sd same, sm say, sa second, sec section, seen see, c see former order S F O see former service, S F S seen, en see your service, SYS single deck, S D sir, sr slow, slo some how, smhw some one, sm I something, smtng somewhat, smwt somewhere, smwr soon, sun south, s speak, spk special, spl special delivery guaran- teed, spl dely gtd sending, sendg September, Sept 5o TELEGRAPHY service, svc several, svl should, shld siding, sdg sight, site, sign, sine signature, sig signed, sined (or) sgd station, stn (or) sta stay, sta stock, stx (or) stk stop for breakfast, sfb stop for dinner, sfd stop for night, sfn stop for tea, sft straight, strate street, st superintendent, supt supper, supr suppose, spose switch, sw system, sys take, tk talk, tlk tariff, tf telegraph, tel telephone, fone (or) phone thanks, tnx that, tt that is, tts (or) "i. e." the, t their, tr them, em then, tn there, tr they, ty thing, tng think, tnk this, ts this morning, tsmng (or) ts A M though, tho thought, thot thousand, tnd through, thru (or) tru tierce, tc to-day, toda together, togtr tomorrow, tomw tonight, tonite took, tuk tough, tuf track, trk train, trn transfer, tfr Traveling Passenger Agt, TPA trouble, tbl try, tri typewriter, (mill) TELEGRAPHY U. 5* unchanged, unchgd undelivered, undeld versus, vs was, ws water, wtr way, wa way bill, "W B" weather, wtr west, w wharf, whf what, wt (or) ? when, wn where, wr while, wile understand, 13 V. very, vy W. why, wi who, wo will, wi with, wi word, wd (or) w worked, wkd would, wld write, rite wrote, rote wrong, wng X. *X" acknowledge (used in train orders only.) yard, yd yet, et yards, yds you, u yes, es young, unj year, yr your, ur years, yrs yesterday, estrda yes sir, esr GENERAL RULES AND INSTRUCTIONS FOR TELEGRAPH EMPLOYES. The telegraph department is under the management of the Superintendent of Telegraph, who will have charge of the telegraph service and other electrical business of the company, including construction and maintenance. The appointment of telegraph operators will be made by the Chief Train Dispatcher, of each division, in his capac- ity of chief operator. Such appointment must be ap- proved by the Division Superintendent. The Superintendent of Telegraph will report to and re- ceive his instructions from, the General Superintendent. CHIEF OPERATOR. Chief dispatchers acting as chief operators will be intrusted with the ordinary working of the line, testing and changing of circuits, and the direction of operators and repairers in the discharge of their duties. They will report to trie Superintendent of Telegraph daily, the state of the weather and the condition of the circuits under their charge, the nature and location of interruptions to the circuits that have existed, or do exist, and what meas- ures have been taken for repairs. They will also report when lines previously reported as in trouble are repaired. Chief Operators will report any neglect on the part of operators or repairers that may come under their notice, and will at all times, manifest an interest in the successful operation of the wires, and will co-operate 52 TELEGRAPHY 53 with the Superintendent of Telegraph in securing good working lines. The night train dispatchers will have charge of the wires on their respective divisions between the hours of 7:00 P. M. and 7:00 A. M., and will assume the duties of the chief operator during that time. OPERATORS. Telegraph operators report to and receive instructions pertaining to the business of the railway from the di- vision superintendent or train master, and pertaining to the business of the Telegraph Department from the superintendent of telegraph, and will obey the instruc- tions of the chief train dispatcher of the division. They are required to be constantly on duty during the hours assigned to them, and must not leave their of- fices without permission' from the Train Dispatcher on duty. Office hours for operators at stations where there are no night offices are from 7:00 A. M. until relieved by the train dispatcher on duty. Office hours for opera- tors at stations where there are night offices, day operator, from 7:00 A. M. until 7:00 P. M. Opera- tors at such stations are required to come on duty promptly at the regular hour, and remain on duty until relieved by their colleague, or excused by the train dis- patcher. At offices where more than one day or night operator are employed, there must be one person on duty at all hours. Day operators must keep the loca- tion of their residence posted up inside bill boxes, at stations where there are no night offices, so that train- men mav know where thev are to be found. 54 TELEGRAPHY Operators must not go beyond hearing of their call, nor leave the office without first notifying the train dispatcher and obtaining his permission. Operators will assist and obey the instructions of the station agent, when it does not interfere with their du- ties as operators. There must be no delay in obtaining answers to telegrams. If a reply cannot be had in reasonable time, the sending office must be promptly notified of the reason. It will be the duty of the agent and operators to see that the train-order signals are kept in good working order and ready for use at all times, and when neces- sary oil them, using kerosene oil to make them work freely. Should the signal become disabled and out of order, and repairs needed, prompt notice must be sent to the train dispatcher by wire, giving cause of trouble, and stating what material is required for repairs. Operators are expected to make suggestions and give such information from time to time, as is calculated to improve the service. Should anything occur which does, or is likely to impair the service in any way, it must be reported at once to the Superintendent of Telegraph. Operators will familiarize themselves with the Western Union Book of Rules and obey them. Operators are required to devote themselves exclu- sively to the service of the company during business hours ; those having other duties to perform in the freight department will not allow such duties to prevent proper attention being given to the telegraph. At offices where there is but one day and night operator, the day operator acts as agent or manager, and is held re- sponsible for all the cash taken in. TELEGRAPHY 55 Operators are required to be in their offices when trains are due or at their stations and not out on the platform unless the service requires their pres- ence there; they will keep a register of all trains pass- ing their station and the reports from such stations as the train dispatcher may require and report the same promptly to the dispatcher. They must give public notice upon the bulletin board of the time traftis carrying passengers are clue, and whether on time or how much late. All instruments necessary for the use of the tele- graph department at each office, will be furnished by the Company, which together with the office furniture and fixtures must be kept clean and In good order. No private instruments will be allowed upon the wires, and no private lines must be connected with any office without the permission of the Superintendent of Tele- graph. Always try to be accommodating, treating all persons with respect, with whom you come in contact. Do not get out of patience if traveling men make what might seem unreasonable requests, or ask a small favor. Be ready at all times to aid feeble or old persons on and off trams, and make yourself of worth to the Com- pany and your services will be rewarded. Remember a good word spoken of you from the traveling public, will soon reach the officials and greatly figure in your chances for promotion. Do not depend upon any one to do your work for you; or meddle with other employees' business unless your help be requested. In case of accident, no account or message respecting it, other than regular tariff business, must be sent un- 56 TELEGRAPHY less to an officer of the Company, signed by an agent, conductor or other authorized person, nor must it be made the subject of conversation or remark over the Avire or otherwise. Particulars for the public, or for publication will be furnished only by an officer of the Company, or upon his authority. Contention for circuit will not be permitted. Any operator who follows this practice will be promptly dis- missed. In case of doubt, or when unable to "raise" an office within a reasonable length of time, operators must promptly call upon the Chief Operator or Super- intendent of Telegraph for assistance. Operators must make themselves familiar with their switch-board and cut-outs, so they can connect wires as directed by the testing operator. Always be sure that the testing operator has finished his directions before com- mencing to connect wires, or to remove ground wire. When directed to cross-connect, open, close or ground a wire, follow directions carefully. When they have been carried out say "now'' and always keep an instrument on the wire on which instructions are being given, until communication is restored. Never connect wires vice versa unless directed to do so. Operators must invari- ably sign their office call when using the line for any purpose whatever. They will block all trains the required time apart, as provided in the rules, unless otherwise directed, and must keep a full set of signals in good order, and always ready for immediate use, and use them strictly in accordance with the rules and observe the rear of trains and report at once to the superintendent or train master if markers or red lights are not displayed as provided by the rules. When fixed signals become soiled or faded, operators TELEGRAPHY 57 will report their condition to the superintendent or train master. Operators using positive block must not give a train that is blocked a clearance card, unless they are posi- tively sure that the train can proceed. The day operator will be held responsible for the work- ing condition of the train order signal. Operators will report the state of the weather in cases of rain, snow, fog or severe storm in their vicinity, day or night, to the train. dispatcher. Where two or more operators are employed, one must always be on duty. Operators going off duty must no- tify relieving operators of any undelivered orders, re- lieving operators receipting for them on the face of orders ; also notifying relieving operator of any unfin- ished business. Operators must not leave their offices before the arri- val of an expected train that is due, without permission of the train dispatcher. They must not leave their office while a train is at the station, unless required by business connected with the train. When they are given leave of absence, they must be- fore leaving, see that their substitutes are thoroughly acquainted with the duties of the office, the management of the switch-board, instruments, batteries, etc. Before opening a key, they must adjust the relay, using special care in wet weather, to make sure that the cir- cuit is not in use. They must in transmitting, write firmly, space care- fully and take every precaution to guard against mis- takes. v They must use good judgment in working with inex- 58 TELEGRAPHY perienced operators, and must regulate their speed of transmission to suit the capacity of the receiving oper- ator, to avoid breaking, or possibility of error, and the consequent loss of time. They must not receive messages to be transmitted free, unless such message pertain to the business of the com- pany, and are signed by an officer, agent, or employe, ex- cept answers to such messengers. They must promptly deliver messages received, con- sider all messages confidential, and not permit them to be read by any person except those to whom they are addressed, nor make their contents the subject of conver- sation or remark. All messages not relating to the business of the com- pany must be paid for, unless otherwise ordered by the proper authority. They must record in the proper place upon the face of each message received and sent, the time, date, month and year, and the initials of the operator who received and sent it. No alterations, additions or erasures will be allowed on original messages after transmission, and they will be retained in the files, unless they are called for by the Superintendent or general officer or by Superintendent of Telegraph, If originals are called for, a copy must be left in the files, with a memorandum attached showing the disposition of the original. Railroad messages, after being transmitted, must be carefully filed daily, and pre- served for one year, unless otherwise directed. All telegrams received for delivery to an officer of the company, who may be en route upon the road, must be enclosed in a proper envelope and sealed, and addressed to him before delivery. TELEGRAPHY 59 Operators should require persons leaving messages at their offices for transmission, to read them aloud before they are accepted. They must exhibit a courteous disposition at all times, in and about their offices, and over the wire, avoiding unnecessary conversation ; be polite to all and prompt in furnishing proper information to those entitled to it. The use of profane, obscene or ungentlemanly language over the wires, or in and about the company's offices, is positively prohibited. Students must not be allowed to enter or practice in an office without first obtaining permission from the Super- intendent of Telegraph. The attention of students must be called to all rules of the company, and particularly to those relating to the privacy of telegrams. The regular operators will be held responsible for any interruptions that may occur to the line, or delay to busi- ness, caused by incompetent or unauthorized persons using- the instruments. THE DOUBLE ORDER SYSTEM. In the double order system, the dispatcher calls up all offices where orders can soonest be delivered to the train concerned, and sends the order to each at one transmis- sion ; the order being worded so that it serves for both trains. This system is considered the most reliable and less liable to error. Xote — Among the points in its favor might be stated that the mental strain upon the dispatcher arising in the single order system where he has to keep several different orders in his mind at the same time, lest he gives different meeting points to different trains, thereby causing 60 TELEGRAPHY wrecks, is entirely absent in the double order system. In preparing this order the dispatcher cannot possibly give different meeting points, as there is but one message to each train and being sent to both at one sending, each must get the same as the other. Thus we have several addresses; one for each train concerned which are transmitted in their respective order. GENERAL INSTRUCTIONS IN TRAIN ORDER WIRE WORK. Trains are addressed in train orders as follows: "Let HB" be the office call for Hannibal. In addressing an order to 2nd. Xo. 62 at Hannibal, the following form is used: "To HB C & E 2nd No. 62." For different trains at different stations, substitution is made for the different station office calls in the place of "HB" and the different trains in the place of "2nd. No. 62." Train orders are numbered in transmitting in succes- sion each day, No. 1 commencing at midnight. ORDER OF TRANSMISSION. Order No Trains addressed to at each station. Period. Body. Signature. Example of a simple train order as sent on the wire. Letters in the parenthesis () are sent, but not copied by the receiving operator. TELEGRAPHY 61 (31 copy 3) Order No. 1. (to) HB C & E No 55 (to) I C & E No 6 ( .) No 55 Eng 286 and No 6 Eng 13 will meet at Callao instead of Shelbina. (sig) F. W. H. ACKNOWLEDGMENT OF RECEIPT OF TRAIN ORDERS. When it is desirable to have the train of inferior right receive its orders and act upon them before the order is completed and delivered to the train of superior right, it is necessary for the dispatcher to receive an acknpwledg- ment (from the operator who has the orders for the train of superior rights) that he will hold the superior train until they get the order before he can allow the train of inferior right to proceed. Example : No 65 No 66 A. B. C. Let us suppose that No. 65, the inferior train, is now waiting at station "A" and that No. 66, the superior train has not yet arrived at station "C," and they are to meet at station "B." Now if the dispatcher is sure that No. 65, the inferior train, will get a copy of the order, he can allow operator at station "A" to repeat and complete his order first and No. 65 could leave station "A" and pro- ceed to the meeting point, which in case No. 65 was a heavy train, would greatly lessen the cause of delaying No. 66 at the meeting point. Thus for acknowledging receipt of a train order and assuring the dispatcher, the train addressed will be held until a copy is delivered the form of X ing is used as an abbreviated form. 62 TELEGRAPHY ORDER OF "x ING." Form and order No Your office call. Train addressed at your station. The letter "X." Your personal sign. Example of "Chillicothe" or "Hi" office X ihg" Order No. i. "31 No i HI C & E No. 6 X Go." ORDER OF REPEATING. Form and order No Your office call. Train addressed at your station. The letter "X." Your personal sign. Period. Body of the order. Conductor's signature and his train number. Example of "Hannibal" or "HB" office repeating Order No. I. "31 No 1 HB C & E No 55 X SN ( .) No 55 Eng 286 and No 6 Eng 13 will meet at Callao instead of Shelbina." Sig. Johnson condr trn No 55. HOW TO COPY ORDERS OX THE FORMS. Let us next make a careful study of the two following forms which are adopted as the standard for copying train orders. On the first "form 31," let us suppose that TELEGRAPHY 63 Hannibal office is going to copy and using "HB" for his office call, "SN," for his personal sign. On the second "form 19/' suppose that Chillicothe is going to copy and use "HL" for his office call, "Go" for his personal sign. The dispatcher after calling "HB" and receiving his re- ply, would say, "31 copy 3/' meaning make three copies on form 31 ;" then after raising "HI" would say, "19 copy 3," meaning "make 3 copies on form 19." Then he would start out with Order No , stating the number which we will suppose was 10; both operators would then put the number 10 on the blank space opposite the Order No. ....... The dispatcher would then address "HB" and give him his train address as follows : To HB C & E Exa 427 West. The operator at "HB" would then write after the word To The train ad- dress, C & E Exa 427 West and his station name "Han- nibal" after the word At The dispatcher would then address "HI" and say, "To HI C & E 2nd No 46," and make a period, indicating that he was ready to begin the body of the order. Operator at "HI" would fill in the form the same as "HB," only it would read "To C. & E. 2nd No 46 at Chillicothe/' Commencing with the period, the dispatcher would send the body as follows : "Exa 427 West has right of track against 2nd No 46 Eng 928 Hannibal to C^llao." Sig F. W. H. Both operators would copy the body as sent in the space provided ; at the conclusion of the dispatcher's ini- tials "F. W. H.," the dispatcher would address "HB" as follows : "To HBX." Operator at "HEB" would then take the wire and say, "31 No 10 HB C & C Exa 427 West X SN." The dispatcher would then give him OK and the time as follows: "31 No 10 OK 751 PM F. W. H." Operator at "HB" would then write his initials and the 64 TELEGRAPHY time after the letter X Opr M. The dispatcher after giving him OK, would address "HI" as follows: "To HI ga," Operator at "HI" would take the circuit and say, "19 No 10 HI C&E2nd No 46 X GO," make a period and repeat the body, giving his own name as signature. The dispatcher w r ould then give him complete and the time as follows: "19 No 10 OK & complete 755 P M F. W. H." "To KB ga.". Operator at "HI" would write the word complete after the word Made . . . , and the time 7:55 PM after the word Time and his name Gregory, before the word Opr., and also fill in the spaces X Opr M 1 ., with his initials and the time. Operator at 1 IV ' would then give the circuit as follows : "31 No 10," make a period and repeat the body giving the conductor's name and signature. The dispatcher would them give him complete as follows: "31 No 10 complete 758 PM. F. W. H." Operator at "HB" would write the word Complete in the column headed "Made" arid the time in the column headed "Time" and his name in the column headed "Operator." Each operator will fill in the blank places 190. . . . , without instructions from the dispatcher. It must be remembered that No. 31 order cannot be completed until the signature of the conductor, or person addressed is signed to the order, and the same has been transmitted to the dispatcher. Upon repeating back an order, if you have not yet the conductor's signature to send to the dispatcher, you will only receive the OK response and the time, which time goes in the space provided — Repeated. . . . : M. After you have received the conductor's signature to an order, which you have al- ready repeated, you must then get the wire and repeat TELEGRAPHY 6* MISSOURI CENTRAL ROUTE 19 TRAIN ORDER No.^ Chicago, 111.. Aug 8th. 1 9Q 4 19 To C & E 2nd No 4fi ' At Chillicothe x_ GO _Opr. ^_Mi Exa 427 West has right of track against 2nd No 46 Eng 928 Hannibal to Callao. F. W. H. CONDUCTOR AND ENGINEMAN MUST BOTH HAVE A COPY OF THIS ORDER. MnAo Complete *,'m* 7:S5 P M Gregory. .Opt. 66 TELEGRAPHY MISSOURI CENTRAL ROUTE FORM 31 TRAIN ORDER No.. Chicago, III. Aug, 8. ~j C)Q 4. FORM 31 TO 9_ & E Exa 427 Went, X_ SN At. Hannibal Opr 7.51 M. Exa 427 West has right of track against 2nd No 46 Eng 928 Hannibal to Callao. F. W. H. CONDUCTOR AND ENGI NEMAN MUST BOTH HAVE A COPY OF THIS ORDER. Repeated at- 7:58 M. CONDUCTOR TRAIN MADE TIME OPERATOR Jones 427 W Complete 7:58 P. M. Seaton TELEGRAPHY 67 the same to the dispatcher in the following form: "31 Order No 10 sig Jones trn Exa 427 West." The train dispatcher will then give you complete as follows: "31 Xo 10 complete 758 PM F. W. H." TRAIN ORDER WIRE WORK. (As overheard on the wire from start to finish.) Meaning of the abbreviations used in the following: "HIT— Office call for Hannibal, "SN"— Operator's personal sign. "HI"— Office call for Chillicothe. "GO"— Operator's personal sign. "CU"— Dispatcher's office call. "F. W. H."— Dis- patcher's initials. "Hr — Here 29" — Train dispatcher, train orders. "31 and 19" — Forms of orders." "Cy— Copy." "U— you." "&— and." Example of what would be heard go over the wire in the "X" order system as used in the previous order: (Dspr) Hr 29 HB HB HB 29 CU (Opr HB) I I HB (Dspr) 31 cy 3 u & HI 29 HI HI 29 CU HI (Opr HI) I I HI , (Dspr) 19 cy 3 ( .) Order No 10 To HB C & E Exa 427 West To HI C & E 2nd No 46 ( .) ( .) Exa 427 West has right of track against 2nd No 46 Eng 928 Hannibal to Callao. Sig F. W. H. To HB X CU (Opr HB) 31 No 10 HB C & E Exa 427 West X SN (Dispr) 31 No 10 OK 751 PM F. W. H. To HI ga 68 TELEGRAPHY (Opr HI) 19 Xo 10 HI C & E 2nd No 46 X GO ( .) Exa 427 West has right of track against 2nd Xo 46 Eng 928 Hannibal to Callao. (.) Sig Gregory. (Dspr) OK Hr msg CU FW Fm Chicago 10 To condr 2nd Xo 46 (.) Leave one large box for hay at Shelbina, and one spl stock car at Callao (.) (Sig) F W H 19 Xo 10 complete 755 PM F. W. H. to HB ga (.) (Opr HB) 31 Xo 10 ( .) Exa 427 West has right of track against 2nd Xo 46 Eng 928 Hannibal to Callao (.) Sig Jones trn Exa 427 West (Dspr) Hr Clip CU FW Fr Chicago 10 To condr Exa 427 West (.) Pick up 2 cars cattle at Palmyra Jet and take them through (.) Sig F.W.'H. 31 Xo 10 complete 758 PM F. W. H. 29 CU HI HI 29 Ci^ (Opr HI) I I HI (Dspr) OS (Opr HI) OS OS HI 2nd Xo 46 by 801 HI (Dspr) OK CU BREAKING IN TRAIN ORDERS. Breaking is to open the key and stop the sending operator when you miss a letter or word. In breaking in an order should you miss the order X T o, say "No" ; in the address say, "To" ADDIXG YOUR OFFICE CALL; in the beginning of the body, say, "period ( .)"; TELEGRAPHY 69 in the body give the last word received ; in the signature, say, "sig." (For other forms of Train orders, see Standard Code as revised by the American Railway Association, in another portion of this book.) RAILROAD TELEGRAMS. Railroad telegrams or messages are those which are sent and revised between officials, agents and other em- ployees of a railroad company, and pertain strictly to business of the company. They have no checks, and no record is made of them, are brief and concise as possible and usually composed of many abbreviations, are ad- dressed and signed with full names, except when limited to one division, in which case initials are generally used. Each message received must show on its face from which office it was sent, the signatures of both sending and receiving operators and the time received. Telegrams addressed to persons on trains (except those addressed to train men) must be enclosed in sealed envelopes. The contents of all telegrams must be held strictly confidential. GENERAL INSTRUCTIONS IN RAILWAY MESSAGE WIRE WORK. The signals "Hr," "Anr," or "Ahr," are used to an- nounce the beginning of a message, and to the operator seem as plain as for some one to say, "Here" or "Here is another/' sometimes they say, "Hr msg" or "Hr clip" ; any of the above terms mean get your message blank, here is a message for you. Following this will be sent the office call, of the sending office, then the personal sign of the sending operator; following his sign will 70 TELEGRAPHY come the signal "Fm" or u Fr," which announces that the place from which it is being sent and the date will follow, following the date the signal "To" announces that the address will follow; following ' the address the signal "period (.)" announces that the body will follow, at the conclusion of the body the signal "sig," announces that the signature will follow. The above signals are sent by the sending operator, but never copied by the re- ceiving operator. ORDER OF TRANSMISSION. Office call of sending office. The sending operator's personal sign. Place from and date. Address of the message. Body. Signature. Example of how a Railway message is transmitted. The combinations of letters enclosed in the parenthesis ( ) are sent by the sending operator, but not copied by the receiving operator. (Hr msg) HB SN (Fm) Hannibal 12 (To) Bloomdahl, Sect 4 man, HI ( .) Go to Shelbina and help raise track next week work 5 men. (Sig) J. B. D., R. M. HOW TO COPY MESSAGES ON THE FORMS. Let us now make a study of the following form which will be found similar to that used on most roads. Let Hannibal be the sending office, "HB" the office call, and "SN" the operator's personal sign. Let ChilHcothe be the receiving office, "HI" the office call, and "GO" his TELEGRAPHY 71 personal sign. After calling "HI" and receiving his re- ply, "HB" would say, "Hr msg," meaning get your blank I have a message for you ; following this he would give his office call "HB" which the operator at "HI" would place in the space under the words office call, next he would give his personal sign, "SN," which the operator at "HI" would place in the space under the words Sent By and under the words Received By, he would put his own personal sign "GO," and the time received in the space under the word Time, then the operator at "HB" would say, "FM Hannibal 12," operator at "HI" would then write Hannibal 12 opposite the word From and also the year in the place provided 19. . . . ; then ope- rator at "HB" would say, "To Agt HI," the operator at "HI" would place the abbreviation "Agt' after the word To and his office call. "HI" after the word At , the operator at "HB" would then make a "Period ( .)," which* announces the beginning of the body of the message and send the body and signature as follows : Pis advise how many psngrs for the excn tomorrow Sig. W. D. B. The operator at "HI" would copy the body and signa- ture on the blank space provided for that purpose, and would acknowledge receipt of the message by giving the signal OK, his personal sign and his office call as follows : OK GO HI. After receiving the OK and his personal sign, the operator at "HB" would time the message by placing on its face the receiving office call, the receiving operator's personal sign, his own personal sign and the time as follows: HI 132 PM SX GO. In copying messages, you should always place your personal sign and the time received, in the proper places 72 TELEGRAPHY UJ % 8 z Id I- H tr hi m (0 D 2 Z < -J CO CO z Z o UJ Q. o (0 UJ < to en UJ < o S H to Q > E o w o © o S3 01 03 CO .a •H c G CO £ o v- o U (h o S o a o X CD O A o CO Pi G CO p. t» a CO s o CO •H > CO CO H Ph PQ o H TELEGRAPHY 73 at the same time you are receiving it, then it will never be omitted. This will be found quite difficult at first, but by careful practice from the start it can soon be mastered. BREAKING IN RAILWAY MESSAGES. When breaking in railway messages, should you miss the "office call" of the sending office, say "sine" ; the per sonal sign of the sending operator, say, "wo" ; the name of the place from which it was sent, say "fm"; in the date say, "date"; in the name or initials of the address say, "to"; in the beginning of the body, say, "period (.)"; in the body, give the last word received ; in the signature, say "sig." TELEGRAPH REPORT CALLED "THE SOUP TICKET" Callao station 8/16 190 7. Train No. Exa 927 East Engine No. 927 Arr. 3 10 AM. Dep. 3 28 AM. LOADS EMPTIES PASSENGER stock 15 N.W. Mail and baggage Time Freights 4 Foreigns H Coaches D Freight 807 TOIlS Sleepers WilSOn Conductor. The above report would be sent as follows : (Hr soup tkt) CL AM "S" "4:08 PM." (fm) Callao 16 (.) Trn exa 927 East a 310 d 328 Lds 15 Time Frt 4 Mts Fgn 11 Total Tons 807. (sig) Wilson. 74 TELEGRAPHY THE DETAIL TRAIN REPORT To the Train Dispatcher: Chillicothe 8/16 i 90 6 Train 116 Left 4:10 PM . Engine 896 Engineer L S Morgan Conductor King LOADS. Give contents and destination of each load and state when carded, or Time Freight. Give route of Eastern Time Freight. No. lbs. Contents Destination Time Route Ton- nage 17 Sheep Kansas City 450 11 Hogs c c 330 1 Horse Omaha Stk Yd U P Trns 30 EMPTIES. Give initials, Kind of Cars, Destination, and Size of Local Box and Stocks. No. Mts. Initials Kind Destination Size Tonnage 4 G & N W Box Home 48 King Cond'rorAgt. TELEGRAPHY 75 Detail train reports are started the same as "soup tickets/' and are sent directly across the page with period made at the end of each line ; when through sending, the loads announce the Empties. Example : (Hr. detail) HI BN "ON" " 125 PM." (fm) Chillicothe 16 (to) Dspr ( .) Trn 116 d 4 10 PM Eng 896 Engr L S Morgan Has Lds 17 Sheep Kansas City, Tons 450 ( .) 11 Hogs do Tons 330 ( .) 1 Horse Stk Yds Via U P Trains Tons 30 (0 Mts 4 C & N W Bx Home Tons 48. - Sig King. CAR REPORT LOCAL. These reports differ in form on different roads, but the principle is the same. In sending this report, announce it as "cars,'' sign your office call and then send the letter over such part of the report as you have to fill out. Example: B 2 E 1 M 3 Q 4 R 12 U 3 V 8, and again sign your office call. The operator in the dispatcher's office has a similar form upon which he places the numbers under the letters as you name them. /6 TELEGRAPHY -»j cd m <& X ^ k s •o tf 'C :_' a c W 2 GO O H e o £ T3 X < C3 Q 0) 3 X § < o •^ SI o o QQ > CO a 0) X X TJ O M c p to 2 a pq JO In >> ^» ^j a «s w 53 Eh & ►^ &< 0) u TJ 7™ -o « H c o ^ C C X 13 X W O X 3 > X y t E c 8 M o o *a 02 N O 3d « 03 t-H 2 l y { 13 O w «H o C ^ CO n 4 C e m -u 4) C3 Q K Id 5 o5 a • e 3 1 J2 W e 4 TE RPORAT ABLE g » O T3 ._ ._ a ^ c V 3 w a. CO CO 2 c c o- 5 D 1 < o 5 Id - 1 c c o a, X «J t Hi Ss*p~ ° « ° u - §*£££ — M • C *~ fig 3 u u r- >- 5 tliei "■ MC • O u id Q J > TERN CES IN A DEUVERS messa nly by repeating a nf Unrepealed M« eis riled wuh the C ACE. and to delive O OS Ac X H re CO IT °2^8 ** * Ik «ss«.ui n »^ co"So*-»- J> O I?ss2 E 1,00 any TR be gua nsmiss: days af JNREP UJ 20 H 23 Comp rs can in tra sixty is an 1 DC f— • a££.S- — 1 S t-a.CC o o 0> o o 2 0> o o OQ o crj 2 2 o o CQ Q > u UJ as CD «-> o O CO r* c a* c as to 0) o 10 a CO E as o a> en u o » p. a> •!-> o 6 a> o c o a> S o x: o 6 o o TELEGRAPHY 83 Let us now presume that the above message has been presented at Chillicothe, Mo., office for transmission, and as it meets all the requirements of Rule 1, the operator will observe Rule 2 and see that the month, and the day, are correctly noted thereon ; by referring to his time-piece he*finds the time it was presented to him to be sent was 9:19 A. M., which he will place under the words, "Time Filed" ; he will place his personal sign, which we will presume as "AH," under the words ''Receiver's No." Now by carefully reading every word, he finds according to Rules 3 to 8 inclusive, there are six words to be counted and charged for, which makes the check 6 paid. If the sender had desired it sent collect, and met all the requirements of Rule 13, he would have made the check 7 collect, instead of 6 paid. He should obtain and file the address of the sender, if not well known, in case any reply or service should be received pertaining to the message, the sender can be notified. RECEIVING FORM AND HOW TO COPY ON THE SAME. Let us presume that the operator at Chillicothe, who J has the message for Brookfield, sends it over the wire while the operator at Brookfield makes a copy of the same on the receiving form below. Office call for Chilli- cothe, "HI ;" Brookfield, "BF ;" Operator's personal sign at Chillicothe, "H;" Brookfield, "VG" RECEIVING FORM. After calling "BF" and receiving his reply, operator at "HI" would say, "Hr city." The operator at "BF" would at once know that "HI" had a message for him, 8 4 TELEGRAPHY < a, O u X < a: o UJ -3 UJ H Q K O u 2 O < P « U J | J y 0) o =5 CD O o o 9-» J* o o u CO W u o o 4-> o S 0) o c o ♦-> as © B o .c Q> s o o > 33 ID 0> Pn 0Q TELEGRAPHY 85 and it is a day message, and to be copied on a day mes- sage form. He would, therefore, get the above form and copy as follows : Operator at "HI" after giving him the signal "Hr city/' would send the number of the mes- sage, and his office call which being the first message to- day would be "No 1 HI." Operator at "BF" would write "1 HI," under the word number, operator at "HI" would then send his personal sign "AH," which the operator at "BF" would write under words, "Sent By," and would write under his own personal sign "VC" under the words "Received By/' operator at "HI" ; would then say, "Ck 6 Paid." Operator at "BF" would write, "6 Paid" under the word "Check"; operator at "HI" would then say, "fm Chillicothe Mo 19." Operator at "BF" would write "Chillicothe Mo 19" on the same line after the word, "Dated " ; operator at "HI" would then say, "to James Perkins." Operator at "BF" would write the name of "James Perkins" after the word "To" ; operator at "HI" would then make a "com- ma ( ,)" which in this case means to the receiving opera- tor, drop a line for the address, following the comma the operator at "HI" would say, "931 Alain St." The opera- tor at "BF" would write on the line below the name com- mencing about half way under the name, "931 Main St," operator at "HI" would make another "comma ( ,) Brookfield, Mo." Operator at "BF" would observe the comma this time also and commence about half way under the street address and write, "Brookfield., Mo."; operator at "HI" would then make a "period ( .)" and send the body and signature as follows : "Come home at once mother worse sig Walter Perkins." Operator at "BF" would then copy the body and signature on the blank space provided for that purpose, omitting the ab- 86 TELEGRAPHY breviation "sig." On the line, "Received at 190.. " the operator at "BF" will observe Rule 32 and place "Brookfield, Mo., 9.25 A. M., July 19, 1904," and will count the number of words in the tody of the mes- sage, see that they agree with the check, and otherwise satisfy himself that the message is correct in every way, and then will acknowledge receipt of the same by giving the signal OK, his personal sign and office call as follows : "OK VC BF." The operator at "HI" will time his sent copy according to the following form. TELEGRAPHY 87 TIMING OF SENT COPIES. Copies of sent messages when transmitted should be timed in the following form: 1 BF 9.25 AM AH VG "1" is the number of the message to Brookfield office on that day; "BF" the office call for Brookfield to which the message is being sent; "9:25 A. M." the time trans- mitted; "AH" the sending operator's personal sign; and "VC" the receiving operator's personal sign. It is quite customary for the sending operator to place this form upon the sending blank with his left hand while transmitting the message with the right. It is found quite difficult tor operators of considerable experience but with constant trials the beginner can soon master this im- portant stej\ BREAKING IN COMMERCIAL MESSAGES. When breaking in commercial messages, should you miss in the message number, say — "No f in the sending operator's personal signal say — "wo;" in the, check, say — "ck ;" in the name of the place from which it was sent say — "fm;" in the state, — say "state:" in the date, say — "date ;" in the name of the addressee, say— "to ;" in the street number, or in the case of the party in whose care addressed, say — "comma (,) ;" in the beginning of the body or text, say ("period (...) ;" in the body or text give the last word received; in the signature, say "sig." If for any reason you should fail to receive a message after a part or all of it has been transmitted, or in case you make a "bull" in your copy which would make it neces- sary to have the message repeated, say — "ga anr" cr "ga ahr." 88 TELEGRAPHY MISTAKES IN CHECKS. Suppose that in the following message either the send- ing operator had failed to send, or the receiving operatot had failed to copy, the word % 'wire." 21 MD CR BP 10 Paid. Madison Wis. 22 James Person, Kankakee, 111. Can you meet me Great Northern Chicago Monday wire answer. Milton Clark, 10:14 AM. The receiving operator would at once discover that there was only nine words, in which case he would say, "9 w," meaning I have only "9 words." The sending operator would review his copy and find ten words, and would say "ck 10 Paid and make a period and repeat the first letter of each word as follows : c ; m m g n c m w a." By following each letter closely the receiving opera- tor would discover that he had no word which com- menced with "w" after the word Monday and would say "ga monday;" the sending operator would repeat "mon- dav wire answer" and the error would be corrected. COMMERCIAL MESSAGES EXPLAINED. In the following messages the combinations of letters inclosed in the parenthesis () are sent by the sending operator, but not copied by the receiving operatot ; those in quotations " " are copied by the receiving operator, but not sent by the sending operator. TELEGRAPHY 89 MORE THAN ONE ADDRESS. When a message is addressed to two persons in the same place or town and delivery is to be made to each, it will be charged for as two messages. Example : (Sturges receives city.) (Hr city mk 2 cys No) 1 BN AN "HW" (ck) 10 Paid. (fm) Hannibal Mo 22 (to) C L Brown and Geo Clark, Sturges, Mo. (.) Meet me Kansas City Hudson House Eleven oclock Monday bring papers. (sig) P D Kitt "11:15 AM" The manner of transmitting the above message will be determined by the manager or chief operator of the sending office. It may be sent to both persons at one transmission, or to each one separately ; if only one trans- mission is made the sending operator who makes the last transmission should tell the receiving operator to make 2 copies, as follows: (Hr city mk 2 cys) so he may at one writing with manifold make a copy for each address. When a message is addressed to two persons in the same place or town and delivery is to be made to either, it will be charged as only one message, but the second address together with the connecting word "or" will be included in the count and charged for. .jo TELEGRAPHY Example : (Brookfield received city.) (Hr city No) 4 MR ED "ED" (ck) 14 Paid 3 exa wds. (fm) Palmyra Mo 22 (to) J K Wheeler, or Ed Page, Care Bacon Elevator, Brookfield Mo (.) Phone Ella I bought load mules waiting for car home tomorrow. (sig) Win Hopper "12 K Noon" In the above message we have 3 extra words which are the three extra words in the address, "or Ed Page" while there are only eleven body words. They are called extra words because they are not a part of the body, yet must be counted and charged for; therefore, they are men- tioned in the check as extra words. All words in a mes- sage which according to the rules must be counted and charged for, and are not in the body, are mentioned in the check as so many extra words. STREET ADDRESSES, Great care should be taken to obtain from the sender a good, clear address for each message. The importance of the address cannot be over-estimated. When the ad- dress given seems insufficient a better one should be re- quested. Example : '(Moberley receives City.) (Hr City No) 41 BF FS "JK" (ck) 8 Paid (fm) Brookfield Mo 22 (to) M L Quinn, TELEGRAPHY 91 Traveling salesman for Hibbard Spencer Bartlett & Co., Try Hotels and 326 Wentworth Ave., Moberley, Mo. (.) Go to St Louis first train meet George answer. (sig) Mrs M L Quinn ■ "3:15 PM" In the above address it might seem that extra words appear to be used, but whenever it is necessary to make a lengthy address, which will insure prompt delivery, do so rather than necessitate sending several service messages. MORE THAN ONE SIGNATURE. Whenever a message has two or more signatures and they are not in the nature of a firm, Mr & Mrs, or John Smith & Family, all will be counted and charged for ex- cept the last. Example : (Shelbina receives City.) (Hr city No) 16 GH OA "HX" (ck) 16 paid 3 exa wds. (fm) Birmingham Mo 22 (to) Rev A L Appleby, Pastor M E Church Shelbina, Mo (.) Will you meet our Sunday School at picnic at Seven Oak Farm Friday. (sig) S M McGee, Elmer Ford. ■ "4:25 PM" In this message we also have 3 extra words, as we count and charge for all signatures when there are more than one except the last. 92 TELEGRAPHY TITLE WORDS. Whenever a signature has a title of more than two words or whenever there are words after the signature which are not title words, each word will be counted and charged for. Example : (Hannibal received Relayed.) (Hr tru No) 23 BN WR "GR" (ck) 12 Collect 3 exa wds (fm) St Louis Mo 22 (to) Melvin Clarksdale, On Train Xo 6, H & St J Ry, Monroe Mo (.) Work Shelbina Geo Thompson here have wired firm. (Sig) Geo M. Holder, Agent Deering Machine Co "8:29 AM" In the above message we have four words after the signature, only one of them being a title word, "Agent'' (which is allowed free) therefore, we count and charge for "Deering Machine Co" as 3 extra words together with 8 body words and the word "collect" in the check which is counted but not charged for. REPORTING DELIVERY. Whenever the sender of a message wishes the company to notify him of its delivery. Example. (Kansas City receives Relayed.) (Hr tru No) 8 CL CR "RG" (ck) 18 Paid 2 exa wds Rept Dely TELEGRAPHY 93 (fm) Chicago 111 22 (to) Dr J B Freeman, 68 Main St, Macon, Mo (.) Will send papers today Title will have to be made perfect before I can accept it. (sig) Dr N J Moreland, "12:27 EM" In the above message there are two extra words in the check 44 Rept Dely" which are counted and charged for and placed there by the sending office to notify the re- ceiving office, that a notice of delivery must be given. Example : (Kansas City receives Relayed.) (Hr tru No) 3 CN RG "CR" (ck) 11 collect (fm) Macon Mo 22 (to) Dr N J Moreland Chicago, 111. (.) Delivered your message to Dr J B Freeman nine AM. (sig) L S McDonald, Manager "2:10 PM" REPEATED MESSAGE. Whenever the sender wishes his message repeated or telegraphed back to the originating office for compari- son. Example : (Kansas City receives City.) (Hr city No) 9 GH NS "G" (ck) 11 Paid 2 exa wds Rept Bk (fm) Birmingham Mo 22 94 TELEGRAPHY (to) Adams Bros & Co, Kansas City Mo (.) Send by express Range casting twenty nine fifty four, (sig) Field Hdw Co. "7:14 PM." In the check of the above message there are two extra words "rept Back'' which are counted and charged for. They are placed in the check by the sending office to notify the receiving office, that the message must be re- peated for comparison, which should be done immediate- ly before giving OK. A half rate will be charged for the repetition in addition to the charge for the message. SPECIAL DELIVERY. Delivery charges to be paid by the sender. Whenever a message is to be especially delivered be- yond the free delivery limits of the terminal office, and for which the delivery charges are not given in the tariff book and the charges are to be paid by the sender. Example : (Bucklin received City) (Hr city No) 12 CD SR "B" (ck) 11 Paid exa wds Rept Dely Chgs (fm) Laclede Mo 22 (to) L A Martin, 3 1-2 miles southeast town, Bucklin, Mo (.) When can you meet me to arrange contract. (sig) George Perdin. "10:18 AM" The above message is to be delivered by special mes- senger 3 1-2 miles southeast of Bucklin Mo and the TELEGRAPHY 95 charges are to be paid by the sender. In which case the sending office inserts in the check the word "Rept Dely Chgs" which are counted and charged for. They are placed in the check to notify the receiving office to have the message delivered and notify them by Service of the amount of charges so they can be collected from the sender. When the charges are to be paid by the addressee. Whenever a message is to be specially delivered beyond the free delivery limits of the terminal office, and for which the delivery charges are not given in the tariff book, and the charges are to be paid by the addressee. Example : (Ottumwa receives relayed) (Hr tru No) 5 CRMK "JF" (ck) 12 Paid 3 exa wds Dely Chgs Gtd. (fm)Des Moines Ioa 22 (to) S O Warren, Cattle Breeder 5 miles east, Chillicothe, Mo (.) Offer twenty five good steers average four five twenty. (sig) W A Drake, "9:03 AM" In this message we also have 3 extra words in the check "Dely Chgs Gtd" which are counted and charged for and placed there by the sending office to notify the receiving office, that the charges are guaranteed, but should be paid by the addressee. EXTRA DATES. Whenever a message is to be forwarded according to Rules. The name of the originating office and the date 96 TELEGRAPHY will be counted and charged for as a part of the mes- sage. Example : (As message appears when first received at Boston.) 25 BN FN WR 11 Collect Buffalo N Y 22 John Brown, Transient, Boston, Mass. Meet me next Monday at ten oclock in the forenoon. H Smith, 8:19 AM For example, if the above message had been sent by "this" line from Buffalo to Boston, and John Brown had left Boston before the message arrived and had left a request, that all messages received for him be for- warded care Hudson House, Fall River, Mass. Boston would mark out certain words and add others as per following example : 8:25 Buffalo, N.Y. 22, Via Boston Mass. 22 John Brown, Transient Care Hudson House, Boo ton, Maoo . Fall River, Mass* Meet me next Monday, at ten o'clock in the forenoon. H. Smith, 8:19 AM (As message appears marked ready to forward.) TELEGRAPHY 97 You will notice in the above message four extra words appear which are the originating office and the date (Buffalo, N. Y. 22) which are to be counted and charged for. In the check, numbers appear which are the tolls to be collected. Suppose the rate from Buf- falo to Boston to be 35 and 2 and from Boston to Fall River 25 and 2 : then an collect message from Buffalo to Boston would cost 35c and a 15 collect message from Boston to Fall River 33c. The message being a "re- ceived collect" message, in which case Boston would check it so the rate from Boston to Fall River which is 33c would appear in the check first, as the "this" line tolls, and the rate from Buffalo to Boston which is 35c would appear in the check second, as the "other" line tolls. (As message appears when copied at Fall River.) B FB P 15 Colect 33 & 35 4 exa wds. Buffalo N Y. 22, Via Boston, Mass. 22, John Brown, Care Hudson House, Fall River, Mass. Meet me next Monday at ten oclock in the forenoon. H Smith 8:39 AM. Fall River would deliver and collect from Brown 2>Z & 35 or the total 68c. OTHER LINE MESSAGES. Whenever a message is to go over any "other" lines to reach the destination, the name of the transfer station should appear on the check from the originating office to the transfer office. * Example: 9 8 TELEGRAPHY (Kansas City receives Relayed.) (Hr tru No) 7 HI MS "WF" (ck) 7 Paid Via St Louis (fm) Chillicothe Mo 22 (to) Alvin Ferryman, Ballwin, Mo (.) Meet George St Louis Friday important business answer. (sig) M L Hardlin, -8:28 AM" In the check of the above message we have the words "Via St. Louis" which are not counted or charged for, only placed in the check to indicate that the message is paid Via St. Louis. Whenever a message is received over "other" lines at the proper station indicated by the tariff book, the name of the transfer office and also the date should appear on the same line with the originating office. Example : (Chillicothe receives City.) (Hr city No) 12 KC WF "MS" (ck) 9 Collect an ans (fm) Ballwin Mo 22 Via St Louis Mo 22 (to) M L Hardlin, Chillicothe Mo ( .) Will meet George Union Station ticket office Friday. (sig) Alvin Perryman, "1 128 PM" It might seem in the above message that there were extra dates, but by referring to the tariff book we find that St. Louis is one of the proper places for a message from Ballwin to reach this Company's lines, and it is placed there, so the office of destination may know both TELEGRAPHY 99 the originating and the transfer office, in order that the tolls may be computed Via the transfer office. You will note that the above message is an answer to the preceding message and it is customary to send the answer to a message, when such message makes some request of the addressee, collect. In the check we find the words "an answer" which are placed there to remind the receiving office that it is an answer to some message which has been sent from his office ; in case a prepaid message requires an answer the addressee may send an answer collect and will not be required to make a de- posit. WHEX AN ANSWER IS PREPAID. Whenever the sender of a message wishes to prepay for an answer to his message, the sending office will place in the check the wire signal "33" which will hot be counted or charged for. Example : (Cameron receives City.) (Hr city No) 32 HB B "AS" (ck) 10 Paid & 33 (fm) Hannibal Mo 22 (to) Geo Thompson Mgr Foot Ball Team, Cameron. Mo (.) Can you accept our offer for thirteenth others want- ing date. (sig) M L Stevens, "8:10 AM" ioo TELEGRAPHY Upon receipt of a message bearing the wire signal "33" in the check, the receiving offices will if possible obtain an answer and send the same "collect" without requiring any deposit from the sender. NIGHT MESSAGES. A night message will be written upon a night mes- sage form; they are sent at reduced rates and if pre- sented any time during the day, and it is so requested, they will be accepted at night rates and held until 6 PM. and sent as soon thereafter as possible. Example : (Kansas City Receives Relayed.) (Hr red tru No) 5 KG AX "SN" (ck) 12 Collect Night (fm) Breckenridge Mo 22 (to) J L McCandlish Indianapolis, Ind (.) Offer ten cars good mill screenings seven ten im- mediate acceptance. (sig) Breckenridge Elevator Co. "9:45 AM" In the above message the w r ord "red" is found in the signals which announce that it is to be copied on Night Message Form, and also in the check the word "night" is placed, indicating that the message will be charged for at night rates. ALWAYS begin night messages with the word RED and also send the word NIGHT in the check. An office which is not kept open, will before closing, transmit its "night" messages; if any night messages are left over until morning they will be trans- mitted before new business is taken up. TELEGRAPHY 101 CODE MESSAGES. Code messages are composed of words found in the ordinary dictionaries but so arranged as to give no mean- ing without the use of a code book ; such messages are transmitted at ordinary tariff rates. Example : (Kansas City receives Relayed.) (Hr code tru No) 3 GH ED "MA" (ck) 6 Paid (fm) Birmingham Mo 22 (to) Warner & Wilbur, Commission Merchants, Chicago, 111. (.) Alert Anvil and abacus demand probable. (sig) Robert Elliott "8;i6 AM" A code message is usually preceded by the word "code" which puts the receiving operator on his guard. The above message, to an operator, has no meaning, but should be handled very carefully and every letter sent and copied unmistakably correct, and be very particular, crossing every "t" and dotting every "i," so they may be readily translated by the addressee. Translated the above message would read "Buy 10,000 bushels Xo 2 wheat for May delivery and buy 100 bales of January cotton margin twenty points." Much money is there- fore saved in telegraphing by the use of codes. All lead- ing branches of business have separate and different codes and it would be useless to try to decipher their messages without a copy of their code book. 102 TELEGRAPHY CIPHER MESSAGES. Cipher messages are in reality used for the same pur- pose as code messages. They are composed in whole, or part, of figures, letters, characters or words not con- tained in dictionaries or a combination of either or all of them, having no sense unless interpreted by means of a key in possession of the sender and receiver. Example : (St. Joseph receives City.) (Hr city No) 5 BN RK "TD" (ck) 29 Paid Cipher. (fm) Hannibal Mo 22 (to) Keller Mfg Co. 1225 Madison St. St. Joseph Mo (.) Maeotis qr7ef 1740 aedeui zyrstfg6 heavy qzrnm 9658. (sig) Johnson & Co. "9:19 AM" To count the above message study the rule covering such messages. The receiving operator should not OK a cable, code, or cipher message until he has repeated the body to the sending operator for comparison. This should be done to protect against possible errors, regard- less of the requirements of the rules. GOVERNMENT MESSAGES. Government messages relate to the official business of the government and have preference over all other busi- ness. Example : (Moberly receives City.) (Hr pink govt No) 56 KC FL "Z" (ck) 13 Paid Govt. TELEGRAPHY 103 (fm) Washington D C 22 (to) Weatherman, Moberly, Mo (.) Generally fair tonight and Tuesday warmer west portion tonight. (sig) Cox "4:38 PM" In all government messages you count the address, body words and the signature, or commence after the word ki to" and count everything. ALWAYS begin a government message with the word GOVT, and also put the word GOVT in the check. DEAD-HEAD MESSAGES. Messages of employes of an urgent social or domes- tic character may be sent free and the check will show the reason for its acceptance without payment of the tolls. Example : (Sturges receives City.) (Hr City No) 5 MA RX "Q" 9 D H Opr (fm) Ottumwa Ioa 22 (to) Edgar P Walker, Sturges, Mo (.) Mother and Mollie leave tonight meet them seven oclock. (sig) G L Walker "7:33, PM" A message of this sort must be approved by the man- ager or superintendent in accordance with the rules. I04 TELEGRAPHY CABLES. Cable messages sent or received should be written on cable blanks and must always be prepaid. Example : (Form of Transmission) (Hr Cable No) 8 CN MS (fm) Liverpool 5 (to) Sherlock St. Louis (Mo) (.) Abhor 36-4 (sig) Ole In cables the check is not sent, only the number of words which appear immediately after the originating point. No date is given in transmission, but is filled in by both sending and receiving operator. To count cables begin at the word "to" and count everything except where the state is in parentheses ( ). It is not to be counted. If it is not in the parentheses it is to be counted. Counting of cables will be found different from messages, and a thorough study of the cable rules is needed. ALWAYS repeat the cables, and time them on the face with both sending and receiving operator's signal. A press message, or query, should be written upon a pink blank at a relay office, and should receive prompt service. The check of such message shall contain the words "Day Press rate" or "Night press rate" the same as press for publication. They are sent by some newspaper correspondent to some newspaper stating some happening or occurrence TELEGRAPHY UJ < fiu o U 26 a a 65 (A s O Ed Qj2 us J z 2§ u CD < 2 a: H CO UJ UJ X H . c « a £ <£ 2 § c CDD - a> (L * (L J| 0> v JB •SI o o o O 5 .2 M C w « ,. SOjB — 00 a) — - zj a- jcjcq CD UJ y E (L u ui ir • t — © in 00 o to o r-t O z o o z o Q > z — o «: Q£ 00 to o o a p. Q> > O 2£ 3 O o o r-l o c/3 CD tO p. o < (*Form as received and copied.) «o6 TELEGRAPHY and inquiring the amount of matter desired for publica- tion : they are charged for at the same rate as press for publication. No message to be rated less than ten words. Example : (Kansas City receives Relayed.) (Hr tru pink No) 12 Hi Z "DA" (ck) 18 Collect N P R. (fm) Chillicothe Mo 22 (to) Chicago Record, Chicago, 111 ( .) Nancy Bell takes three out of five best time 216 3-4 Good story how much. (Sig) Morgan, -7:55 PM" TRESS SPECIAL. A despatch addressed to some newspaper containing an account of some happening or occurrence for pub- lication, is charged for at press rates. Example: (Chillicothe receives press special.) (Hr spl No) 29 KC AB "B" (ck) 70 Collect N P R ■ t (fm) St Louis Mo 22 (to) Constitution, Chillicothe Mo (.) Tony Faust's restaurant on Broadway, opposite the Olympic, was the scene of a robbery some time dur- ing the early hours of this morning, in which $4JOO in cash was stolen. The police are looking for Henry Stetten, alias Henry Stegger, who was em- ployed as a bartender at the catering establishment, and who is suspected of having some knowledge of the crime. Filed 7 :10 PM (sig) Hemmings "7:25 PM" TELEGRAPHY jo- in the foregoing press message we have 70 words, 64 of which are the body, 1 in the check, and 5 in the Filing Time, which when placed in the body of despatches will be transmitted, counted and charged for. SERVICE MESSAGES. A message, pertaining to messages, which have been sent, regarding their delivery, collection of charges, etc, is called a service message. ABBREVIATIONS USED. N S N — No such number. B B A — Give better address. G S A — Give some address. S F S — See former service. S Y S — See your service. D F S — Disregard former service. 92— Deliver. Deld (or 92A) — Delivered. Undeld — Undelivered. Dely — Delivery. Dely chgs gtd — Delivery charges guaranteed. Rept dely chgs — Report delivery charges. Rept dely — Report delivery. Spl dely — Special delivery. Sgd (or) sined — Signed. Gte — Guarantee. ioS TELEGRAPHY FORMS USED IN TRANSMISSION. (Hr tru No) 28 MO K "FCT (ck) Svc (or) Ofs. (to) Omaha Nebr (.) S F S yours red date Williams sgd Harrison 926 OK. (sig) Monroe Mo. 22 "5:46 PM" You will note that the above service or office message has no "from" and the number of the words are not men- tioned in the check ; it is also addressed to the name of an office and signed by the name of an office ; the signa- ture also contains the date. Never address a service message to an operator, agent, or any other person, ex- cept in making an answer to some service from a large office which might be signed for example : "Clark Chi- cago 111 22" in which case you would address your ser- vice message to "Clark Chicago 111." EXPLANATION AND DIFFERENT FORMS USED. Whenever a message is received with a request in the check to "Rept dely chgd," the receiving office will have the message delivered, pay the special messenger and send a service. Example: To Laclede, Mo. Dely chgs yours date Martin sgd Perdin One dollar which we check you other lines. Bucklin, Mo. 22. Whenever a message is received with the words "Dely chgs gtd" in the check, and the addressee refuses to pay TELEGRAPHY 109 for the special delivery, the receiving office will pay the special messenger and in accordance with the RULES, send a service. Example : To Cameron, Mo. We check you One Fifty other lines Dely yours date Warren sgd Drake. Chillicothe, Mo. 22. Whenever a message is received, and the addressee lives outside the free delivery limits, and the delivery charges have not been provided for, ask about the de- livery charges by service. Example : To Madison Wis. John Benson lives four miles out do you gte One Twenty Five Dely yours date sgd Clark. St. Lotus Mo. 22. When a service similar to the above is received and the delivery charges are guaranteed by the sender. Example : To St. Louis, Mo. SYS we gte One Twenty Five Dely chgs ours date Ben- son sgd Clark. Madison Wis. 22 The above service must be charged for in accordance with the RULES. WHEN CHARGES ARE NOT GUARANTEED. To St. Louis, Mo. SYS ours date Benson sgd Clark chgs not gtd, pis drop in P. O. Madison Wis. 22 no TELEGRAPHY WHERE THE STREET NUMBER MENTIONED IN THE ADDRESS OF A MESSAGE CANNOT BE FOUND. Example : To Battle Creek, Mich. N S N as 324 East Lake St and Huffman & Son un- known at 324 West -Lake St, G B A or cant 92 your date sgd Peterson. Indianapolis, Ind. 22. WRONG ADDRESS. To Geneva, 111. M L Sacket unknown at 1262 Wentworth Ave, G B A or cant 92 yours date sgd Mitchell. Clark, Chicago, 111. 22. CORRECTED ADDRESS. To Clark Chicago, 111. Ours date Sacket sgd Mitchell is addressed to 1282 Wentworth Ave, Not 1262 we repeat 1282, SYS and advise. Geneva, 111. 22. WHEN MESSAGE IS DELAYED. To St Joseph, Mo. Can't 92 until 8 AM yours Meek & Co sgd Clayball, of- fice closed for the night and residence unknown. Boston, Mass. 22. TELEGRAPHY ill IF THE ADDRESSEE OF A COLLECT MESSAGE REFUSES TO PAY FOR THE SAME, To New York, N. Y. Collect there yours date Hutson sgd Reedy payment re- fused. Toledo, Ohio. 22. WHEN A MESSAGE HAS BEEN LOST OR NOT UNDERSTOOD, ASK FOR DUPLICATE. To Quincy, 111. Duplicate quick yours date Carlton sgd Manning, mes- sage not understood. Galesburg, 111. 22. ASKING FOR DUPLICATE OF A CERTAIN WORD. To Rawlins, Wyo. Duplicate eighth body word yours Nelson sgd Hender- son. Medicine Bow, Wyo. 22. DUPLICATING A CERTAIN WORD. To Medicine Bow, Wyo. SYS eighth body word ours date Nelson sgd Hender- son is "waste" we repeat it "waste." Rawlins, Wyo. 22. WHEN NO STREET ADDRESS IS GIVEN. To Adams, Nebr. G S A or can't 92 your red- 21st Parker sgd Ammer- man. Englewood, 111. 22. Whenever the check in a message is anything else than "Day," it should be mentioned as in the above mes- sage. ii2 TELEGRAPHY WHEN A SERVICE HAS BEEN SENT AND ANOTHER FOLLOWS CHANGING THE FIRST., To Adams, Nebr. D F S have 92 OK your Red 21st Parker sgd Ammer- man. Englewood, 111. 22. WHEN THE ADDRESSEE HAS CHANGED RESIDENCE. To Pattensburg, Mo. Clifton Pub Co. have moved from 936 West Clay St and present address unknown G B A or can't 92 yours yesterday sgd Adams Bros. Clark, Chicago, 111. 22, WHEN THE ADDRESSEE LEAVES TOWN BEFORE A COLLECT MESSAGE ARRIVES FOR HIM. To South Bend, Ind. Allen Thompson left city before yours date sgd Mer- dock arrived. Collect there. Warsaw, Ind. 22. WHEN A MESSAGE IS SENT TO WRONG DESTINATION. To St Joseph, Mo. File but do not check ours red 21st Randall sgd Peterson should have been sent to St Louis, Mo. have resent it to St. Louis. Chillicothe, Mo. 22. ASKING FOR QUICK ANSWER. To Milwaukee, Wis. Pis get quick answer or reason why ours yesterday Stock- ton sgd demons. Minneapolis, Minn. 22. TELEGRAPHY ii 3 NUMBER SERVICE MESSAGES. To Chicago, 111. Yesterday sent 97 received 210. Kansas City, Mo. 12. To Kansas City, Mo. No record your No 97 yesterday, Pis give skeleton. Hitchcock, Chicago, 111. 22. GIVING SKELETON. To Hitchcock, Chicago, 111. Ours yesterday No 97 to you ck 13 Paid fm Brecken- ridge, Mo. to James Armstrong Milwaukee, Wis. sgd Widley Bros, reed opr MA 2 125 PM, SYS and ad- vise. Kansas City, Mo. 22. COMMERCIAL NEWS DEPARTMENT. That department of commercial telegraph which gath- ers and furnishes by wire, quotations and other news of grain and provision market. The grain and provision market opens at 9:30 A. M. on the board of trade, and the quotations are sent out at different times until 1:15 P. M., except on Saturdays, when the close is sent at twelve o'clock, noon. ABBREVIATIONS. GRAIN. PROVISIONS. W Wheat P Pork C Corn L Lard O Oats S R (or) R . . . Short Ribs J 14 TELEGRAPHY OPTION MONTHS. F January G February H ■ March J April K May M N J«iy Q August U . • • • • - September V October X November June Z December ORAIN.r N D. (Hr end No) 4 CII AC "GO" (ck) C N D (fm) Chicago 111 22 (to) Quincy 111 (.) WZ 1.05%, K 1.04^ cz oz 4m, 30, K K 40^40^ (sig) 9 :3o AM Opening. "9:41 AM" PROVISIONS C N D (Hr end No) 5 CH AC "GO" (ck) C N D (fm) Chicago 111 22 (to) Quincy 111 ( .)PZ 13.00, K 12.50 . lZ 7.65, K 7.85 SRZ 9.70, K 10.00 (sig) 9 .-30 AM Opening. "9:43 AM" TELEGRAPHY 115 ABBREVIATIONS USED IN LIVE STOCK C N D A Exact Receipts M Heavy B Exports N Light C Sales P Premium J Left Over X Mixed K . . . . Receipts Da} T Before OPENING LIVE STOCK C N D. (Hr end No) 2 KC NF "SR" (ck) C N D (fm) Kansas City Mo 22 (to) Cameron Mo ( .)Hogs 20,000 prospects stronger. Cattle 10,000 prospects steady. Sheep 6,000 prospects unchanged. (sig) 7:10 AM Opening. "7:18 AM THE 8 140 AM C N D. (Hr end No) 25 KC NF "SR" (ck) C N D (fm) Kansas City Mo 22 (to) Cameron Mo (.) A 20,000 B 11, 292 C 5,121 J 2,854 K 21,000 aver- age higher. M 5°o@5i7^ N 460(^505, P 5QO@5i7, X 460(0)505. Cattle 10,000 including 300 southerns. Na- tive steers 400(^625. Southern Steers 250(^375. Na- tive Cows arid Heifers 150(^450. Stocker and Feed- ers 2125(0)425. Westerns 300@45o. Sheep, 6,000. Muttons 325(0^380. Lambs 400(0)415. Range wethers 325@400. Ewes 275(0)360. (sig) 4:40 AM "8:48 AM" n6 TELEGRAPHY GRAIN SPECIAL FOR PUBLICATION. (Hr spl No) 56 KC J "AD" (ck) Collect DPR (fm) Kansas City Mo 22 (to) The Gallatin Democrat, Gallatin, Mo ( .) Wheat — 198 cars — Dec. $1.05*4; May, $1.04)4 ; cash No. 2 hard, $i.O/)4@t.io ; No. 3, $1.04(0)1.08; No. 4, 96c@$i.04; rejected, 85(094^ No 2 red, $1.12; No. 3, $i.o8@i.io; No. 4, 98c@$i.o6. Wheat — Higher. Corn — Dec. 41^ ; May 40.74(0)40^; cash; No. 2 mixed. 48c; No. 3, 47)/, No. 2 white, 48^ ; No. 3, 48® 4854 c. Oats — No. 2 white, 30(o)32c ; No 2 mixed, 29^ c. (sig) * Watkins . Filed 4:37 PM. "4:40 PM." INDEX MOVEMENT OF TRAINS. The Train Brakeman 5 Freight Brakeman 6 Passenger Conductor 9 Freight Conductor v 12 Dispatchers; Trainmaster; Division Superintendent.. i£ Chief Train Dispatcher 16 The Trainmaster 19 Division Superintendent 22 The Manifestations of Color Blindness — How to De- tect It 2J Heating Passenger Cars 41 The Baker System 41 The Original or Old Style Ordinary Baker Heater 42 Circulating Drum, or Water Reservoir and Ex- pansion Chamber 44 Showing Plan of Piping, Coil, and Circulation Drum 45 Improved Fire-Proof Heater 47 Automatic Regulator and Pressure Indicator. ... 49 Double Coil or Two-Circulation Heater 50 Arrangement Illustrating Method of Filling the Heater Circulation System 53 Baker Steam Attachment Shown Fitted to Heater 58 Details of Improved Baker Steam Attachment. . 59 Standard Heating System 60 i 11 INDEX Heating Passenger Cars — Continued. Train Pipe Valve 61 Extension Handle 62 Automatic Steam Trap 64 Diagram Showing Minimum Pitch to Be Given to Steam Trap 65 Direct Steam Heating System 66 Steam Inlet Valve 67 Angle Valve 68 Reducing Valve 69 Gauge for Steam Heating 70 Steam Coupler Troubles 71 Coupling of Heads 72 The Economy Car Heating System 74 Action of the Locks 75 Pipe Connections 78 Three-Way Cock Located in the Exhaust Pipe. . . 80 Operation ' 81 Showing Location of Apparatus 82 Showing the Piping of Economy Car Heating Apparatus 83 Showing Location of Apparatus 85 Relief Valve 86 Gold's Steam Heating Apparatus 87 Gold's Heating Apparatus, Its Application to Lo- comotive 88 Improved Temperature Regulator 89 Sectional View Improved Temperature Regu- lator 91 Pressure Radiator Dial 93 Explanation of Plate V 93 Gold's Improved Direct System for Heating Pas- senger Cars 94 INDEX 111 Heating Passenger Cars — Continued. Cylinder Containing Bricks for Storing Heat... 95 Gold's Improved Storage System for Heating Compartment Cars 97 Duplex Coils 99 Sectional View Duplex Coils 100 Gold's Improved System of Hot Water Circula- tion 101 Gold's Improved System of Hot Water Circula- tion 102 Combination Automatic Lock and Hose Support. 103. Combination Automatic Lock and Hose Support. 104 Combination Automatic Lock and Hose Support, Attached to a Car 105 Vapor Heating 107 Expansive Diaphragm 108 Details of Operation 109 Details of Vapor Regulator no Heating Cars with Electricity 115 Completed Coil for No. 143-LL Heater Show- ing Resistance Coil, Porcelain Plates and Lead Wires 116 Electric Heater in Position 117 Heater Enclosed in Insulated Iron Casing; Wir- ing Shown in Moulding 117 Diagrams of Wiring Electric Heating System. . .11S Electric Couples Used for Heating Trains by Electricity 119 A Quick-Break Knife Switch. . . . 120 Catechism of Steam Heating 122 Making Up Trains 122 Regulation of Temperature 122 Changing Engines 123 IV INDEX Catechism of Steam Heating Apparatus of Trains. . .124 Operation of the Apparatus 127 Care of the Apparatus 129 Responsibility of Employes 131 Lighting Passenger Cars 133 Present Form 138 Old Form 138 Showing a Two-Flame Ordinary Pintsch Gas Lamp, in Baggage Car. . 141 The Regulator Used with the Mantles for In- verted Burners ; 142 Showing Proper Flame 143 Inverted Burner Lamps in Passenger Coach 144 Inverted Burner Lamps in Dining Car 145 Instructions to Foremen and Inspectors for the Use of Pintsch Gas Equipment at Terminal Points 146 Instructions to Trainmen for the Care of Pintsch Gas Car Equipment 148 Gold's Improved System of Acetylene Car Lighting. .150 Interior of Coach with Gas Generator Installed. .151 Top of Generator Projecting Through Roof of Sleeping Car 152 Generator Applied to a Coach 154 The Safety Storage System of Acetylene Light- ing for Railway Cars 155 Safety Storage Tank Broken to Show the Asbes- tos Discs 155 Charging Plant of the N. Y, N. H. & H. R. R., * Providence, R. I., Showing 5,000 Cu. Ft. Holder . . . ^ 156 INDEX V Gold's Improved System of Acetylene Car Lighting — Continued. Ground Plan of Generating and Compressing Plant, N. Y., N. H. & H. R. R., at Provi- dence, R. 1 157 Ground Plan of Gas Holder 158 General Acetylene Generator 159 Generating and Compressing Plant of the D., L. & W. R. R. at Hoboken, N. J 160 N. Y. C. & H. R. R. Day Coach equipped with the Safety Storage System 161 Erie Mail Car 162 D., L. & W. Cafe Car 163 N. Y., N. H. & H. Car Equipped with the Safety Storage System 164 Sections of Cars Showing Equipment. 165 The Electric Car Lighting System 166 Generator . Showing Perforated Pulley and Sup- porting Arms 167 Side View of Eucker Showing Coupler Head. . . 168 Automatic Switch 169 Bucker with Lower Frame Removed Showing Armature in Lower Frame 169 Wiring, Fixtures and Lamps 170 Partial Theoretical Wiring Diagram 171 Relative Position of Bucker and Junction Box on Bottom of Car Body. . .172 Arrangement of Circuits 173 Battery Current Regulation 175 Car Generator 177 Car Generator Showing Outside Suspension Pul- ley End 177 INDEX Generator — Continued. Side View of Generator Showing Armature Pul- ley, Axle Pulley, Belt and Tension Mechan- ism 178 Belt Tension Mechanism 179 Pulleys and Belts 1 79 Side View of Generator Showing Lower Frame Swung Down, Exposing Internal Parts, Armature Remaining in Upper Frame. .180 Advantages of Bliss Suspension 180 Generator Field Coils and Retainers 18 1 End View of Generator, Showing Bearing Head and Hand Hole Cover Removed, Exposing Automatic Brush Mechanism 182 Complete Generator Armature and Pulley, Auto- matic Brush Mechanism and Armature Coil. 183 Armature 183 Spider and Removable Shaft 184 Armature Shafts and Nuts of Generator and Bucker, Showing Spider and Removable Shaft Construction 184 End View of Generator Showing Bearing Head and Hand Hole Cover Removed 185 Journals and Lubrication 186 Brushes 186 Capacity and Rating 186 Brush Mechanism and Automatic Pole Changer. 18O Automatic Brush Mechanism and Flexible Cables. 187 Bucker 188 Bucker with Lower Frame Removed, Showing Armature in Upper Frame 189 Armatures 190 Complete Bucker Armature and Shaft 190 INDEX yii Car Generator — Continued. Bucker Field Coils and Pole Pieces 190 Field Magnets 190 Brush Holders : 191 Bucker Brush Holders and Details 191 Bearings 191 Terminals and Connections 192 Interior View of Bucker Showing Construction of Upper Frame, Brush Holders and Wir- ing 192 End View of Bucker Showing Complete Coupler Head and Block and Method of Connecting Car Wires 193 Operation of the Bucker 193 Constant Lamp Voltage 194 Regulation of the Generator 195 Economy of the Bucker 195 Generator Switch 195 Complete Theoretical Wiring Diagram 196 Generator Switch in Single Section Iron Box. ..197 Construction 197 Operation 198 Triple Contact 198 Generator Switch with Four-Circuit Panel Board in Double Section Iron Box 199 Fuse Deck 200 Adjustable Shunt 200 Emergency Exciter Switch 201 Junction Box. 202 Front View Junction Box, with Cover Removed . 202 The Standard Code Train Rules , 203 General Rules 203 Definitions 204 \ 111 INDEX Rules for Single Track. . . 206 Standard Time 206 Certificate of Watch Inspector 207 Time Tables ' 208 Signal Rules 209 Visible Signals 209 Hand, Flag and Lamp Signals 210 Audible Signals 210 Air Whistle or Bell Cord Signals 212 Train Signals 2 1.2 Use of Signals 213 Superiority of Trains 214 Movement of Trains 215 Rules for Movement by Train Orders 220 Forms of Train Orders 22K Fixing Meeting Points for Opposing Trains 228 Directing a Train to Pass or Run Ahead of An- other Train 228 Giving Right to a Train over an Opposing Train. 229 Time Order 230 For Sections 231 For Changing Sections 232 Extra Trains 234 Work Extra 235 Holding Order 236 Annulling a Schedule or a Section. . . .• 237 Annulling an Order 237 Annulling Part of an Order 237 Suspending an Order or Part of an Order 238 Rules for Double Track 238 Signal Rules 239 Train Signals 239 Use of Signals 240 INDEX IX Forms of Train Orders — Continued. Superiority of Trains 240 Movement of Trains 241 Rules for Movement by Train Orders 243 Form of Train Orders 244 Work Extra 244 Annulling Part of an Order 246 Providing for a Movement Against the Current of Traffic 246 Providing for the Use of a Section of Double Track as Single Track 247 Rules Regulating Movement of Trains Against the Current of Traffic on Double Track by Means of Block Signals 24S Rules Governing the Movement of Trains with the Current of Traffic on Double Track by Means of Block Signals 249 Trainmen's Examination 250 General Rules 250 Rules for Single Track Standard Time 252 Time Table 254 Signal Rules 257 Visible Signals 258 Hand, Flag and Lamp Signals 259 Audible Signals 262 Air- Whistle or Be'll-Cord Signals 265 Train Signals 266 Use of Signals 270 Superiority of Trains 280 Movement of Trains 281 Rules for Movement by Train Orders 291 Forms of Train Orders 301 X INDEX Trainmen's Examinations — Continued. Extra Trains 308 Work Trains 310 Rulings of the American Railway Association 314 Rights of Trains in Yard Limits 315 Yard Engines 315 Regular Trains Passing 316 Extra Trains Passing 316 Order 317 New Time Table 319 Arriving Time 323 Clearance Card 323 Pilot 324 „ Direction 324 Color 324 Blue Signal 324 Switch Lights 325 Superseding an Order 328 Meeting Point 328 Annulling a Section 333 Does Xot Supersede 335 Work Train 336 Reverse Movement 336 Size of Blank 337 Interlocking Rules 343 Definitions 343 Rules 243 Signalmen 344 Enginemen and Trainmen 348 Repairmen 348 Block Signal Rules 350 Home Signals 351 INDEX XI Enginemen and Trainmen 359 Controlled Manual Block System 360 Adjuncts ; 361 Signalmen 363 Enginemen and Trainmen 369 Automatic Block System 371 Adjuncts 372 Distant Signals 372 Train Order Signals 375 Target Signals 376 Semaphores, Common Types. . . I 377 A Two-Position Train-Order Signal 378 A Train Order Signal 379 A Three-Position Signal 38a Different Type of Three-Position Signal 380 Semaphore (Double Arm) for Use on Single Track 384 The Universal Semaphore 385 Type of Semaphore Arm, Considered Standard. .386 Types of Standard Semaphore Arms .387 Semaphore Arm 388 Cupola Identification Method 389 The Manual Controlled System. . . c 391 The Disc Type of Semaphore. . . 392 Home and Distant Signals 393 Clear Indicated by Green Light 394 Night Colors 395 The Electric Train Staff System 395 Absolute Staff Instrument with Pedestal 397 Absolute Staff Instrument 399 Absolute Staff Instrument 400 The Permissive Feature 407 Control of Signals . 400 Xll INDEX Train Order Signals — 'Continued. Staff Lever Lock " 410 Switch Locking 41 1 Intermediate Siding and Junction Instruments.. 411 Pusher Engine Attachment 412 Pusher Attachment 413 Circuit Controller Attachment. 414 Circuit Controller Attachment 415 Staff System on the Southern Pacific Railway. . .416 Crane Staff Deliverer 417 The A. B. C. System 418 Table of Resistance for Electric Train Staff System 420 Staff Catcher and Deliverer 422 View Showing Staff in Crane Staff Deliverer Ready to be Taken by a Passing Train 423 Eight Semaphore Signal Bridge Equipped with the Safety Storage System 425 Block Signal Examination 427 Signalling Catechism 432 Ten Minute Block 435 Definitions . 435 Signals used in Automatic Block 436 Signals of Interlocking Plants 440 Signals of Interlocking Plants 443 Definitions 447 Repairmen 451 Pointers for Conductors 453 Pointers to Brakemen. 457 General Rules Covering the Operation of Trains and Handling of Freight and Passengers 458 Train-men Handling Brakes 474 Detaching Engine or Cars 475 INDEX Xlll Trainmen Handling Brakes — Continued. Coupling Frozen 475 Train Breaking into Two or More Parts 475 Cutting out the Brake on a Car 475 Conductor's Valve * 476 Burst Hose 476 Brakes Not in Use 477 Retaining Valve 477 Train Air Signal 477 Reporting Defects to Inspectors 478 Starting Trains 478 The Air Brake Association's Questions and Answers for Trainmen 478 Bursted Hose and Broken Train Pipes 479 Break-in-Twos 48a Use of Hand Brakes 481 Bleeding-off Brakes 482 Rules for Giving First Aid to the Injured 484 Shock . . . . 484 Crushed Limbs 485 Broken Limbs 485 Transportation of the Injured 488 Bruises 488 Wounds or Cuts ' 488 Burns and Scalds 490 Electric Shock Accidents 491 Appendices 493 AR.V7 INDEX-PART II. Instructions for beginners 3 Learners' instruments, how to connect for practice 3 Morse alphabet 6 Transmission 9 Position 9 Movement 10 Exercises in sending 11 Hints in sending 17 Punctuation 19 Receiving 20 Penmanship 21 Battery zj. Conductors and insulators 24 Magnetism 24 Electro-Magnet 25 Key 25 Relay 27 Adjustment of instruments 30 Key 30 Relay 30 Sounder 31 Switch board 31 Ground wire 33 General instructions for circuit 38 Wire signals used in taking the circuit from others . . 41 Numeral wire signals 41 Abbreviations 42 i: il INDEX AR.V7 General rales and instructions for telegraph employes . 52 Chief operator 52 Operator 53 Double order system 59 General instructions in train order wire work 60 Order of transmission 60 Acknowledgment of receipt of train orders 61 How to copy orders on the forms 62 Train order wire work 67 Breaking in train orders 68 Railroad telegrams 69 General instructions in railway message wire work . . . 69 Order of transmission 70 How to copy messages on the forms 70 Breaking in railway messages 73 Car report local 75 Car report foreign yy General instructions in commercial wire work 78 Order of transmission 80 Sending form 82 Receiving form and how to copy on same 83 Receiving form 84 Timing of sent copies 87 Breaking in commercial messages 87 Mistakes in checks 88 Commercial messages 88 More than one address 89 Street addresses 90 More than one signature 91 Title words . . . . 92 Reporting delivery 92 Repeated message „'.-..♦. 93 AR.V7 INDEX 111 Special delivery 94 Extra dates 95 Other line messages 97 When an answer is prepaid 99 Night messages 100 Code messages 101 Cipher messages 102 Government messages 102 Dead-head messages 103 Cables 104 Cable message form 105 Press special 106 Service messages 107 Abbreviations used 107 Forms used in transmission 108 Explanation and different forms used 108 ELECTRIC RAILWAY TROUBLES AND HOW TO FIND THEM By PAUL E. LOWE, M. E. THIS is the latest and most comprehensive work on the several subjects embodied, which has up to the present time been offered to that great army of serious, ambitious and intelligent workers which is en- gaged in the various depart- ments of the Electrical Rail- way Service. The work treats of Motors, Motor Operation, Motor Repairs, Car Break- downs, Control System, Re- pairing of Control, Car Equip- ment, Catechism of Motor Re- pairs. It is prepared in a man- ner which will answer the most exacting demands of the ad- vanced scientist, and by rea- son of its simplicity and lucid elaboration, it will prove a valuable educator for the student and practical operative of less experience and technical knowledge. In fact it is an indispensable guide for members of the profession, from the highest to the lowest grade. The work contains over 350 pages, with clear-cut mechanical drawings and illustra- tions, which will enable the reader to acquire a thorough and lasting impression of the written descriptions. In view of the tremendous strides, made in recent years in the sphere of Electrical Railway Operation, this work, containing the vast accumulation of practical experience up to the present day, will undoubtedly remain the standard work on the subjects treated for a long time to come. Sold by booksellers generally or sent postpaid to any address upon receipt of price. 12mo., Cloth, over 350 Pages, Fully Illustrated : $1.50 FREDERICK J. DRAKE & CO. PUBLISHERS .... CHICAGO, ILLINOIS \ $e